RENESAS M306K9FCLRP

M16C/6K9 Group
REJ03B0041-0100Z
Rev.1.00
2003.06.06
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Description
Description
The M16C/6K9 group of single-chip microcomputers are built using the high-performance silicon gate
CMOS process using a M16C/60 Series CPU core and are packaged in a 144-pin plastic molded QFP.
These single-chip microcomputers operate using sophisticated instructions featuring a high level of instruction efficiency. To communicate with host CPU, the LPC bus interface is built in. In this way, this MCU can
work as slave controller in the personal computer system.
The specification is target oriented specification for the development of M16C/6K9.
Features
• Memory capacity .................................... ROM (See Figure AA-4 ROM Expansion)
RAM 3K to 5K bytes
• The Min. time of instruction execution ... 62.5ns (f(XIN)=16MHz, with 0 wait, Vcc=3.3V)
• Supply voltage ....................................... 3.0 to 3.6V (f(XIN)=8MHZ with 0 wait)
• Supply voltage for Program/Erase ......... 3.0 to 3.6V (CPU reprogram mode, f(XIN)=16MHZ with 1 wait)
• Low power consumption ........................ 52.8mW ( f(XIN)=16MHZ, with 0 wait, VCC = 3.3V)
• Interrupts ................................................ 38 internal and 16 external interrupt sources, 4 software
interrupt sources; 7 levels (including key input interrupt)
• Key input interrupts .................................. 2 (8 inputs shared with1 interrupt request X 1;
8 inputs (with event latch) shared with1 interrupt request X 1)
• Multifunction 16-bit timer ........................ 5 output timers + 6 input timers
• Serial I/O ................................................ 5 channels (3 for UART or clock synchronous, 2 for clock synchronous)
• DMAC .................................................... 2 channels
• Host interface ......................................... LPC bus interface X 4
• A-D converter ......................................... 10 bits X 8 channels (Expandable up to 10 channels)
• D-A converter ......................................... 8 bits X 2 channels
• Comparator circuit ................................. 8 channels
• PWM ...................................................... 8 bits X 6 channels
• Watchdog timer ...................................... 1
• I2C bus interface .................................... 3 channels : M306K9FCLRP, 2 channels : M306K9F8LRP
• PS/2 interface ........................................ 3 channels
• Serial interrupt output ............................ 6 factors (2 fixed factors, 4 programmable factors)
• Programmable I/O ................................. 129
_______
• Input port ................................................ 1 (P85 shared with NMI pin)
• Clock generating circuit ......................... 2 built-in clock generation circuits
(built-in feedback resistor, and external ceramic)
Specifications written in this
manual are believed to be accurate, but are not guaranteed
to be entirely free of error.
Specifications in this data sheet
may be changed for functional
or performance improvements.
Please make sure your manual
is the latest edition.
Applications
Notebook PC, others
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 1 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Description
------Table of Contents-----Central Processing Unit (CPU) ..................... 14
Reset ............................................................. 17
Processor Mode ............................................ 27
Clock Generating Circuit ............................... 30
Protection ...................................................... 39
Interrupts ....................................................... 40
Watchdog Timer ............................................ 68
DMAC ........................................................... 70
Timer ............................................................. 79
Serial I/O ....................................................... 97
A-D Converter ............................................. 131
D-A Converter ............................................. 141
Comparator Circuit ...................................... 143
PWM Output Circuit .................................... 145
LPC Bus Interface ....................................... 149
Serial interrupt output .................................. 167
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface ............ 178
PS2 Interface .............................................. 209
Programmable I/O Ports ............................. 224
Electrical Characteristics ............................. 246
Flash Memory Version ................................ 259
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 2 of 290
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 3 of 290
Flash memory recognition register
After reset 000000002
Vcc
Not exist
Not exist
129
Port 0 - Port 16
2 channels
8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt
request X 1
8 inputs (with event latch) shared
with 1 interrupt request X 1
Detected only in the falling edge
Can not be selected with 1 bit unit
Flash memory control register
After reset XXXX00012
Flash memory control register
After reset 000000002
Vcc
3.0 - 3.6V
M2 pin 4.5 - 5.25V
The input pin of power supply
for program/erase
Not exist
128
Port 0 - Port 16 without P84
3.3V/5V
Exist
Exist
14-bit X 4
2 channels
8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt
request X 1
8 inputs (with event latch) shared
with 1 interrupt request X 1
Detected only in the falling edge
Can not be selected with 1 bit unit
Not Exist
Address 03B416
Address 03B716
After reset 000000002
The power supply
for program/erase
M2 pin
FVCC pin
Programmable I/O
The I/O voltage in P2, P3
Programmable I/O ports
ISA bus interface
Serial interrupt output
& LPC bus interface
PWM output circuit
I2C bus interface
Key input interrupt
Timer B TB2IN
Exist
8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt
request X 1
8 inputs (with event latch) shared
with 1 interrupt request X 1
Detected in either of the edges by
the dege selection
Can be selected with 1 bit unit
3 channels
8-bit X 6
Exist
Not Exist
3.3V
Exist
8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt
request X 1
8 inputs (with event latch) shared
with 1 interrupt request X 1
Detected in either of the edges by
the dege selection
Can be selected with 1 bit unit
2 channels
8-bit X 6
Exist
Not Exist
3.3V
129
Port 0 - Port 16
The input pin of power supply
for program/erase
The input pin of power supply
for program/erase
129
Port 0 - Port 16
Not exist
Vcc 3.0 - 3.6V
FVCC 3.0 - 3.6V
Flash memory control register
After reset 000000012
Flash memory recognition register
After reset XXXXXX102
Not exist
Vcc 3.0 - 3.6V
FVCC 3.0 - 3.6V
Flash memory control register
After reset 000000012
Flash memory recognition register
After reset XXXXXX102
User ROM area
Address 0F000016 - 0FFFFF16
Boot ROM area
Address 0FF00016 - 0FFFFF16
NEW DINOR
Flash memory 64K bytes
3K bytes
144-pin
M306K9F8LRP(Under development)
Note 1 : Timer B TB2IN refers to the count source input and pulse period measurement in event count mode/pulse input in pulse width measurement mode.
Exist
14-bit X 4
Exist
Not Exist
3.3V
3.0 - 3.6V
Flash memory control register
After reset XX0000012
User ROM area
Address 0E000016 - 0FFFFF16
Boot ROM area
Address 0FF00016 - 0FFFFF16
User ROM area
Address 0EF00016 - 0FFFFF16
Boot ROM area
Address 0FF00016 - 0FFFFF16
User ROM area
Address 0E800016 - 0F5FFF16
Address 0FE00016 - 0FFFFF16
Boot ROM area
In parallel I/O mode
Address 0FE0016 - 0FFFFF16
In CPU reprogram mode & standard
serial I/O mode
Address 0DE00016 - 0DFFFF16
Built-in ROM area
NEW DINOR
Flash memory 128K bytes
NEW DINOR
Flash memory 68K bytes
NEW DINOR
Flash memory 64K bytes
ROM
5K bytes
3K bytes
3K bytes
144-pin
M306K9FCLRP(In mass production)
RAM
144-pin
M306K7F8LRP(In mass production)
144-pin
M306K5F8LRP(In mass production)
Pin numbers
Type name
The differences in M16C/6K group
M16C/6K9 Group
Description
M16C/6K9 Group
Description
Pin configuration
Fig. AA-1 shows the pin configuration (top view).
P10/CTS01/RTS01
P126
P125/INT111
P124/INT102
P123/INT92
P122/INT82
P121/INT72
P120/INT61
P07
P06
P05
P04
P03
P02
P01
P00
P117
P116
P115
P114
P113
P112
P111/F1OUT1
P110/F1OUT0
P107/AN7/INT110
P106/AN6/INT100
P105/AN5/INT90
P104/AN4/INT80
P103/AN3/INT70
P102/AN2
P101/AN1
AVSS
P100/AN0
VREF
AVcc
P97/ADTRG/SIN40/INT60
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
84
83
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
108
107
106
105
104
103
102
101
100
99
98
97
96
P11/CLK01
P12/RXD01
P13/TXD01
P14/INT71/CTS11/RTS11/CTS01/CLKS11
P15/INT81/CLK11
P16/INT91/RXD11
P17/INT101/TXD11
P20/TXD21
P21/RXD21
P22/CLK21
P23/CTS21/RTS21
P24
P25
P26
P27
VSS
P30/LAD0
VCC
P127
P31/LAD1
P32/LAD2
P33/LAD3
P34/LFRAME
P35/LRESET
P36/LCLK
P37
P130
P131
P132
P133
P134
P135
P136
P137
P40/ TA00OUT/OBF00/PWM41
P41/TA10OUT/PWM51
PIN CONFIGURATION (top view)
109
111
112
113
72
71
70
69
68
114
115
67
66
116
117
118
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
110
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
M306K9FCLRP
126
127
128
129
130
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
136
137
138
139
140
40
39
141
142
143
38
37
144
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
P96/ANEX1/SOUT40/PWM30
P95/ANEX0/CLK40/PWM20
P94/DA1/TB40IN/PWM10
P93/DA0/TB30IN/PWM00
P92/SOUT30/INT5
P91/SIN30/INT4
P90/CLK30/INT3
P161/TB41IN/PWM50
P160/TB31IN/PWM40
P157/SIN41
P156/SOUT41
P155/CLK41
P154
P153
M1
M0
P87/XCIN
P86/XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC
P85/NMI
P84/TB2IN
P83/TB1IN
P82/TB0IN
P81/TA4IN
P80/ICCK
P77/TA3IN/SCL2
P76/SDA2
P75/TA2IN/INT2/PS2B2
P74/INT1/PS2B1
P73/CTS20/RTS20/TA1IN/INT0/PS2B0
P72/CLK20/PS2A2
P71/RXD20/TA0IN/TB5IN/PS2A1
2 3 4 5
Fig. AA-1 Pin configuration (top view)
Jun 06, 2003
53
52
51
131
132
133
134
135
1
Rev.1.00
56
55
54
P42/TA20OUT/GATEA20
P43/OBF01/SERIRQ
P44/PWM01/OBF1
P45/PWM11/OBF2/PRST
P46/PWM21/OBF3/CLKRUN
FVCC
P47/PWM31
VSS
P140/KI10
P141/KI11
P142/KI12
P143/KI13
P144/KI14
P145/KI15
P146/KI16
P147/KI17
P50/KI00
P51/KI01
P52/KI02
P53/KI03
P54/KI04
P55/KI05
P56/KI06
P57 /CLKOUT/KI07
P150/TA01OUT/CLK31
P151/TA11OUT/SIN31
P152/TA21OUT/SOUT31
P60/CTS00/RTS00/SDA0
P61/CLK00/SCL0
P62/RXD00/SDA1
P63/TXD00/SCL1
P64/CTS10/RTS10/CTS00/CLKS10
P65/CLK10
P66/RXD10/TA3OUT
P67/TXD10/TA4OUT
P70/TXD20/PS2A0
page 4 of 290
Package: 144PFB-A
M16C/6K9 Group
Description
Pin configuration
Fig. AA-2 shows the pin configuration (top view).
P10/CTS01/RTS01
P126
P125/INT111
P124/INT102
P123/INT92
P122/INT82
P121/INT72
P120/INT61
P07
P06
P05
P04
P03
P02
P01
P00
P117
P116
P115
P114
P113
P112
P111/F1OUT1
P110/F1OUT0
P107/AN7/INT110
P106/AN6/INT100
P105/AN5/INT90
P104/AN4/INT80
P103/AN3/INT70
P102/AN2
P101/AN1
AVSS
P100/AN0
VREF
AVcc
P97/ADTRG/SIN40/INT60
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
84
83
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
108
107
106
105
104
103
102
101
100
99
98
97
96
P11/CLK01
P12/RXD01
P13/TXD01
P14/INT71/CTS11/RTS11/CTS01/CLKS11
P15/INT81/CLK11
P16/INT91/RXD11
P17/INT101/TXD11
P20/TXD21
P21/RXD21
P22/CLK21
P23/CTS21/RTS21
P24
P25
P26
P27
VSS
P30/LAD0
VCC
P127
P31/LAD1
P32/LAD2
P33/LAD3
P34/LFRAME
P35/LRESET
P36/LCLK
P37
P130
P131
P132
P133
P134
P135
P136
P137
P40/ TA00OUT/OBF00/PWM41
P41/TA10OUT/PWM51
PIN CONFIGURATION (top view)
109
111
112
113
72
71
70
69
68
114
115
67
66
116
117
118
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
110
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
M306K9F8LRP
126
127
128
129
130
56
55
54
53
52
51
131
50
49
132
133
48
134
135
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
136
137
138
139
140
40
39
141
142
143
38
37
144
2 3 4 5
6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
P96/ANEX1/SOUT40/PWM30
P95/ANEX0/CLK40/PWM20
P94/DA1/TB40IN/PWM10
P93/DA0/TB30IN/PWM00
P92/SOUT30/INT5
P91/SIN30/INT4
P90/CLK30/INT3
P161/TB41IN/PWM50
P160/TB31IN/PWM40
P157/SIN41
P156/SOUT41
P155/CLK41
P154
P153
M1
M0
P87/XCIN
P86/XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC
P85/NMI
P84/TB2IN
P83/TB1IN
P82/TB0IN
P81/TA4IN
P80/ICCK
P77/TA3IN
P76
P75/TA2IN/INT2/PS2B2
P74/INT1/PS2B1
P73/CTS20/RTS20/TA1IN/INT0/PS2B0
P72/CLK20/PS2A2
P71/RXD20/TA0IN/TB5IN/PS2A1
1
P42/TA20OUT/GATEA20
P43/OBF01/SERIRQ
P44/PWM01/OBF1
P45/PWM11/OBF2/PRST
P46/PWM21/OBF3/CLKRUN
FVCC
P47/PWM31
VSS
P140/KI10
P141/KI11
P142/KI12
P143/KI13
P144/KI14
P145/KI15
P146/KI16
P147/KI17
P50/KI00
P51/KI01
P52/KI02
P53/KI03
P54/KI04
P55/KI05
P56/KI06
P57 /CLKOUT/KI07
P150/TA01OUT/CLK31
P151/TA11OUT/SIN31
P152/TA21OUT/SOUT31
P60/CTS00/RTS00/SDA0
P61/CLK00/SCL0
P62/RXD00/SDA1
P63/TXD00/SCL1
P64/CTS10/RTS10/CTS00/CLKS10
P65/CLK10
P66/RXD10/TA3OUT
P67/TXD10/TA4OUT
P70/TXD20/PS2A0
Package: 144PFB-A
Fig. AA-2 Pin configuration (top view)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 5 of 290
Description
M16C/6K9 Group
Block Diagram
Fig.AA-3 is a block diagram of the M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group.
8
I/O ports
8
Port P0
Port P1
8
8
Port P2
8
Port P3
Port P4
Clock synchronous SI/O
(8 bits x 2channels)
Comparator
(8 channels)
I C bus interface
(Note 3)
Host interface
(LPC bus interface x 4 channels)
PWM output
(8 bits x 6channels)
2
INTB
Flag register
FLG
Port P14
Port P13
8
8
Note1 : ROM size depends on MCU type.
Note2 : RAM size depends on MCU type.
Note3 : A number of channels depends on MCU type.
Fig.AA-3 Block diagram of M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 6 of 290
AAAA
AAAA
Multiplier
Port P12
8
Port P11
8
8
8
RAM
(Note2)
Vector table
SB
Port P15
2
ISP
USP
ROM
(Note1)
8
Serial interrupt output
(6 factors)
Stack pointer
Port P10
PS2 interface
(3 channels)
Port P16
PC
R0H
R0
R0H
R0L
R1H
LR1
R1H
R1L
R L
R2
R
2
R3
A
3
A0
A
0
A1
F
1B
FB
D-A converter
(8 bits x 2channels)
Memory
Program counter
Registers
Port P9
M16C/60 series 16-bit CPU core
Port P85
Watchdog timer
(15 bits)
DMAC
(2 channels)
7
UART/clock synchronous SI/O
(8 bits x 3 channels)
8
XIN-XOUT
XCIN-XCOUT
Port P6
Port P8
System clock generator
A-D converter
(10 bits x 8 channels
Expandable up to 10 channels)
Timer TA0(16 bits)
Timer TA1(16 bits)
Timer TA2(16 bits)
Timer TA3(16 bits)
Timer TA4(16 bits)
Timer TB0(16 bits)
Timer TB1(16 bits)
Timer TB2(16 bits)
Timer TB3(16 bits)
Timer TB4(16 bits)
Timer TB5(16 bits)
Port P5
8
Port P7
Internal peripheral function
Timer
8
Description
M16C/6K9 Group
Performance Outline
Table AA-1 is a performance outline of M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group.
Table AA-1 Performance outline of M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group
Item
Performance
Number of basic instructions
91 instructions
The Min. time of instruction execution
62.5ns (f(XIN)=16MHz, with 0 wait, Vcc=3.3V)
Memory
ROM
(See the figure of ROM Expansion)
capacity
RAM
3K to 5K bytes
I/O port
P0 to P10 (except P85)
8 bits x 10, 7 bits x 1
P11 to P16
8 bitsx5, 2 bitsx1
Input port
P85
1 bit x 1
Multifunction TA0, TA1, TA2, TA3, TA4
16 bits x 5
timer
TB0, TB1, TB2, TB3, TB4, TB5
16 bits x 6
Serial I/O
UART0, UART1, UART2
(UART or clock synchronous) x 3
SI/O3, SI/O4
A-D converter
D-A converter
DMAC
Watchdog timer
Interrupt
Host interface
Comparator circuit
PWM
I2C bus interface
PS2 interface
Serial interrupt output
Clock generating circuit
(Clock synchronous) x 2
10 bits x (8 + 2) channels
8 bits x 2
2 channels (trigger: 24 sources)
15 bits x 1 (with prescaler)
38 internal and 16 external sources, 4 software
sources, 7 levels
4 channels (LPC bus interface)
8 channels
8 bits x 6
3 channels : M306K9FCLRP, 2 channels : M306K9F8LRP
3 channels
6 factors (2 fixed factors, 4 programmable factors)
2 built-in clock generation circuits
(built-in feedback resistor, and external ceramic)
Program/erase supply voltage
Power consumption
I/O
I/O withstand voltage
characteristics Output current
Device configuration
Package
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 7 of 290
3.0 to 3.6V (CPU reprogram mode, f(XIN)=16MHz with 1 wait)
52.8mW (3.3V, f(XIN)=16MHz, with 0 wait)
3.3V
5mA
CMOS high performance silicon gate
144-pin plastic mold QFP
M16C/6K9 Group
Description
Renesas plans to release the following products in the M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group:
(1) Support for flash memory version
(2) ROM capacity
(3) Package
144PFB-A : Plastic molded QFP(flash memory version)
ROM Size
(Byte)
External
ROM
256K
M306K9FCLRP
128K
96K
80K
M306K9F8LRP
64K
32K
Mask ROM version
Flash version
Fig.AA-4 ROM expansion
Table AA-2 Product list
Type No.
M306K9FCLRP
M306K9F8LRP**
ROM size RAM size
Jun 06, 2003
Package type I2C bus Interface
Remarks
128K bytes
5K bytes
144PFB-A
3 channels
Flash memory (NEW
DINOR) version
64K bytes
3K bytes
144PFB-A
2 channels
Flash memory (NEW
DINOR) version
**: Under development
Rev.1.00
From June 2003 up to now
page 8 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Description
Type No. M30 6K 9 M 8 XXX RP
Package type
RP : 144PFB-A
ROM No.
ROM type
8 : 64Kbytes
C : 128Kbytes
Memory type
M : Mask ROM version
F : Flash version
Shows RAM capacity, pin count, etc
(The value itself has no specific maeaning)
M16C/6K Group
M16C Family
Fig.AA-5 Type No., memory size, and package
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 9 of 290
Pin Description
M16C/6K9 Group
Pin Description
Pin name
Signal name
I/O type
Vcc, Vss
Power supply
input
____________
RESET
Reset input
Input
XIN
Clock input
Input
XOUT
Clock output Output
M0,M1
P00 to P07
Chip mode
Input
setting
Power supply
input for flash
memory programming
Analog power
supply input
Analog power
supply input
Reference
Input
voltage input
I/O port P0
Input/output
P10 to P17
I/O port P1
Input/output
P20 to P27
I/O port P2
Input/output
P30 to P37
I/O port P3
Input/output
P40 to P47
I/O port P4
Input/output
P50 to P57
I/O port P5
Input/output
FVCC
AVCC
AVSS
VREF
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 10 of 290
Function
Apply 3.0 to 3.6 V to VCC . Apply 0V to VSS
A “L” on this input resets the microcomputer.
These pins are provided for the main clock generating circuit.
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal between the XIN and
the XOUT pins. To use an externally derived clock, input it to
the XIN pin and leave the XOUT pin open.
Connect to VSS
This pin is a power supply input for on-chip flash memory
programming. During the normal operation, 0V to 3.6V can
be applied. When programming on-chip flash memory, 3.0V
to 3.6V should be applied.
This pin is a power supply input for the A-D converter.
Connect this pin to VCC.
This pin is a power supply input for the A-D converter.
Connect this pin to VSS.
This pin is a reference voltage input for the A-D converter.
This is an 8-bit CMOS I/O port. It has an input/output port
direction register that allows the user to set each pin for input or output individually. When set for input, the user can
specify in units of four bits via software whether or not they
are tied to a pull-up resistor.
This port supports CMOS input level. And output type supports CMOS 3 state or N channel open drain selectable.
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also
function as external interrupt pins as selected by software.
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type just supports CMOS 3 state only). P20-P27 are available for directly driving LED's.P20 to P24 also function as
UART2 or SI/O pins as selected by software.
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type just supports CMOS 3 state only). The port can be
used for LPC bus interface I/O pins by software selection.
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type just supports CMOS 3 state only). By software selecting,
the port can also be used for LPC bus interface I/O pins,
Timer A0 to A2 output pins PWM output pins or serial interrupt
output I/O pins. P40 to P46 pins' level can be read regardless
the setting of input port or output port. If P40 or P43 are used
for output ports, the function that clears P40 or P43 to "0" after
the read of output data buffer from host CPU is available.
This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type
is CMOS 3 state only). Key on wake interrupt 0 and comparator
input function support. P57 in this port outputs a divide-by-8 or
divide-by-32 clock of XIN or a clock of the same frequency as
XCIN as selected by software.
Pin Description
M16C/6K9 Group
Pin Description
Pin name
Signal name
I/O type
Function
P60 to P67
I/O port P6
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that P60 to
P63's output type is N channel open drain only; P64 to P67's
output type is CMOS 3 state only; P60 to P63 no internal
pull-up registor support.) By software selecting, this port
can be used for I2C-BUS interface, UART0/UART1 input/
output pin, timerA3,A4 output pin. When P60 to P63 used as
I2C-BUS interface SDA,SCL, the input level of these pins are
CMOS/SMBUS selectable.
P70 to P77
I/O port P7
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that P70 to
P77 output type is N channel open drain only; no internal
pull-up registor support.) By software selecting, this port
can be used for external interrupt input pin, timerA0 to A3
and timer B5 input pin, PS2 interface input/output pin, I2C
interface (M306K9FCLRP only) or UART2 input/output pin.
P70 to P75 pins' level can be read regardless of the setting of
input port or output port.
P80 to P84,
P86,
P87,
P85
I/O port P8
Input/output
Input/output
Input/output
Input
P90 to P97
I/O port P9
P100 to P107
I/O port P10
Rev.1.00
I/O port P85
Jun 06, 2003
P80 to P84, P86, and P87 are I/O ports with the same functions
as P0. (Except that P86 to P87's output type is CMOS 3 state
only; P80 to P84's output type is N channel open drain only;
P85 is input port only; the P80 to P84 and P85 are no internal
pull-up registor support.)
By software selecting, this port can be used for timer A4, B0 to
B2, I2C-BUS interface I/O pins. P86 and P87 can be set using
software to function as the I/O pins for a sub clock generation
circuit. In this case, connect a quartz oscillator between P86
(XCOUT pin) and P8
7 (XCIN pin).
P85 is an input-only port that
______
______
also functions for NMI. The NMI interrupt is generated
when
______
the input at this pin changes from “H” to “L”. The NMI function
cannot be cancelled using software.
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, the port can
be used for external interrupt, timer B3 to B4, A-D converter
extended input pins, A-D trigger, SI/O3, SI/O4 I/O pins, PWM,
D-A converter output pins.
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type is CMOS 3 state only.) If the ports are set to input
mode, the pull-up resistor can be set in bit unit. By software
selecting, the port can be used for A-D converter, external
interrupt input pins.
page 11 of 290
Pin Description
M16C/6K9 Group
Pin Description
Pin name
Signal name
I/O type
Function
P110 to P117
I/O port P11
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. By software selecting, P110, P111 also function as clock output pins, which the
frequency is the same with XIN (XCIN).
P120 to P127
I/O port P12
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, this port
can be used for external interrupt input pin.
P130 to P137
I/O port P13
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type is N channel open drain only; no internal pull-up
registor support.)
P140 to P147
I/O port P14
P150 to P157
I/O port P15
P160, P161
I/O port P16
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. The port can be
used for key on wake-up interrupt 1 input pins. P140 to P143
are available for directly driving LED's. In input mode, the
pull-up register can be set in one bit unit by software.
Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, these
ports can be used for timer A0 to A2's output or SI/O3 and
SI/O4 I/O pins.
Input/output This is an 2-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output
type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, this port
can be used for timer B3 and B4 input or PWM output pin.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 12 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Memory
Operation of Functional Blocks
The M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group accommodates certain units in a single chip. These units include
ROM and RAM to store instructions and data and the central processing unit (CPU) to execute arithmetic/
logic operations. Also peripheral units such as timers, serial I/O, D-A converter, DMAC, A-D converter, host
bus interface, comparator, PWM output , I2C BUS interface, PS2 interface and I/O ports are included.
The following explains each unit.
Memory
Fig.CA-1 is the memory map. The address space extends up to 1M bytes from address 0000016 to FFFFF16.
From FFFFF16 to the address decreasing direction ROM is allocated. For example, in the M306K9FCLRP,
there is 128K bytes of internal ROM from E000016 to FFFFF16. The vector table for fixed interrupts such as
_______
the reset and NMI are mapped from FFFDC16 to FFFFF16. The starting address of the interrupt routine is
stored here. The address of the vector table for timer interrupts, etc., can be set as desired using the internal
register (INTB). See the section on interrupts for details.
From 0040016 to the address increasing direction RAM is allocated. For example, in the M306K9FCLRP, 5K
bytes of internal RAM is mapped to the space from 0040016 to 017FF16. In addition to storing data, the RAM
also stores the stack used when calling subroutines and when interrupts are generated.
The SFR area is mapped from 0000016 to 003FF16. This area accommodates the control registers for peripheral devices such as I/O ports, A-D converter, serial I/O, and timers, etc. Fig.CA-2 to CA-5 are location of
peripheral unit control registers. Any part of the SFR area that is not occupied is reserved and cannot be
used for other purposes.
The special page vector table is mapped from FFE0016 to FFFDB16. If the starting addresses of subroutines
or the destination addresses of jumps are stored here, subroutine call instructions and jump instructions can
be used as 2-byte instructions, reducing the number of program steps.
0000016
SFR area
For details, see
Fig.CA-2 to Fig.CA-4
0040016
Internal RAM area
FFE0016
XXXXX16
Type No.
M306K9FCLRP
M306K9F8LRP
Address XXXXX16
Address YYYYY16
017FF16
E000016
00FFF16
Special page
vector table
FFFDC16
Inhibited
Overflow
BRK instruction
Address match
Single step
F000016
YYYYY16
Internal ROM area
FFFFF16
Fig.CA-1 Memory map
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 13 of 290
Undefined instruction
FFFFF16
Watchdog timer
DBC
NMI
Reset
CPU
M16C/6K9 Group
Central Processing Unit (CPU)
The CPU has a total of 13 registers shown in Fig.BA-1 Seven of these registers (R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, and
FB) come in two sets; therefore, these have two register banks.
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
AAAAAA
b15
R0(Note)
b8 b7
b15
R1(Note)
b8 b7
H
b15
R2(Note)
b15
R3(Note)
b15
A0(Note)
b15
A1(Note)
b15
FB(Note)
b0
L
H
b19
b0
L
b0
Program counter
Data
registers
b19
INTB
b0
Interrupt table
register
L
H
b15
b0
b0
User stack pointer
USP
b15
b0
b0
b0
PC
b0
Interrupt stack
pointer
ISP
Address
registers
b15
b0
Static base
register
SB
b15
b0
Frame base
register
b0
FLG
Flag register
AA
AAAAAA
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAA
IPL
U
I O B S Z D C
Note: These registers consist of two register banks.
Fig.BA-1 Central processing unit register
(1) Data registers (R0, R0H, R0L, R1, R1H, R1L, R2, and R3)
Data registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) are configured with 16 bits, and are used primarily for transfer and
arithmetic/logic operations.
Registers R0 and R1 each can be used as separate 8-bit data registers, high-order bits as (R0H/R1H), and
low-order bits as (R0L/R1L). In some instructions, registers R2 and R0, as well as R3 and R1 can use as 32bit data registers (R2R0/R3R1).
(2) Address registers (A0 and A1)
Address registers (A0 and A1) are configured with 16 bits, and have functions equivalent to those of data
registers. These registers can also be u2sed for address register indirect addressing and address register
relative addressing.
In some instructions, registers A1 and A0 can be combined for use as a 32-bit address register (A1A0).
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 14 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU
(3) Frame base register (FB)
Frame base register (FB) is configured with 16 bits, and is used for FB relative addressing.
(4) Program counter (PC)
Program counter (PC) is configured with 20 bits, indicating the address of an instruction to be executed.
(5) Interrupt table register (INTB)
Interrupt table register (INTB) is configured with 20 bits, indicating the start address of an interrupt vector
table.
(6) Stack pointer (USP/ISP)
Stack pointer comes in two types: user stack pointer (USP) and interrupt stack pointer (ISP), each configured
with 16 bits.
Your desired type of stack pointer (USP or ISP) can be selected by a stack pointer select flag (U flag). This
flag is located at the position of bit 7 in the flag register (FLG).
(7) Static base register (SB)
Static base register (SB) is configured with 16 bits, and is used for SB relative addressing.
(8) Flag register (FLG)
Flag register (FLG) is configured with 11 bits, each bit is used as a flag. Fig.BA-2 shows the flag register
(FLG). The following explains the function of each flag:
• Bit 0: Carry flag (C flag)
This flag retains a carry, borrow, or shift-out bit that has occurred in the arithmetic/logic unit.
• Bit 1: Debug flag (D flag)
This flag enables a single-step interrupt.
When this flag is “1”, a single-step interrupt is generated after instruction execution. This flag is cleared to
“0” when the interrupt is acknowledged.
• Bit 2: Zero flag (Z flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in 0; otherwise, cleared to “0”.
• Bit 3: Sign flag (S flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in a negative value; otherwise, cleared to “0”.
• Bit 4: Register bank select flag (B flag)
This flag chooses a register bank. Register bank 0 is selected when this flag is “0” ; register bank 1 is
selected when this flag is “1”.
• Bit 5: Overflow flag (O flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in overflow; otherwise, cleared to “0”.
• Bit 6: Interrupt enable flag (I flag)
This flag enables a maskable interrupt.
An interrupt is disabled when this flag is “0”, and is enabled when this flag is “1”. This flag is cleared to “0”
when the interrupt is acknowledged.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 15 of 290
CPU
M16C/6K9 Group
• Bit 7: Stack pointer select flag (U flag)
Interrupt stack pointer (ISP) is selected when this flag is “0” ; user stack pointer (USP) is selected when this
flag is “1”.
This flag is cleared to “0” when a hardware interrupt is acknowledged or an INT instruction of software
interrupt No. 0 to 31 is executed.
• Bits 8 to 11: Reserved area
• Bits 12 to 14: Processor interrupt priority level (IPL)
Processor interrupt priority level (IPL) is configured with the three bits, for specification of up to eight processor interrupt priority levels from level 0 to level 7.
If a requested interrupt has priority greater than the processor interrupt priority level (IPL), the interrupt is
enabled.
• Bit 15: Reserved area
The C, Z, S, and O flags are changed when instructions are executed. See the software manual for details.
AA
AAAAAAAAAA
AAA
AA
AAA
b15
b0
IPL
U
I
O B S Z D C
Flag register (FLG)
Carry flag
Debug flag
Zero flag
Sign flag
Register bank select flag
Overflow flag
Interrupt enable flag
Stack pointer select flag
Reserved area
Processor interrupt priority level (CPU)
Reserved area
Fig.BA-2 Flag register (FLG)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 16 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Reset
Reset
There are two kinds of resets; hardware and software. In both cases, operation is the same after the reset.
(See “Software Reset” for details of software resets.) This section explains the hardware reset.
When the supply voltage is in the range where operation is guaranteed, a reset is effected by holding the
reset pin level “L” (0.2VCC max.) for at least 20 cycles. When the reset pin level is then returned to the “H”
level while main clock is stable, the reset status is cancelled and program execution resumes from the
address in the reset vector table.
Fig.VB-1 shows the example reset circuit. Fig.VB-2 shows the reset sequence.
3.3V
3.0V
VCC
0V
3.3V
VCC
RESET
RESET
0.6V
0V
Example when VCC = 3.3V
Fig.VB-1 Example reset circuit
XIN
More than 20 cycles are needed
RESET
BCLK
24cycles
Internal
clock Φ
Single chip
mode
Address
FFFFE16
Fig.VB-2 Reset sequence
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
Content of reset vector
FFFFC16
page 17 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Reset
____________
Table VB-1 shows the statuses of the other pins while the RESET pin level is “L”. Fig.VB-3 and VB-4 show
the internal status of the microcomputer immediately after the reset is cancelled.
____________
Table VB-1 Pin status when RESET pin level is “L”
Status
Pin name
Rev.1.00
CNVSS = VSS
(M0)
P0
I/O port (floating)
P1
I/O port (floating)
P2, P3, P40 to P43
I/O port (floating)
P44
I/O port (floating)
P45 to P47
I/O port (floating)
P50
I/O port (floating)
P51
I/O port (floating)
P52
I/O port (floating)
P53
I/O port (floating)
P54
I/O port (floating)
P55
I/O port (floating)
P56
I/O port (floating)
P57
I/O port (floating)
P6, P7, P80 to P84,
P86, P87, P9, P10
I/O port (floating)
P11, P12, P13, P14
I/O port (floating)
P15, P16
I/O port (floating)
Jun 06, 2003
page 18 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Reset
(25) A-D conversion interrupt control register
(004E16)···
? 0 0 0
(26) UART2 transmit interrupt control register
(004F16)···
? 0 0 0
(000616)··· 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0
(27) UART2 receive interrupt control register
(005016)···
? 0 0 0
(000716)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
(28) UART0 transmit interrupt control register
(005116)···
? 0 0 0
(1) Processor mode register 0
(000416)···
0016
(2) Processor mode register 1
(000516)··· 0 0 0 0 0
(3) System clock control register 0
(4) System clock control register 1
0
(5) Address match interrupt enable register
(000916)···
0 0
(29) UART0 receive interrupt control register
(005216)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(6) Protect register
(000A16)···
0 0 0
(30) UART1 transmit interrupt control register
(005316)···
? 0 0 0
(7) Watchdog timer control register
(000F16)··· 0 0 0 ? ? ? ? ?
(31) UART1 receive interrupt control register
(005416)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(8) Address match interrupt register 0
(001016)···
0016
(32) Timer A0 interrupt control register
(005516)···
? 0 0 0
(001116)···
0016
(33) Timer A1 interrupt control register
(005616)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(34) Timer A2 interrupt control register
(005716)···
? 0 0 0
(001216)···
(9) Address match interrupt register 1
0 0 0 0
(001416)···
0016
(35) Timer A3 interrupt control register
(005816)···
? 0 0 0
(001516)···
0016
(36) Timer A4 interrupt control register
(005916)···
? 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
(37) Timer B0 interrupt control register
(005A16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(10) DMA0 control register
(002C16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 ? 0 0
(38) Timer B1 interrupt control register
(005B16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(11) DMA1 control register
(001616)···
(003C16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 ? 0 0
(39) Timer B2 interrupt control register
(005C16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(12) I2C interrupt control register
(004116)···
? 0 0 0
(40) INT0 interrupt control register
(005D16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(13) SCL2, SDA2 interrupt control register
(004216)···
? 0 0 0
(41) INT1 interrupt control register
(005E16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(42) INT2 interrupt control register
(005F16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(14) Timer B5 interrupt control register
(004316)···
? 0 0 0
(15) INT3 interrupt control register
(004416)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(43) PS20 shift register
(02A016)···
0016
(16) INT9 interrupt control register
(004516)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(44) PS20 status register
(02A116)···
0016
? 0 0 0
(45) PS20 control register
(02A216)···
0016
(17) Timer B4 interrupt control register
(004616)···
(18) Timer B3 interrupt control register
(004716)···
? 0 0 0
(46) PS21 shift register
(02A416)···
0016
(19) SI/O4 interrupt control register
(004816)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(47) PS21 status register
(02A516)···
0016
(20) SI/O3 interrupt control register
(004916)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(48) PS21 control register
(02A616)···
0016
(02A816)···
0016
(21) Bus collision detection interrupt
control register
(004A16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(49) PS22 shift register
(22) DMA0 interrupt control register
(004B16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(50) PS22 status register
(02A916)···
0016
(51) PS22 control register
(02AA16)···
0016
(52) PS2 mode register
(02AC16)···
0016
(23) DMA1 interrupt control register
(004C16)···
0 0 ? 0 0 0
(24) Key input interrupt control register 0
(004D16)···
? 0 0 0
x : Nothing is mapped to this bit
? : Undefined
The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values must therefore be set.
Fig.VB-3 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 19 of 290
Reset
M16C/6K9 Group
(53) Data bus buffer status register 0
(02C116)···
0016
(87) PWM control register 1
(030D16)···
0016
(54) Data bus buffer status register 1
(02C316)···
0016
(88) I2C2 address register
(031216)···
0016
(55) Data bus buffer status register 2
(02C516)···
0016
(89) I2C2 control register 0
(031316)···
0016
(56) Data bus buffer status register 3
(02C716)···
0016
(90) I2C2 clock control register
(031416)···
0016
(57) Data bus buffer control register 0
(02C816)···
0016
(031516)···
1A16
(58) Data bus buffer control register 1
(02C916)···
0016
2
(91) I C2 start/stop condition
control register
2
(92) I C2 control register 1
(031616)···
3016
(59) GateA20 control register
(02CA16)···
0016
(93) I2C2 control register 2
(031716)···
0016
(60) Port P11 direction register
(02E216)···
0016
(94) I2C2 status register
(031816)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0
(61) Port P12 direction register
(02E316)···
0016
(95) I2C0 address register
(032216)···
0016
(62) Port P13 direction register
(02E616)···
0016
(96) I2C0 control register 0
(032316)···
0016
(63) Port P14 direction register
(02E716)···
0016
(97) I2C0 clock control register
(032416)···
0016
(64) Port P15 direction register
(02EA16)···
0016
(032516)···
1A16
(65) Port P16 direction register
(02EB16)···
2
(98) I C0 start/stop condition
control register
(99) I2C0 control register 1
(032616)···
3016
(66) Port function selection register 0
(02F816)···
0016
(100) I2C0 control register 2
(032716)···
0016
(67) Port function selection register 1
(02F916)···
0016
(101) I2C0 status register
(032816)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0
0 0
(68) Port P4 input register
(02FA16)··· 0
(102) I2C1 address register
(033216)···
0016
(69) Port P7 input register
(02FB16)··· 0 0
(103) I2C1 control register 0
(033316)···
0016
(70) Pull-up control register 3
(02FC16)···
0016
(104) I2C1 clock control register
(033416)···
0016
(71) Pull-up control register 4
(02FD16)···
0016
(033516)···
1A16
(72) Port control register 1
(02FE16)···
0016
2
(105) I C1 start/stop condition
control register
(106) I2C1 control register 1
(033616)···
3016
(73) Port control register 2
(02FF16)···
0016
(107) I2C1 control register 2
(033716)···
0016
(74) PWM0 prescaler
(030016)···
0016
(108) I2C1 status register
(033816)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0
(75) PWM0 register
(030116)···
0016
(109) TimerB3,4,5 count start flag
(034016)··· 0 0 0
(76) PWM1 prescaler
(030216)···
0016
(110) Interrupt factor selection register 1
(035616)···
0016
(77) PWM1 register
(030316)···
0016
(111) Interrupt factor selection register 2
(035716)···
0016
(030416)···
0016
(112) Interrupt factor selection register 3
(035816)···
0016
(030516)···
0016
(113) Interrupt factor selection register 4
(035916)···
0016
(030616)···
0016
(114) Interrupt factor selection register 5
(035A16)···
0016
(81) PWM3 register
(030716)···
0016
(115) TimerB3 mode register
(035B16)··· 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(82) PWM4 prescaler
(030816)···
0016
(116) TimerB4 mode register
(035C16)··· 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(83) PWM4 register
(030916)···
0016
(117) TimerB5 mode register
(035D16)··· 0 0 ?
(84) PWM5 prescaler
(030A16)···
0016
(118) Interrupt factor selection register 0
(035F16)···
0016
(85) PWM5 register
(030B16)···
0016
(119) SI/O3 control register
(036216)···
4016
(030C16)···
0016
(120) SI/O4 control register
(036616)···
4016
(78) PWM2 prescaler
(79) PWM2 register
(80) PWM3 prescaler
(86) PWM control register 0
0 0 0 0
x : Nothing is mapped to this bit
? : Undefined
The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values
must therefore be set.
Fig.VB-4 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 20 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Reset
0016
(149) A-D control register 2
(03D416)··· 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0
0016
(150) A-D control register 0
(03D616)··· 0 0 0 0 0 ? ? ?
(037C16)··· 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(151) A-D control register 1
(03D716)···
0016
(124) UART2 transmit/receive control register 1
(037D16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
(152) D-A control register
(03DC16)···
0016
(125) Count start flag
(038016)···
(153) Comparator control register
(03DE16)···
0016
0016
(121) UART2 special mode register
(037716)···
(122) UART2 transmit/receive mode register
(037816)···
(123) UART2 transmit/receive control register 0
0016
(126) Clock prescaler reset flag
(038116)··· 0
(127) One-shot start flag
(038216)··· 0 0
(128) Trigger select flag
(038316)···
(154) Port P0 direction register
(03E216)···
0 0 0 0 0
(155) Port P1 direction register
(03E316)···
0016
0016
(156) Port P2 direction register
(03E616)···
0016
0016
(129) Up-down flag
(038416)···
0016
(157) Port P3 direction register
(03E716)···
(130) Timer A0 mode register
(039616)···
0016
(158) Port P4 direction register
(03EA16)···
0016
0016
(159) Port P5 direction register
(03EB16)···
0016
0016
(131) Timer A1 mode register
(039716)···
(132) Timer A2 mode register
(039816)···
0016
(160) Port P6 direction register
(03EE16)···
(133) Timer A3 mode register
(039916)···
0016
(161) Port P7 direction register
(03EF16)···
0016
(134) Timer A4 mode register
(039A16)···
0016
(162) Port P8 direction register
(03F216)··· 0 0
0 0 0 0 0
(135) Timer B0 mode register
(039B16)··· 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(163) Port P9 direction register
(03F316)···
0016
(136) Timer B1 mode register
(039C16)··· 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(164) Port P10 direction register
(03F616)···
0016
(137) Timer B2 mode register
(039D16)··· 0 0 ?
0 0 0 0
(165) Pull-up control register 0
(03FC16)···
0016
(138) UART0 transmit/receive mode register
(03A016)···
(166) Pull-up control register 1
(03FD16)···
0016
(139) UART0 transmit/receive control register 0
(03A416)··· 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(167) Pull-up control register 2
(03FE16)···
0016
(03A516)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
(168) Port control register 0
(03FF16)···
(140) UART0 transmit/receive control register 1
0016
(141) UART1 transmit/receive mode register
(03A816)···
(142) UART1 transmit/receive control register 0
(03AC16)··· 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(143) UART1 transmit/receive control register 1
0016
(03AD16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
(144) UART transmit/receive control register 2
(03B016)···
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
(145) Flash memory recognition register (Note1)
(03B416)···
1 0
(146) Flash memory control register (Note1)
(03B716)···
0 0 0 0 0 1
(147) DMA0 cause select register
(03B816)···
0016
(148) DMA1 cause select register
(03BA16)···
0016
000016
(170) Address registers (A0/A1)
000016
(171) Frame base register (FB)
000016
(172) Interrupt table register (INTB)
0000016
(173) User stack pointer (USP)
000016
(174) Interrupt stack pointer (ISP)
000016
(175) Static base register (SB)
000016
(176) Flag register (FLG)
000016
x : Nothing is mapped to this bit
? : Undefined
The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values
must therefore be set.
(Note1) This register exists only in the flash memory version.
Fig.VB-5 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 21 of 290
0016
(169) Data registers (R0/R1/R2/R3)
Reset
M16C/6K9 Group
(177) Serial interrupt control register 0
(02B016)···
0016
(178) Serial interrupt control register 1
(02B116)···
0016
(179) IRQ request register 0
(02B216)···
0016
(180) IRQ request register 1
(02B316)···
0016
(181) IRQ request register 2
(02B416)···
0016
(182) IRQ request register 3
(02B516)···
0016
(02B616)···
0016
(184) Serial interrupt control register 2
(02B716)···
1016
(185) LPC1 address register L
(02D016)···
0016
(186) LPC1 address register H
(02D116)···
0016
(187) LPC2 address register L
(02D216)···
0016
(188) LPC2 address register H
(02D316)···
0016
(189) LPC3 address register L
(02D416)···
0016
(190) LPC3 address register H
(02D516)···
0016
(191) LPC control register
(02D616)···
0016
(192) Port function selection register 2
(02F116)···
0016
(193) Pull-up resistor control register 5
(02F216)···
0016
(194) Pull-up resistor control register 6
(02F316)···
0016
(195) Key input interrupt 1 enable register
(02F416)···
0016
(196) Key input interrupt 1 edge selection register
(183) IRQ request register 4
(02F516)···
0016
(197) P14 event register
(02F616)···
0016
(198) Port control register 3
(02F716)···
0016
The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values must
therefore be set.
Fig.VB-6 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (4)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 22 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
SFR
SFR
000016
004016
000116
004116
I2C2 interrupt control register (IIC2IC)
000216
004216
SCL2,SDA2 interrupt control register (SCLDA2IC)
DMA0 interrupt control register (DM0IC)
Timer B5 interrupt control register (TB5IC)
LRESET interrupt control register (LRSTIC)
INT3 interrupt control register (INT3IC)
INT9 interrupt control register (INT9IC)
Timer B4 interrupt control register (TB4IC)
000316
000416
000516
000616
000716
Processor mode register 0 (PM0)
Processor mode register 1(PM1)
System clock control register 0 (CM0)
System clock control register 1 (CM1)
000816
000916
000A16
004316
004416
004516
004616
Address match interrupt enable register (AIER)
Protect register (PRCR)
000B16
UART1 receive interrupt control register (S1RIC)
SI/O4 interrupt control register (S4IC)
Timer B3 interrupt control register (TB3IC)
004716
000C16
UART1 transmit interrupt control register (S1TIC)
000D16
000E16
000F16
004816
Watchdog timer start register (WDTS)
Watchdog timer control register (WDC)
004916
Address match interrupt register 0 (RMAD0)
004A16
SI/O4 interrupt control register (S4IC)
INT6 interrupt control register (INT6IC)
SI/O3 interrupt control register (S3IC)
INT5 interrupt control register (INT5IC)
001016
001116
Bus collision detection interrupt control register (BCNIC)
001216
001316
001416
001516
INT4 interrupt control register (INT4IC)
INT8 interrupt control register (INT8IC)
DMA1 interrupt control register (DM1IC)
INT7 interrupt control register (INT7IC)
Key input interrupt 0 control register (KUP0IC)
A-D conversion interrupt control register (ADIC)
004B16
004C16
Address match interrupt register 1 (RMAD1)
001616
004D16
001716
004E16
001816
004F16
UART2 transmit interrupt control register (S2TIC)
005016
UART2 receive interrupt control register (S2RIC)
005116
UART0 transmit interrupt control register (S0TIC)
001916
IBF0 interrupt control register (IBF0IC)
001A16
001B16
IBF1 interrupt control register (IBF1IC)
001C16
I2C0 interrupt control register (IIC0IC)
001D16
001E16
005216
001F16
002116
UART0 receive interrupt control register (S0RIC)
SCL0,SDA0 interrupt control register (SCLDA0IC)
002016
DMA0 source pointer (SAR0)
INT11 interrupt control register (INT11IC)
005316
UART1 transmit interrupt control register (S1TIC)
I2C1 interrupt control register (IIC1IC)
002216
002316
005416
UART1 receive interrupt control register (S1RIC)
002416
002516
SCL1,SDA1 interrupt control register (SCLDA1IC)
DMA0 destination pointer (DAR0)
002616
005516
002716
002816
002916
DMA0 transfer counter (TCR0)
002A16
005716
002B16
002C16
005616
005816
DMA0 control register (DM0CON)
002D16
005916
002E16
002F16
005A16
INT10 interrupt control register (INT10IC)
Timer A0 interrupt control register (TA0IC)
Timer A1 interrupt control register (TA1IC)
INT7 interrupt control register (INT7IC)
SI/O3 interrupt control register (S3IC)
Timer A2 interrupt control register (TA2IC)
Timer A3 interrupt control register (TA3IC)
IBF2 interrupt control register (IBF2IC)
Timer A4 interrupt control register (TA4IC)
IBF3 interrupt control register (IBF3IC)
Timer B0 interrupt control register (TB0IC)
003016
003116
SCL0,SDA0 interrupt control register (SCLDA0IC)
DMA1 source pointer (SAR1)
003216
005B16
003316
SCL1,SDA1 interrupt control register (SCLDA1IC)
003416
003516
DMA1 destination pointer (DAR1)
005C16
003616
003716
003816
003916
005D16
DMA1 transfer counter (TCR1)
005E16
003A16
003B16
003C16
INT11 interrupt control register (INT11IC)
Timer B1 interrupt control register (TB1IC)
005F16
DMA1 control register (DM1CON)
003D16
006016
003E16
006116
INT10 interrupt control register (INT10IC)
Timer B2 interrupt control register (TB2IC)
Key input interrupt 1 control register (KUP1IC)
INT0 interrupt control register (INT0IC)
PS20 interrupt control register (PS20IC)
INT1 interrupt control register (INT1IC)
PS21 interrupt control register (PS21IC)
INT2 interrupt control register (INT2IC)
PS22 interrupt control register (PS22IC)
003F16
027D16
027E16
027F16
Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited.
Fig.CA-2 Location of peripheral unit control registers (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 23 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
SFR
028016
02C016
028116
02C116
028216
02C216
028316
02C316
028416
02C416
028516
02C516
028616
02C616
028716
02C716
028816
02C816
028916
02C916
028A16
02CA16
028B16
02CB16
028C16
02CC16
028D16
02CD16
028E16
02CE16
028F16
02CF16
029016
02D016
029116
02D116
029216
02D216
029316
02D316
029416
02D416
029516
02D516
029616
02D616
029716
02D716
029816
02D816
029916
02D916
029A16
02DA16
029B16
02DB16
029C16
02DC16
029D16
02DD16
029E16
02DE16
02A116
02A216
PS20 shift register (PS20SR)
PS20 status register (PS20STS)
PS20 control register (PS20CON)
02A516
02A616
PS21 shift register (PS21SR)
PS21 status register (PS21STS)
PS21 control register (PS21CON)
02A916
02AA16
PS22 shift register (PS22SR)
PS22 status register (PS22STS)
PS22 control register (PS22CON)
02E216
02E416
02E516
02E616
02E816
02E916
02EA16
02EB16
02AB16
02AC16
02E116
02E716
02A716
02A816
02E016
02E316
02A316
02A416
PS2 mode register (PS2MOD)
02ED16
02AE16
02EE16
02EF16
02AF16
02B116
02B216
02B316
02B416
02B516
02B616
02B716
Port P11 (P11)
Port P12 (P12)
Port P11 direction register (PD11)
Port P12 direction register (PD12)
Port P13 (P13)
Port P14 (P14)
Port P13 direction register (PD13)
Port P14direction register (PD14)
Port P15 (P15)
Port P16 (P16)
Port P15 direction register (PD15)
Port P16 direction register (PD16)
02EC16
02AD16
02B016
LPC1 address registerL (LPC1ADL)
LPC1 address registerH (LPC1ADH)
LPC2 address registerL (LPC2ADL)
LPC2 address registerH (LPC2ADH)
LPC3 address registerL (LPC3ADL)
LPC3 address registerH (LPC3ADH)
LPC control register (LPCCON)
02DF16
029F16
02A016
Data bus buffer register0 (DBB0)
Data bus buffer status register0 (DBBSTS0)
Data bus buffer register1 (DBB1)
Data bus buffer status register1 (DBBSTS1)
Data bus buffer register2 (DBB2)
Data bus buffer status register2 (DBBSTS2)
Data bus buffer register3 (DBB3)
Data bus buffer status register3 (DBBSTS3)
Data bus buffer control register0 (DBBCON0)
Data bus buffer control register1 (DBBCON1)
Gate A20 control register (GA20CON)
Serial Interrupt control register 0 (SERCON0)
Serial Interrupt control register 1 (SERCON1)
IRQ request register 0 (IRQ0)
IRQ request register 1 (IRQ1)
IRQ request register 2 (IRQ2)
IRQ request register 3 (IRQ3)
IRQ request register 4 (IRQ4)
Serial Interrupt control register 2 (SERCON2)
02F016
02F416
Port function selection register 2 (PSL2)
Pull-up resistor control register 5 (PUR5)
Pull-up resistor control register 6 (PUR6)
Key input interrupt 1 enable register (KIN1EN)
02F516
Key input interrupt 1 edge selection regiter (KINSEL)
02F616
P14 event register (P14EV)
Port control register3 (PCR3)
Port function selection register0 (PSL0)
Port function selection register1 (PSL1)
Port P4 input register (P4PIN)
Port P7 input register (P7PIN)
Pull-up control register3 (PUR3)
Pull-up control register4 (PUR4)
Port control register1 (PCR1)
Port control register2 (PCR2)
02F116
02F216
02F316
02F716
02B816
02F816
02B916
02F916
02BA16
02FA16
02BB16
02FB16
02BC16
02FC16
02BD16
02FD16
02BE16
02FE16
02BF16
02FF16
Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited.
Fig.CA-3 Location of peripheral unit control registers (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 24 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
030016
030116
030216
030316
030416
030516
030616
030716
030816
030916
030A16
030B16
030C16
030D16
SFR
PWM0 prescaler (PREPWM0)
PWM0 register (PWM0)
PWM1 prescaler (PREPWM1)
PWM1 register (PWM1)
PWM2 prescaler (PREPWM2)
PWM2 register (PWM2)
PWM3 prescaler (PREPWM3)
PWM3 register (PWM3)
PWM4 prescaler (PREPWM4)
PWM4 register (PWM4)
PWM5 prescaler (PREPWM5)
PWM5 register (PWM5)
PWM control register 0 (PWMCON0)
PWM control register 1 (PWMCON1)
I2C2 data shift register (S02) (Note2)
031416
031516
031616
031716
031816
034316
034416
034516
034616
034716
034816
034916
034A16
034B16
034C16
034D16
035016
035116
031116
031316
034216
034F16
030F16
031216
2
I C2 address register (S0D2) (Note2)
I2C2 control register 0 (S1D2) (Note2)
I2C2 clock control register (S22) (Note2)
I2C2 start/stop condition control register (S2D2) (Note2)
I2C2 control register 1 (S3D2) (Note2)
I2C2 control register 2 (S4D2) (Note2)
I2C2 status register (S12) (Note2)
035216
035316
035416
035516
035616
035716
035816
031916
035916
031A16
035A16
031B16
035B16
031C16
035C16
031D16
035D16
031E16
035E16
035F16
031F16
032016
I2C0 data shift register (S00)
032316
032416
032516
032616
032716
032816
036016
I2C0 address register (S0D0)
I2C0 control register0 (S1D0)
I2C0 clock control register (S20)
I2C0 start/stop condition control register (S2D0)
I2C0 control register1 (S3D0)
I2C0 control register2 (S4D0)
I2C0 status register (S10)
036216
036316
036416
036616
036716
036916
036A16
032B16
036B16
032C16
036C16
032D16
036D16
032E16
036E16
I2C1 data shift register (S01)
033516
033616
033716
033816
Interrupt event select register0 (IFSR0)
SI/O3 transmit/receive register (S3TRR)
SI/O3 control register (S3C)
SI/O3 communication speed register (S3BRG)
SI/O4 transmit/receive register (S4TRR)
SI/O4 control register (S4C)
SI/O4 communication speed register (S4BRG)
037016
037116
033116
033416
Interrupt event select register1 (IFSR1)
Interrupt event select register2 (IFSR2)
Interrupt event select register3 (IFSR3)
Interrupt event select register4 (IFSR4)
Interrupt event select register5 (IFSR5)
TimerB3 mode register (TB3MR)
TimerB4 mode register (TB4MR)
TimerB5 mode register (TB5MR)
036F16
032F16
033316
TimerB5 register (TB5)
036816
032A16
033216
TimerB4 register (TB4)
036516
032916
033016
TimerB3 register (TB3)
036116
032116
032216
TimerB3,4,5 count start flag (TBSR)
034116
034E16
030E16
031016
034016
I2C1 address register (S0D1)
I2C1 control register0 (S1D1)
I2C1 clock control register (S21)
I2C1 start/stop condition control register (S2D1)
I2C1 control register1 (S3D1)
I2C1 control register2 (S4D1)
I2C1 status register (S11)
037216
037316
037416
037516
037616
037716
037816
033916
037916
033A16
037A16
033B16
037B16
033C16
037C16
033D16
037D16
033E16
037E16
033F16
037F16
UART2 special mode register (U2SMR)
UART2 transmit/receive mode register (U2MR)
UART2 communication speed register (U2BRG)
UART2 tranmit buffer register (U2TB)
UART2 transmit/receive control register0 (U2C0)
UART2 transmit/receive control register1 (U2C1)
UART2 receive buffer register (U2RB)
Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited.
Note 2: Nothing is allocated in M306K9F8LRP.
Fig.CA-4 Location of peripheral unit control registers (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 25 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
038016
038116
038216
038316
038416
SFR
Count start flag (TABSR)
Clock prescaler reset flag (CPSRF)
One-shot start flag (ONSF)
Trigger select register (TRGSR)
Up-down flag (UDF)
03C016
03C116
03C216
03C316
03C416
038516
03C516
038616
TimerA0 (TA0)
03C616
TimerA1 (TA1)
03C816
TimerA2 (TA2)
03CA16
038716
038816
038916
038A16
03C716
03C916
038B16
03CB16
038C16
TimerA3 (TA3)
03CC16
038D16
03CD16
038E16
TimerA4 (TA4)
03CE16
TimerB0 (TB0)
03D016
038F16
039016
TimerB1 (TB1)
03D216
TimerB2 (TB2)
03D416
TimerA0 mode register (TA0MR)
TimerA1 mode register (TA1MR)
TimerA2 mode register (TA2MR)
TimerA3 mode register (TA3MR)
TimerA4 mode register (TA4MR)
TimerB0 mode register (TB0MR)
TimerB1 mode register (TB1MR)
TimerB2 mode register (TB2MR)
03D616
039316
039416
039516
039616
039716
039816
039916
039A16
039B16
039C16
039D16
03D716
03D816
03DA16
03A416
03A516
03A616
03A716
03A816
03A916
03AA16
03AB16
03AC16
03AD16
03AE16
03AF16
03B016
03DC16
UART0 transmit/receive mode register (U0MR)
UART0 communication speed register (U0BRG)
UART0 tranmit buffer register (U0TB)
UART0 transmit/receive control register0 (U0C0)
UART0 transmit/receive control register1 (U0C1)
UART0 receive buffer register (U0RB)
UART1 transmit/receive mode register (U1MR)
UART1 communication speed register (U1BRG)
UART1 tranmit buffer register (U1TB)
UART1 transmit/receive control register0 (U1C0)
UART1 transmit/receive control register1 (U1C1)
UART1 receive buffer register (U1RB)
UART transmit/receive control register2 (UCON)
03E016
03E116
03E216
03E316
03E416
03E516
03E616
03E716
03E816
03E916
03EA16
03EB16
03EC16
03ED16
03EE16
03EF16
03F016
03F116
03B216
03F216
03F316
03B316
Flash memory recognition register (FMRR)
Flash memory control register (FMCR)
DMA0 request cacse select register (DM0SL)
A-D control register2 (ADCON2)
A-D control register0 (ADCON0)
A-D control register1 (ADCON1)
D-A register0 (DA0)
D-A register1 (DA1)
D-A control register (DACON)
Comparator control register (CMPCON)
Comparator data register (CMPD)
Port P0 (P0)
Port P1 (P1)
Port P0 direction register (P0D)
Port P1 direction register (P1D)
Port P2 (P2)
Port P3 (P3)
Port P2 direction register (P2D)
Port P3 direction register (P3D)
Port P4 (P4)
Port P5 (P5)
Port P4 direction register (P4D)
Port P5 direction register (P5D)
Port P6 (P6)
Port P7 (P7)
Port P6 direction register (P6D)
Port P7 direction register (P7D)
Port P8 (P8)
Port P9 (P9)
Port P8 direction register (P8D)
Port P9 direction register (P9D)
Port P10 (P10)
Port P10 direction register (P10D)
03F716
03F816
03F916
03B916
03BA16
03F416
03F616
03B616
03B816
A-D register7 (AD7)
03F516
03B516
03B716
A-D register6 (AD6)
03DD16
03B116
03B416
A-D register5 (AD5)
03DB16
03DF16
03A316
A-D register4 (AD4)
03D916
03DE16
03A216
A-D register3 (AD3)
03D516
039F16
03A116
A-D register2 (AD2)
03D316
039E16
03A016
A-D register1 (AD1)
03D116
039116
039216
03CF16
A-D register0 (AD0)
DMA1 request cacse select register (DM1SL)
03FA16
03BB16
03FB16
03BC16
03FC16
03BD16
03FD16
03BE16
03FE16
03BF16
03FF16
Pull-up control register0 (PUR0)
Pull-up control register1 (PUR1)
Pull-up control register2 (PUR2)
Port control register0 (PCR0)
Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited.
Fig.CA-5 Location of peripheral unit control registers (4)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 26 of 290
Software Reset
M16C/6K9 Group
Software Reset
Writing “1” to bit 3 of the processor mode register 0 (address 000416) applies a (software) reset to the
microcomputer. A software reset has almost the same effect as a hardware reset. The contents of internal
RAM are retained.
Processor Mode
(1) Types of Processor Mode
The single-chip mode is supported in processor mode.
• Single-chip mode
In single-chip mode, only internal memory space (SFR, internal RAM, and internal ROM) can be accessed.
Ports P0 to P16 can be used as programmable I/O ports or as I/O ports for the internal peripheral functions.
Fig. BG-1 shows the structure of processor mode register 0 and processor mode register 1.
Processor mode register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0 0 0 0
b2
b1
Symbol
PM0
b0
0
Address
000416
Bit symbol
PM00
Bit name
Processor mode bit
PM01
Reserved bit
PM03
When reset
0016 (Note 2)
Function
b1 b0
0 0: Single-chip mode
0 1: Inhibited
1 0: Inhibited
1 1: Inhibited
Must always be set to “0”
Software reset bit
Reserved bit
The device is reset when this bit is set
to “1”. The value of this bit is “0” when
read.
Must always be set to “0”
AA
A
AA
A
R W
Note 1: Set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” when writing new
values to this register.
Processor mode register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
0 0 0
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
PM1
Address
000516
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
00000XX02
Function
Must always be set to “0”
Reserved bit
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Must always be set to “0”
Reserved bit
PM17
Wait bit
0 : No wait state
1 : Wait state inserted
A
AA
A
Note 1: Set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” when writing new
values to this register.
Fig.BG-1 Processor mode register 0 and 1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 27 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
Bus control
Bus control
(1) Software wait
A software wait can be inserted by setting the wait bit (bit 7) of the processor mode register 1 (address
000516) (Note) .
A software wait is inserted in the internal ROM/RAM area by setting the wait bit of the processor mode
register 1. When set to “0”, each bus cycle is executed in one BCLK cycle. When set to “1”, each bus cycle
is executed in 2 BCLK cycles. After the microcomputer has been reset, this bit defaults to “0”.
Set this bit after referring to the recommended operating conditions (main clock input oscillation frequency)
of the electric characteristics.
The SFR area is always accessed in two BCLK cycles regardless of the setting of these control bits.
Table.EF-1 shows the software wait and bus cycles. Fig.EF-1 shows example bus timing when using software waits.
Note: Before attempting to change the contents of the processor mode register 1, set bit 1 of the protect
register (address 000A16) to “1”.
Table.EF-1 Software waits and bus cycles
Bus cycle
Area
Wait bit
SFR
Invalid
2 BCLK cycles
0
1 BCLK cycle
1
2 BCLK cycles
Internal
ROM/RAM
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 28 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Bus control
No wait
Bus cycle
Bus cycle
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
Output
Data bus
Address bus
Address
Input
Address
Chip select
With wait
Bus cycle
Bus cycle
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
Data bus
Address bus
Input
Output
Address
Address
Chip select
Note 1: This timing sample shows the lenth of bus cycle. It is possible that the read cyles, write cycle
comes after this cycle in succession.
Fig.EF-1 Typical bus timings using software wait
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 29 of 290
Clock Generating Circuit
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock Generating Circuit
The clock generating circuit contains two oscillator circuits that supply the operating clock sources to the
CPU and internal peripheral units.
Table.WA-1 Main clock and sub clock generating circuits
Main clock generating circuit
Sub clock generating circuit
• CPU’s operating clock source
• CPU’s operating clock source
• Internal peripheral units’
• Timer A/B’s count clock
operating clock source
source
Ceramic or crystal oscillator
Crystal oscillator
XIN, XOUT
XCIN, XCOUT
Available
Available
Oscillating
Stopped
Externally derived clock can be input
Use of clock
Usable oscillator
Pins to connect oscillator
Oscillation stop/restart function
Oscillator status immediately after reset
Other
Example of oscillator circuit
Fig.WA-1 shows some examples of the main clock circuit, one using an oscillator connected to the circuit,
and the other one using an externally derived clock for input. Figure WA-2 shows some examples of sub
clock circuits, one using an oscillator connected to the circuit, and the other one using an externally derived
clock for input. Circuit constants in Fig.WA-1 and WA-2 vary with each oscillator used. Use the values
recommended by the manufacturer of your oscillator.
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
(Built-in feedback resistor)
(Built-in feedback resistor)
XIN
XIN
XOUT
XOUT
Open
(Note)
Rd
Externally derived clock
CIN
COUT
Vcc
Vss
Note: Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive
capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable.
Apply the feedback register between XIN and XOUT if required by oscillator maker.
Fig.WA-1 Examples of main clock
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
(Built-in feedback resistor)
(Built-in feedback resistor)
XCIN
XCOUT
XCIN
XCOUT
Open
(Note)
RCd
Externally derived clock
CCIN
CCOUT
Vcc
Vss
Note: Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive
capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable.
Apply the feedback register between XCIN and XCOUT if required by oscillator maker.
Fig.WA-2 Examples of sub clock
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 30 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock Generating Circuit
Clock Control
Fig.WA-3 shows the block diagram of the clock generating circuit.
XCOUT
XCIN
fC32
1/32
f1
CM04
f1SIO2
fAD
fC
f8SIO2
f8
Sub clock
f32SIO2
CM10 “1”
Write signal
f32
S Q
XIN
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
XOUT
b
R
a
RESET
Software reset
NMI
d
CM07=0
BCLK
fC
CM07=1
Main clock
CM02
CM05
Interrupt request
level judgment
output
c
Divider
S Q
WAIT instruction
R
c
b
a
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=11
CM06=1
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=10
d
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=01
CM06=0
CM17,CM16=00
CM0i : Bit i at address 000616
CM1i : Bit i at address 000716
WDCi : Bit i at address 000F16
Fig.WA-3 Clock generating circuit
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 31 of 290
Details of divider
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock Generating Circuit
The following paragraphs describes the clocks generated by the clock generating circuit.
(1) Main clock
The main clock is generated by the main clock oscillation circuit. After a reset, the clock is divided by 8 to
the BCLK. The clock can be stopped using the main clock stop bit (bit 5 at address 000616). After switching
the CPU operation clock to sub clock stopping the clock reduces the power dissipation.
After the oscillation of the main clock oscillation circuit has stabilized, the drive capacity of the main clock
oscillation circuit can be reduced using the XIN-XOUT drive capacity select bit (bit 5 at address 000716).
Reducing the drive capacity of the main clock oscillation circuit reduces the power dissipation. This bit defaults to “1” when shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode and after a reset.
(2) Sub clock
The sub clock is generated by the sub clock oscillation circuit. No sub clock is generated after a reset. After
oscillation is started using the port Xc select bit (bit 4 at address 000616), the sub clock can be selected as
the BCLK by using the system clock select bit (bit 7 at address 000616). However, be sure that the sub clock
oscillation has fully stabilized before switching.
After the oscillation of the sub clock oscillation circuit has stabilized, the drive capacity of the sub clock
oscillation circuit can be reduced using the XCIN-XCOUT drive capacity select bit (bit 3 at address 000616).
Reducing the drive capacity of the sub clock oscillation circuit reduces the power dissipation. This bit
changes to “1” when shifting to stop mode and at a reset.
(3) BCLK
The BCLK is the clock that drives the CPU, and is either the main clock or fc or is derived by dividing the main
clock by 2, 4, 8, or 16. The BCLK is derived by dividing the main clock by 8 after a reset.
When shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode, the main clock division select bit (bit
6 at 000616) is set to “1”. The bit maintains in low speed mode and low power save mode.
(4) Peripheral function clock
f1, f8, f32, f1SIO2, f8SIO2, f32SIO2, fAD
The clock for the peripheral devices is derived from the main clock or by dividing it by 8 or 32. The peripheral
function clock is stopped by stopping the main clock or by setting the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit
(bit 2 at 000616) to “1” and then executing a WAIT instruction.
(5) fC32
This clock is derived by dividing the sub clock by 32. It is used for the timer A and timer B counts.
(6) fC
This clock has the same frequency as the sub clock. It is used for the BCLK and for the watchdog timer.
Fig.WA-4 shows the system clock control registers 0 and 1.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 32 of 290
Clock Generating Circuit
M16C/6K9 Group
System clock control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CM0
Address
000616
Bit symbol
CM00
Bit name
Clock output function
select bit
CM01
CM02
CM03
CM04
When reset
4816
WAIT peripheral function
clock stop bit
XCIN-XCOUT drive capacity
select bit (Note 2)
Port XC select bit
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : I/O port P57
0 1 : fC output
1 0 : f8 output
1 1 : f32 output
AA
A
AAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AAA
AAA
AA
AAAA
RW
0 :Do not stop peripheral clock in wait mode
1 :Stop peripheral clock in wait mode (Note8)
0 : LOW
1 : HIGH
0 : I/O port
1 : XCIN-XCOUT generation
CM05
Main clock (XIN-XOUT)
stop bit
(Note 3) (Note 4) (Note 5)
0 : On
1 : Off
CM06
Main clock division select
bit 0 (Note 7)
0 : CM16 and CM17 valid
1 : Division by 8 mode
CM07
System clock select bit
(Note 6)
0 : XIN, XOUT
1 : XCIN, XCOUT
Note 1: Set bit 0 of the protect register (address 000A16) to "1" before writing to this register.
Note 2: Changes to "1" when shiffing to stop mode.
Note 3: When entering power saving mode, main clock stops using this bit. When returning from stop
mode and operating with XIN, set this bit to "0". When main clock oscillation is operating by
itself, set system clock select bit (CM07) to "1" before setting this bit to "1".
Note 4: When inputting external clock, only clock oscillation buffer is stopped and clock input is acceptable.
Note 5: If this bit is set to "1", XOUT turns "H". The built-in feedback resistor remains ON, so XIN turns pulled
up to XOUT ("H") via the feedback resistor.
Note 6: In the case of setting the bit from "0" to "1", set port XC select bit (CM04) to "1" and wait for the
subclock being stable before wrting the bit. Don't write in the same time.
In the case of setting the bit from "1" to "0", set main clock stop bit (CM05) to "0" and wait for the main
clock being stable before write the bit.
Note 7: The bit is set to "1" when shifting from high speed mode or mid speed mode to stop mode and after reset.
The bit maintains in low speed mode and power save mode.
Note 8: fc32 is not included. Do not set to "1" when using low-speed or low power dissipation mode.
System clock control register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
0
0
0
0
b0
Symbol
CM1
Address
000716
Bit symbol
CM10
When reset
2016
Bit name
All clock stop control bit
(Note4)
Function
0 : Clock on
1 : All clocks off (stop mode)
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
Always set to “0”
Reserved bit
CM15
XIN-XOUT drive capacity
select bit (Note 2)
CM16
Main clock division
select bit 1 (Note 3)
Always set to “0”
0 : LOW
1 : HIGH
b7 b6
CM17
0 0 : No division mode
0 1 : Division by 2 mode
1 0 : Division by 4 mode
1 1 : Division by 16 mode
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AAA
Note 1: Set bit 0 of the protect register (address 000A16) to "1" before writing to this register.
Note 2: Changes to "1" when shiffing to stop mode.
Note 3: Can be selected when bit 6 of the system clock control register 0 (address 000616) is "0".
If "1", division mode is fixed at 8.
Note 4: If this bit is set to "1", XOUT turns "H", and the built-in feedback resistor turns null.
Fig.WA-4 System clock control registers 0 and 1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 33 of 290
RW
Clock Generating Circuit
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock Output
In single-chip mode, the clock output function select bits (bits 0 and 1 at address 000616) enable f8, f32, or fc
to be output from the P57/CLKOUT pin. When the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit (bit 2 at address
000616) is set to “1”, the output of f8 and f32 stops when a WAIT instruction is executed.
By setting the f1 output function selection bits (bit0 and bit1 of address 02F116) ,f1 can be output via P110
and P111.
By setting P110 output clock selection bit (bit7 of address 02F816), the clock output via P110 can be selected
to f1 or fc.
Stop Mode
Writing “1” to the all-clock stop control bit (bit 0 at address 000716) stops all oscillation and the microcomputer enters stop mode. In stop mode, the content of the internal RAM is retained provided that VCC remains
above 2V.
The oscillation , BCLK, f1 to f32, f1SIO2 to f32SIO2, fC, fC32, and fAD stop in stop mode, peripheral functions
such as the A-D converter and watchdog timer do not function. However, timer A andºº timer B operate
provided that the event counter mode is set to an external pulse, and UARTi(i = 0 to 2) ,SIO3,4 functions
provided an external clock is selected. Table.WA-2 shows the status of the ports in stop mode.
Stop mode is cancelled by a hardware reset or interrupt. If an interrupt is to be used to cancel stop mode, that
interrupt must first have been enabled.After the restoration by interrupt, the corresponding interrupt routine
will be processed.When shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode, the main clock
division select bit 0 (bit 6 at 000616) is set to “1”.
Table.WA-2 Port status during stop mode
Pin
Port
CLKOUT
Rev.1.00
When fc selected
When f8, f32 selected
Jun 06, 2003
page 34 of 290
Single-chip mode
Retains status before stop mode
“H”
Retains status before stop mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Wait Mode
Wait Mode
When a WAIT instruction is executed, the BCLK stops and the microcomputer enters the wait mode. In this
mode, oscillation continues but the BCLK and watchdog timer stop. Writing “1” to the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit and executing a WAIT instruction stops the clock being supplied to the internal peripheral
functions, allowing power dissipation to be reduced. However, because the peripheral function clock (fc32)
that is generated by sub clock does not stop, there is no reducing of power dissipation. Do not set the bit to
"1" then enter wait mode in low speed mode and low power dissipation mode.Table.WA-3 shows the status
of the ports in wait mode.
Wait mode is cancelled by a hardware reset or interrupt. If an interrupt is used to cancel wait mode, the
microcomputer restarts from interrupt routine using as BCLK, the clock that had been selected when the
WAIT instruction was executed.
Table.WA-3 Port status during wait mode
Pin
Single-chip mode
CLKOUT
When fC selected
Does not stop
When f8, f32 selected Does not stop when the WAIT peripheral function clock stop
bit is “0”.
When the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit is “1”, the
status immediately prior to entering wait mode is maintained.
Port
Rev.1.00
maintained the status immediately prior to enterig wait mode
Jun 06, 2003
page 35 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Status Transition Of BCLK
Status Transition Of BCLK
Power dissipation can be reduced and low-voltage operation achieved by changing the count source for
BCLK. Table.WA-4 shows the operating modes corresponding to the settings of system clock control registers 0 and 1.
After a reset, operation defaults to division by 8 mode. When shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed
mode to stop mode, and after a reset main clock division select bit 0 (bit 6 at address 000616) is set to “1”. It
is matained in low speed mode and low power dissipation mode.
(1) Division by 2 mode
The main clock is divided by 2 to obtain the BCLK.
(2) Division by 4 mode
The main clock is divided by 4 to obtain the BCLK.
(3) Division by 8 mode
The main clock is divided by 8 to obtain the BCLK. After reset, it works in this mode. Note that oscillation of
the main clock must have stabilized before transferring from this mode to No-division, Division by 2 and
Division by 4 mode. Oscillation of the sub clock must have stabilized before transferring this mode to Lowspeed mode and Low power dissipation mode.
(4) Division by 16 mode
The main clock is divided by 16 to obtain the BCLK.
(5) No-division mode
The main clock is used as the BCLK.
(6) Low-speed mode
fC is used as the BCLK. Note that oscillation of both the main and sub clocks must have stabilized before
transferring from this mode to another or vice versa. At least 2 to 3 seconds are required after the sub clock
starts. Therefore, the program must be written to wait until this clock has stabilized immediately after powering up and after stop mode is cancelled.
(7) Low power dissipation mode
fC is the BCLK and the main clock is stopped.
Precaution
In the case of switching the BCLK count source from XIN to XCIN, or from XCIN to XIN, it is necessary that the
destination clock count source be stable. The transition should be waited by software after the oscillation
being stable.
Table.WA-4 Operating modes dictated by settings of system clock control registers 0 and 1
CM17
CM16
CM07
CM06
CM05
CM04
0
1
Invalid
1
0
Invalid
Invalid
1
0
Invalid
1
0
Invalid
Invalid
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
Invalid
Invalid
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Invalid
Invalid
Invalid
Invalid
Invalid
1
1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 36 of 290
Operating mode of BCLK
Division by 2 mode
Division by 4 mode
Division by 8 mode
Division by 16 mode
No-division mode
Low-speed mode
Low power dissipation mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Power control
Power control
The following is a description of the power control modes:
Modes
Power control is available in three modes.
(1) Normal operation mode
• High-speed mode
Divide-by-1 frequency of the main clock becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates with the internal clock
selected. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock.
• Medium-speed mode
Divide-by-2, divide-by-4, divide-by-8, or divide-by-16 frequency of the main clock becomes the BCLK. The
CPU operates according to the internal clock selected. Each peripheral function operates according to its
assigned clock.
• Low-speed mode
fC becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates according to the fc clock. The fc clock is supplied by the sub clock.
Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock.
• Low power consumption mode
The main clock operating in low-speed mode is stopped. The CPU operates according to the fC clock. The
fc clock is supplied by the sub clock. The only peripheral functions that operate are those with the sub-clock
selected as the count source.
(2) Wait mode
The CPU operation is stopped. The oscillators do not stop.
(3) Stop mode
All oscillators stop. The CPU and all built-in peripheral functions stop. This mode, among the three modes
listed here, is the most effective in decreasing power consumption.
Fig.WA-5 is the state transition diagram of (1) to (3).
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 37 of 290
Power control
M16C/6K9 Group
Transition of stop mode, wait mode
Reset
All oscillators stop
WAIT
command
CM10 = “1”
Medium-speed mode
(Divided-by-8 mode)
Stop mode
Interrupt
Wait mode
Interrupt
Interrupt
WAIT
command
All oscillators stop
CM10 = “1”
High-speed/mediumspeed mode
Stop mode
All oscillators stop
Wait mode
WAIT
command
low-speed/low power
dissipation mode
Interrupt
CPU operation stop
Interrupt
CM10 = “1”
Stop mode
CPU operation stop
CPU operation stop
Wait mode
Interrupt
Normal mode
(Please see the diagram below on transition of normal mode)
Transition of normal mode
Main clock oscillation
Sub clock stop
Medium-speed mode (divided-by-8 mode)
BCLK : f(XIN)/8
CM06 = “1”
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “1”
CM07 = “0” Note 1
CM06 = “1”
CM04 = “0”
Main clock is oscillating
Sub clock is oscillating
High-speed mode
BCLK : f(XIN)
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “0” CM16 = “0”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-4)
BCLK : f(XIN)/4
CM07 = “0”
CM17 = “1”
CM06 = “0”
CM16 = “0”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-2)
BCLK : f(XIN)/2
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “0” CM16 = “1”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-8)
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-16)
BCLK : f(XIN)/8
CM07 = “0”
CM06 = “1”
CM07 = “0”
Note1,Note3
CM05 = “0”
CM04 = “1”
CM07 = “1” Note 2
CM05 = “1”
Main clock is oscillating
Sub clock is stop
High-speed mode
BCLK : f(XIN)
CM06 = “0”
Note1,Note3
CM06 = “0”
CM16 = “0”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-4)
BCLK: f(XIN)/4
CM07 = “0”
CM17 = “1”
CM06 = “0”
CM16 = “0”
CM07 = “0”
CM17 = “0”
Jun 06, 2003
page 38 of 290
Main clock is stop
Sub clock is oscillating
CM07 = “0” Note 1
CM06 = “0” Note 3
CM04 = “1”
BCLK : f(XCIN)
CM07 = “1”
CM06 = “0”
CM16 = “1”
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-16)
BCLK : f(XIN)/16
CM07 = “0”
CM17 = “1”
CM05 = “1”
Low power dissipation mode
Medium-speed mode
(divided-by-2)
BCLK : f(XIN)/2
CM06 = “0”
CM16 = “1”
Note 1:
Note 2:
Note 3:
Note 4:
Fig.WA-5 State transition diagram of Power control mode
Rev.1.00
BCLK : f(XCIN)
CM07 = “1”
BCLK : f(XIN)/16
CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0”
CM17 = “1” CM16 = “1”
CM04 = “0”
CM07 = “0”
CM17 = “0”
CM07 = “1”
Note2
Main clock is oscillating
Sub clock is oscillating
Low-speed mode
Please switch after the main clock oscillation being stable.
Please switch after the sub clock oscillation being stable.
Please change the CM06 after CM16,CM17 being changed.
Please transit following the arrow direction.
Protection
M16C/6K9 Group
Protection
The protection function is provided so that the values in important registers cannot be changed in the event
that the program runs out of control. Fig.WA-6 shows the protect register. The values in the processor mode
register 0 (address 000416), processor mode register 1 (address 000516), system clock control register 0
(address 000616), system clock control register 1 (address 000716) can only be changed when the respective bit in the protect register is set to “1”.
Protect register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
PRCR
Address
000A16
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
XXXXX0002
Function
PRC0
Enables writing to system clock
control registers 0 and 1 (addresses 0 : Write-inhibited
1 : Write-enabled
000616 and 000716)
PRC1
Enables writing to processor mode
registers 0 and 1 (addresses 000416 0 : Write-inhibited
1 : Write-enabled
and 000516)
Reserved bit
Must be "0"
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
Fig.WA-6 Protect register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 39 of 290
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
AA
R W
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Type of Interrupts
Fig.DD-1 lists the types of interrupts.










Hardware
Special
Peripheral I/O (Note)
















Interrupt
Software
Undefined instruction (UND instruction)
Overflow (INTO instruction)
BRK instruction
INT instruction
Reset
NMI
________
DBC
Watchdog timer
Single step
Address matched
_______
Note: Peripheral I/O interrupts are generated by the peripheral functions built into the microcomputer system.
Fig.DD-1 Classification of interrupts
• Maskable interrupt : An interrupt which can be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag
(I flag) or whose interrupt priority can be changed by priority level.
• Non-maskable interrupt : An interrupt which cannot be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag
(I flag) or whose interrupt priority cannot be changed by priority level.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 40 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Software Interrupts
A software interrupt occurs when executing certain instructions. Software interrupts are non-maskable interrupts.
• Undefined instruction interrupt
An undefined instruction interrupt occurs when executing the UND instruction.
• Overflow interrupt
An overflow interrupt occurs when executing the INTO instruction with the overflow flag (O flag) set to “1”.
The following are instructions whose O flag changes by arithmetic:
ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, CMP, DIV, DIVU, DIVX, NEG, RMPA, SBB, SHA, SUB
• BRK interrupt
A BRK interrupt occurs when executing the BRK instruction.
• INT interrupt
An INT interrupt occurs when assigning one of software interrupt numbers 0 through 63 and executing the
INT instruction. Software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 are assigned to peripheral I/O interrupts, so executing the INT instruction allows executing the same interrupt routine that a peripheral I/O interrupt does.
The stack pointer (SP) used for the INT interrupt is dependent on which software interrupt number is involved.
So far as software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 are concerned, the microcomputer saves the stack pointer
assignment flag (U flag) when it accepts an interrupt request. If change the U flag to “0” and select the
interrupt stack pointer (ISP), and then execute an interrupt sequence. When returning from the interrupt
routine, the U flag is returned to the state it was before the acceptance of interrupt request. So far as
software numbers 32 through 63 are concerned, the stack pointer does not make a shift.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 41 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Hardware Interrupts
Hardware interrupts are classified into two types — special interrupts and peripheral I/O interrupts.
(1) Special interrupts
Special interrupts are non-maskable interrupts.
• Reset
____________
Reset occurs if an “L” is input to the RESET pin.
_______
• NMI interrupt
_______
_______
An NMI interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to the NMI pin.
________
• DBC interrupt
This interrupt is exclusively for the debugger, do not use it in other circumstances.
• Watchdog timer interrupt
Generated by the watchdog timer.
• Single-step interrupt
This interrupt is exclusively for the debugger, do not use it in other circumstances. With the debug flag (D
flag) set to “1”, a single-step interrupt occurs after one instruction is executed.
• Address match interrupt
An address match interrupt occurs immediately before the instruction held in the address indicated by the
address match interrupt register is executed with the address match interrupt enable bit set to “1”.
If an address other than the first address of the instruction in the address match interrupt register is set, no
address match interrupt occurs.
(2) Peripheral I/O interrupts
A peripheral I/O interrupt is generated by one of built-in peripheral functions. Built-in peripheral functions are
dependent on classes of products, so the interrupt factors are also dependent on classes of products. The
interrupt vector table is the same as the one for software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 the INT instruction
uses. Peripheral I/O interrupts are maskable interrupts.
1)Bus collision detection interrupt
This is an interrupt that the serial I/O bus collision detection generates.
2)DMA0 interrupt, DMA1 interrupt
These are interrupts that DMA generates.
3)Key-input interrupt 0
___
A key-input interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to the KI pin.
4) Key-input interrupt 1
___
A key-input interrupt occurs if an “L” or “H” is input to the KI pin.
5)A-D conversion interrupt
This is an interrupt that the A-D converter generates.
6)UART0, UART1, UART2/NACK, SI/O3 and SI/O4 transmission interrupt
These are interrupts that the serial I/O transmission generates.
7)UART0, UART1, UART2/ACK, SI/O3 and SI/O4 reception interrupt
These are interrupts that the serial I/O reception generates.
8)Timer A0 interrupt through timer A4 interrupt
These are interrupts that timer A generates
9)Timer B0 interrupt through timer B5 interrupt
These are interrupts that timer B generates.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 42 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
________
Interrupt
__________
10)INT0 interrupt through INT11 interrupt
______
______
An INT interrupt occurs if either a rising edge or a falling edge or both edges are input to the INT pin.
11)IBF0 to IBF3 interrupt
These are interrupts that host bus interface generates.
______________
12) LRESET interrupt
______________
______________
LRESET interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to LRESET pin.
13)I2C0,I2C1,I2C2,SCL0,SDA0,SCL1,SDA1,SCL2, SDA2 interrupt
These are interrupts that I2C bus interface generates.
14)PS20 to PS22 interrupt
These are interrupt that PS2 interface generates.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 43 of 290
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupts and Interrupt Vector Tables
If an interrupt request is accepted, a program branches to the interrupt routine set in the interrupt vector
table. Set the first address of the interrupt routine in each vector table. Fig.DD-2 shows the format for
specifying the address.
Two types of interrupt vector tables are available — fixed vector table in which addresses are fixed and
variable vector table in which addresses can be varied by the setting.
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAA
LSB
MSB
Vector address + 0
Low address
Mid address
Vector address + 1
Vector address + 2
0000
High address
0000
0000
Fig.DD-2 Format for specifying interrupt vector addresses
• Fixed vector tables
The fixed vector table is a table in which addresses are fixed. The vector tables are located in an area
extending from FFFDC16 to FFFFF16. One vector table comprises four bytes. Set the first address of
interrupt routine in each vector table. Table.DD-1 shows the interrupts assigned to the fixed vector tables
and addresses of vector tables.
Table.DD-1 Interrupts assigned to the fixed vector tables and addresses of vector tables
Interrupt source
Undefined instruction
Overflow
BRK instruction
Vector table addresses
Address (L) to address (H)
FFFDC16 to FFFDF16
FFFE016 to FFFE316
FFFE416 to FFFE716
Remarks
Interrupt on UND instruction
Interrupt on INTO instruction
If the vector contains FF16, program execution starts from
the address shown by the vector in the variable vector table
There is an address-matching interrupt enable bit
Do not use
Address match
FFFE816 to FFFEB16
Single step (Note)
FFFEC16 to FFFEF16
Watchdog timer
FFFF016 to FFFF316
________
DBC (Note)
FFFF416 to FFFF716
Do not use
_______
_______
NMI
FFFF816 to FFFFB16
External interrupt by input to NMI pin
Reset
FFFFC16 to FFFFF16
Note: Interrupts used for debugging purposes only.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 44 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
• Variable vector tables
The addresses in the variable vector table can be modified, according to the user’s settings. The start
address of vector table is set to the interrupt table register (INTB). The 256-byte area subsequent that the
start address is indicated by the INTB becomes the area for the variable vector tables. One vector table
comprises 4 bytes. Set the first address of the interrupt routine in each vector table. Table.DD-2 shows the
interrupts assigned to the variable vector tables and addresses of vector tables.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 45 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Table.DD-2 Interrupts assigned to the variable vector tables and addresses of vector
Software interrupt number
Vector table address
Interrupt source
Remarks
Address (L) to address (H)
Software interrupt number 0
+0 to +3 (Note 1)
BRK instruction
Software interrupt number 1
+4 to +7 (Note 1)
I2
Cannot be masked by I flag
Software interrupt number 2
+8 to +11 (Note 1)
SCL2, SDA2/DMA0 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 3
+12 to +15 (Note 1)
Timer B5/LRESET
Software interrupt number 4
+16 to +19 (Note 1)
INT3
Software interrupt number 5
+20 to +23 (Note 1)
INT9
Software interrupt number 6
+24 to +27 (Note 1)
Timer B4/UART1 reception/SIO4 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 7
+28 to +31 (Note 1)
Timer B3/UART1 transmission (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 8
+32 to +35 (Note 1)
SIO4/INT6
(Note 3)
Software interrupt number 9
+36 to +39 (Note 1)
SIO3/INT5
(Note 3)
Software interrupt number 10
+40 to +43 (Note 1)
Bus collision detection/INT4 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 11
+44 to +47 (Note 1)
INT8
Software interrupt number 12
+48 to +51 (Note 1)
DMA1/INT7
Software interrupt number 13
+52 to +55 (Note 1)
Key input interrupt 0
Software interrupt number 14
+56 to +59 (Note 1)
A-D
Software interrupt number 15
+60 to +63 (Note 1)
UART2 transmit/IBF0 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 16
+64 to +67 (Note 1)
UART2 receive/IBF1 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 17
+68 to +71 (Note 1)
UART0 transmit/I2C0 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 18
+72 to +75 (Note 1)
UART0 receive/SCL0,SDA0/INT11 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 19
+76 to +79 (Note 1)
UART1 transmit/I2C1 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 20
+80 to +83 (Note 1)
UART1 receive/SCL1,SDA1/INT10 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 21
+84 to +87 (Note 1)
Timer A0
Software interrupt number 22
+88 to +91 (Note 1)
Timer A1/INT7/SIO3 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 23
+92 to +95 (Note 1)
Timer A2
Software interrupt number 24
+96 to +99 (Note 1)
Timer A3/IBF2
(Note 2)
Software interrupt number 25
+100 to +103 (Note 1)
Timer A4/IBF3
(Note 2)
Software interrupt number 26
+104 to +107 (Note 1)
Timer B0/INT11/SCL0,SDA0 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 27
+108 to +111 (Note 1)
Timer B1/INT10/SCL1,SDA1 (Note 3)
Software interrupt number 28
+112 to +115 (Note 1)
Timer B2/Key input interrupt 1 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 29
+116 to +119 (Note 1)
INT0/PS20 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 30
+120 to +123 (Note 1)
INT1/PS21 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 31
+124 to +127 (Note 1)
INT2/PS22 (Note 2)
Software interrupt number 32
+128 to +131 (Note 1)
to
Software interrupt number 63
to
+252 to +255 (Note 1)
C2
(Note 2)
(Note 3)
Software interrupt
Cannot be masked by I flag
Note 1: Address relative to address in interrupt table register (INTB).
Note 2: It is selected by interrupt request cause bit.
Note 3: Depend on interrupt event selection bit setting. Please do not set same interrupt
event at the same time.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 46 of 290
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt Control
Descriptions are given here regarding how to enable or disable maskable interrupts and how to set the
priority to be accepted. What is described here does not apply to non-maskable interrupts.
Enable or disable a maskable interrupt using the interrupt enable flag (I flag), interrupt priority level selection
bits and processor interrupt priority level (IPL). Whether an interrupt request is present or absent is indicated
by the interrupt request bit. The interrupt request bit and the interrupt priority level selection bits are located
in the interrupt control register of each interrupt. The interrupt enable flag (I flag) and the IPL are located in
the flag register (FLG).
Fig.DD-3 and DD-4 shows the memory map of the interrupt control registers.
The interrupt factors in the same vector share the same interrupt control register. Which factor to be used
depends on interrupt factor selection bit of interrupt event selection register i(address:035F16 ,035616,
to 035816, i = 0 to 3) setting. After setting the interrupt factor, the corresponding interrupt request bit must be
set to "0" before changing the interrupt.
Interrupt control register
AAA
AA
A
AAAA
AA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
IIC2IC
SCLDA2IC/DM0IC
TB5IC/LRSTIC
TB4IC/S1RIC/S4IC
TB3IC/S1TIC
KUP0IC
ADIC
S2TIC/IBF0IC
S2RIC/IBF1IC
SiTIC/IICjIC(i=0,1)
(j=0,1)
TAiIC(i=0,2)
TAiIC/IBFjIC(i=3,4)
(j=2,3)
TB2IC/KUP1IC
b0
Bit symbol
ILVL0
Address
004116
004216
004316
004616
004716
004D16
004E16
004F16
005016
005116,005316
005116,005316
005516,005716
005816,005916
005816,005916
005C16
Bit name
Interrupt priority level
select bit
ILVL1
ILVL2
IR
Interrupt request bit
When reset
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
XXXXX0002
Function
b2 b1 b0
000:
001:
010:
011:
100:
101:
110:
111:
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Level 4
Level 5
Level 6
Level 7
0 : Interrupt not requested
1 : Interrupt requested
Nothing is assigned.
Note 1: Can only be writing by “0” (Please do not write “1” to this bit)
Fig.DD-3 Interrupt control registers(1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 47 of 290
AA
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
R
W
(Note 1)
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
AAA
A
AA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
INTiIC(i=3,9,8)
004416,004516,004B16
SiIC/INTjIC(i=4,3)
004816,004916
(j=6,5)
004816,004916
BCNIC/INT4IC
004A16
DM1IC/INT7IC
004C16
SiRIC/SCLDAjIC/INTkIC(i=0,1)
005216,005416
(j=0,1)
005216,005416
(k=11,10)
005216,005416
TA1IC/INT7IC/S3IC
005616
TBiIC/INTjIC/SCLDAkIC(i=0,1)
005A16,005B16
(j=11,10)
005A16,005B16
(k=0,1)
005A16,005B16
INTiIC/PS2jIC(i=0 to 2)
005D16 to 005F16
(j=0 to 2)
005D16 to 005F16
Bit symbol
ILVL0
Bit name
Interrupt priority level
select bit
ILVL1
ILVL2
IR
POL
Interrupt request bit
Polarity select bit
Reserved bit
Function
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
0 0 1 : Level 1
0 1 0 : Level 2
0 1 1 : Level 3
1 0 0 : Level 4
1 0 1 : Level 5
1 1 0 : Level 6
1 1 1 : Level 7
0: Interrupt not requested
1: Interrupt requested
0 : Selects falling edge
1 : Selects rising edge
Always set to “0”
Nothing is assigned.
Note 1: Can only be written by "0" (Please do not write "1" to this bit)
Fig.DD-4 Interrupt control registers (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 48 of 290
When reset
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
XX00X0002
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
R
W
(Note 1)
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt Enable Flag (I flag)
The interrupt enable flag (I flag) controls the enabling and disabling of maskable interrupts. Setting this flag
to “1” enables all maskable interrupts; setting it to “0” disables all maskable interrupts. This flag is set to “0”
after reset.
Interrupt Request Bit
The interrupt request bit is set to "1" by hardware when an interrupt is requested. After the interrupt is
accepted and jumps to the corresponding interrupt vector, the request bit is set to "0" by hardware. The
interrupt request bit can also be set to "0" by software. (Do not set this bit to "1").
Interrupt Priority Level Select Bits and Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL)
Set the interrupt priority level using the interrupt priority level select bits in the interrupt control register.
When an interrupt request occurs, the interrupt priority level is compared with the IPL. The interrupt is enabled only when the priority level of the interrupt is higher than the IPL. Therefore, setting the interrupt
priority level to “0” disables the interrupt.
Table.DD-3 shows the settings of interrupt priority levels and Table.DD-4 shows the interrupt levels enabled,
according to the consist of the IPL.
The following are conditions under which an interrupt is accepted:
· interrupt enable flag (I flag) = 1
· interrupt request bit = 1
· interrupt priority level > processor interrupt priority level (IPL)
The interrupt enable flag (I flag), the interrupt request bit, the interrupt priority select bits, and the IPL are
independent, and they are not affected each other.
Table.DD-3 Settings of interrupt priority
levels
Interrupt priority
level select bit
Interrupt priority
level
Table.DD-4 Interrupt levels enabled according
to the contents of the IPL
Priority
order
b2 b1 b0
IPL
Enabled interrupt priority levels
IPL2 IPL1 IPL0
0
0
0
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
0
0
1
Level 1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
Interrupt levels 1 and above are enabled
0
0
1
Interrupt levels 2 and above are enabled
Level 2
0
1
0
Interrupt levels 3 and above are enabled
1
Level 3
0
1
1
Interrupt levels 4 and above are enabled
0
0
Level 4
1
0
0
Interrupt levels 5 and above are enabled
1
0
1
Level 5
1
0
1
Interrupt levels 6 and above are enabled
1
1
0
Level 6
1
1
0
Interrupt levels 7 and above are enabled
1
1
1
Level 7
1
1
1
All maskable interrupts are disabled
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 49 of 290
Low
High
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Rewrite the interrupt control register
To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that
register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occurrence, rewrite the interrupt control register after
the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow:
Example 1:
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
NOP
NOP
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 2:
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
MOV.W MEM, R0
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Dummy read.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 3:
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
POPC FLG
; Push Flag register onto stack
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Enable interrupts.
The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted
before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the
interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue.
When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled, the interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated. This
will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the register.
Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 50 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Interrupt Sequence
An interrupt sequence — what are performed over a period from the instant an interrupt is accepted to the
instant the interrupt routine is executed — is described here.
If an interrupt occurs during execution of an instruction, the processor determines its priority when the execution of the instruction is completed, and transfers control to the interrupt sequence from the next cycle. If an
interrupt occurs during execution of either the SMOVB, SMOVF, SSTR or RMPA instruction, the processor
temporarily suspends the instruction being executed, and transfers control to the interrupt sequence.
In the interrupt sequence, the processor carries out the following in sequence given:
(1) CPU gets the interrupt information (the interrupt number and interrupt request level) by reading address
0000016.
(2) Saves the content of the flag register (FLG) as it was immediately before the start of interrupt sequence
in the temporary register (Note) within the CPU.
(3) Sets the interrupt enable flag (I flag), the debug flag (D flag), and the stack pointer select flag (U flag) to
“0” (the U flag, however does not change if the INT instruction, in software interrupt numbers 32 through 63,
is executed)
(4) Saves the content of the temporary register (Note) within the CPU in the stack area.
(5) Saves the content of the program counter (PC) in the stack area.
(6) Sets the interrupt priority level of the accepted instruction in the IPL.
After the procession of interrupt sequence the processor executes instructions from the first address of the
interrupt routine.
Note: This register cannot be utilized by the user.
Interrupt Response Time
'Interrupt response time' is the period between the instant an interrupt occurs and the instant the first instruction within the interrupt routine has been executed. This time comprises the period from the occurrence of
an interrupt to the completion of the instruction under execution at that moment (a) and the time required for
executing the interrupt sequence (b). Fig.DD-5 shows the interrupt response time.
Interrupt request generated
Interrupt request acknowledged
Time
Instruction
(a)
Interrupt sequence
(b)
Interrupt response time
Fig.DD-5 Interrupt response time
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 51 of 290
Instruction in
interrupt routine
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Time (a) is dependent on the instruction under execution. 30 cycles is the maximum required for the DIVX
instruction (without wait).
Time (b) is as shown in Table.DD-5
Table.DD-5 Time required for executing the interrupt sequence
Interrupt vector address
Stack pointer (SP) value
16-Bit bus, without wait
8-Bit bus, without wait
Even
Even
18 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
Even
Odd
19 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
Odd (Note 2)
Even
19 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
Odd (Note 2)
Odd
20 cycles (Note 1)
20 cycles (Note 1)
________
Note 1: Add 2 cycles in the case of a DBC interrupt; add 1 cycle in the case either of an address coincidence
interrupt or of a single-step interrupt.
Note 2: Locate an interrupt vector address in an even address, if possible.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
BCLK
Address bus
Address
0000
Interrupt
information
Data bus
R
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
SP-2
SP-4
SP-2
contents
SP-4
contents
vec
vec+2
vec
contents
PC
vec+2
contents
Indeterminate
W
The indeterminate segment is dependent on the queue buffer.
If the queue buffer is ready to take an instruction, a read cycle occurs.
Fig.DD-6 Time required for executing the interrupt sequence
Variation of IPL when Interrupt Request is Accepted
If an interrupt request is accepted, the interrupt priority level of the accepted interrupt is set in the IPL.
If an interrupt request, that does not have an interrupt priority level, is accepted, one of the values shown in
Table.DD-6 is set in the IPL.
Table.DD-6 Relationship between interrupts without interrupt priority levels and IPL
Interrupt sources without priority levels
Value set in the IPL
_______
Watchdog timer, NMI
7
Reset
0
Not changed
Other
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 52 of 290
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Saving Registers
In the interrupt sequence, only the contents of the flag register (FLG) and that of the program counter (PC)
are saved in the stack area.
First, the processor saves the four higher-order bits of the program counter, and 4 upper-order bits and 8
lower-order bits of the FLG register, 16 bits in total, in the stack area, then saves 16 lower-order bits of the
program counter. Fig.DD-7 shows the state of the stack as it was before the acceptance of the interrupt
request, and the state the stack after the acceptance of the interrupt request.
Save other necessary registers at the beginning of the interrupt routine using software. Using the PUSHM
instruction alone can save all the registers except the stack pointer (SP).
Address
MSB
Stack area
Address
MSB
LSB
Stack area
LSB
m–4
m–4
Program counter (PCL)
m–3
m–3
Program counter (PCM)
m–2
m–2
Flag register (FLGL)
m–1
m–1
m
Content of previous stack
m+1
Content of previous stack
[SP]
Stack pointer
value before
interrupt occurs
Stack status before interrupt request
is acknowledged
Flag register
(FLGH)
[SP]
New stack
pointer value
Program
counter (PCH)
m
Content of previous stack
m+1
Content of previous stack
Stack status after interrupt request
is acknowledged
Fig.DD-7 State of stack before and after acceptance of interrupt request
The operation of saving registers carried out in the interrupt sequence is dependent on whether the content
of the stack pointer, at the time of acceptance of an interrupt request, is even or odd. If the content of the
stack pointer (Note) is even, the content of the flag register (FLG) and the content of the program counter
(PC) are saved, 16 bits at a time. If odd, their contents are saved in two steps, 8 bits at a time. Fig.DD-8
shows the operation of the saving registers.
Note: Stack pointer is indicated by U flag when software number 32 - 63 INT command is executed,
otherwise is indicated by ISP.
(1) Stack pointer (SP) contains even number
Stack area
Address
[SP] – 3 (Odd)
Program counter (PCL)
(2) Saved simultaneously,
all 16 bits
Program counter (PCM)
[SP] – 2 (Even) Flag register (FLGL)
[SP] – 1 (Odd)
[SP]
Address
Stack area
(1) Saved simultaneously,
all 16 bits
Flag register Program
(FLGH) counter (PCH)
[SP] – 4 (Odd)
Program counter (PCL)
[SP] – 3 (Even)
Program counter (PCM)
(4)
[SP] – 2 (Odd)
Flag register (FLGL)
(1)
[SP] – 1 (Even) Flag register
(FLGH)
[SP]
(Even)
Program
counter (PCH)
Note: [SP] denotes the initial value of the stack pointer (SP) when interrupt request is acknowledged.
After registers are saved, the SP content is [SP] minus 4.
Fig.DD-8 Operation of saving registers
Jun 06, 2003
page 53 of 290
(3)
Saved
simultaneously,
all 8 bits
(2)
(Odd)
Finished saving registers
in two operations.
Rev.1.00
Sequence in which order
registers are saved
[SP] – 5 (Even)
[SP] – 5 (Odd)
[SP] – 4 (Even)
(2) Stack pointer (SP) contains odd number
Sequence in which order
registers are saved
Finished saving registers
in four operations.
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Returning from an Interrupt Routine
Executing the REIT instruction at the end of an interrupt routine returns the contents of the flag register (FLG)
as it was immediately before the start of interrupt sequence and the contents of the program counter (PC),
both of which have been saved in the stack area. Then control returns to the program that was being
executed before the acceptance of the interrupt request, so that the suspended process resumes.
Return the other registers saved by software within the interrupt routine using the POPM or similar instruction before executing the REIT instruction.
Interrupt Priority
If there are two or more interrupt requests occurring at a point in time within a single sampling (checking
whether interrupt requests are made), the interrupt assigned a higher priority is accepted.
Assign an arbitrary priority to maskable interrupts (peripheral I/O interrupts) using the interrupt priority level
select bits. If the same interrupt priority level is assigned, however, the interrupt with higher hardware priority
is accepted.
Priorities of the special interrupts, such as Reset (dealt with as an interrupt assigned the highest priority),
watchdog timer interrupt, etc. are regulated by hardware.
Fig.DD-9 shows the priorities of hardware interrupts.
Software interrupts are not affected by the interrupt priority. If an instruction is executed, control branches
invariably to the interrupt routine
Interrupt priority level judgement circuit
When two or more interrupts are generated simultaneously, this circuit selects the interrupt with the highest
priority level. Fig.DD-10 shows the circuit that judges the interrupt priority level..
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 54 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
_______
Interrupt
________
Reset > NMI > DBC > Watchdog timer > Peripheral I/O > Single step > Address match
Fig.DD-9 Hardware interrupts priorities
Priority level of each interrupt
Level 0 (initial value)
INT1/PS21
High
Timer B2/Key input interrupt 1
Timer B0/INT11/SCL0,SDA0
Timer A3/IBF2
Timer A1/INT7/SIO3
UART1 reception/SCL1,SDA1/INT10
UART0 reception/SCL0,SDA0/INT11
UART2 reception/ IBF1
INT2/PS22
INT0/PS20
Timer B1/INT10/SCL1,SDA1
Timer A4/IBF3
Timer A2
Timer A0
UART1 transmission/ I2C1
UART0 transmission/ I2C0
Priority of peripheral I/O interrupts
(if priority levels are same)
A-D conversion
DMA1/INT7
Bus collision detection/INT4
SIO4/INT6
Timer B4/ UART1 reception/ SIO4
INT3
SCL2, SDA2/ DMA0
UART2 transmission/IBF0
Key input interrupt 0
INT8
SIO3/INT5
Timer B3/ UART1 transmission
INT9
Timer B5/ LRESET
I2C2
Processor interrupt priority level (IPL)
Interrupt enable flag (I flag)
Address match
Watchdog timer
DBC
NMI
Reset
Note 1: I2C exist in M306K9FCLRP
Fig.DD-10 Interrupt priority judgement circuit
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 55 of 290
Low
(Note 1)
To interrupt request level judgment output
clock generation circuit (Fig. WA-3)
Interrupt
request
accepted
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
______
INT Interrupt
Factor selection
Numbers of interrupt factors share the same interrupt registers in the addresses of 004516, 004816 - 004C16,
004F16 - 005616, 005816 -005F16. The setting of interrupt factor selection bits of interrupt factor selection
registers 0 - 3 (addresses of 035F16, 035616 - 035816) select the interrupt factor. After the selection of
interrupt factor, the corresponding interrupt request bit must be "0" before enabling the interrupt.
Fig.DD-11 - Fig.DD-13 show the structure of interrupt factor selection register 0 - 3.
______
INT Interrupt
________
________
INT0 to INT11 are triggered by the edges of external inputs. The edge polarity can be selected using the
polarity select bit.
_______
_______
_______
________
INT0 to INT2 and INT4 to INT11 have polarity switching bit in the interrupt event select register. The polarity
______
switching bit has to set to "0" when INT interrupt event is not selected.
As for external interrupt input, an interrupt can be generated both at the rising edge and at the falling edge by
________
setting “1” in the INTi interrupt polarity switching bit of the interrupt factor selection register0,4
(035F16,035916). To select both edges, set the polarity switching bit of the corresponding interrupt control
register to ‘falling edge’ (“0”).
Fig.DD-11, Fig.DD-13 show the Interrupt factor selection register 0, 4.
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
Interrupt factor selection register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR0
Bit symbol
Address
035F16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
IFSR00
INT0 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR01
INT1 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR02
INT2 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR03
INT3 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR04
INT4 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR05
INT5 interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR06
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 004916)
0 : SIO3
1 : INT5
(Note 1)
IFSR07
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in
the address of 004816)
0 : SIO4
1 : INT6
(Note 2)
AA
A
A
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
R W
Note 1: Do not select the bit if SIO3 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 3.
Note 2: Do not select the bit if SIO4 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 5.
Fig.DD-11 Interrupt factor selection register(1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 56 of 290
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
AA
AA
A
AA
AAAA
A
AA
Interrupt factor selection register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
0
b0
0
Symbol
IFSR1
Bit symbol
Address
035616
Bit name
Reserved bit
IFSR11
When reset
0016
Function
Must be "0"
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 004A16)
Reserved bit
0 : Bus collision detection
1 : INT4
Must be "0"
IFSR13
Interrupt factor selection bit
0 : DMA1
(Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : INT7 (Note 1)
address of 004C16)
IFSR14
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 004F16)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005016)
IFSR15
IFSR16
IFSR17
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in
the address of 005116)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in
the address of 005316)
0 : UART2 transmission
1 : IBF0
0 : UART2 reception
1 : IBF1
0 : UART0 transmission
1 : I2C0
R W
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
0 : UART1 transmission (Note 2)
1 : I2C1
Note 1: Do not select the bit if INT7 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 3.
Note 2: Do not select the bit if UART1 transmission is selected by interrupt factor selection
register 5.
AA
AA
A
AA
AAAA
A
AA
Interrupt factor selection register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR2
Bit symbol
IFSR20
IFSR21
IFSR22
IFSR23
IFSR24
IFSR25
IFSR26
IFSR27
Address
035716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005216)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005416)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005A16)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005B16)
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : UART0 reception
0 1 : SCL0,SDA0 (Note1)
1 0 : INT11
(Note1)
1 1 : Inhibited
b3 b2
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
R W
0 0 : UART1 reception (Note 2)
0 1 : SCL1,SDA1 (Note1)
1 0 : INT10
(Note1)
1 1 : Inhibited
b5 b4
0 0 : Timer B0
0 1 : INT11
(Note1)
1 0 : SCL0,SDA0 (Note1)
1 1 : Inhibited
b7 b6
0 0 : Timer B1
0 1 : INT10
(Note1)
1 0 : SCL1,SDA1 (Note1)
1 1 : Inhibited
Note1 : Do not select INT10, INT11, SCL0, SDA0, SCL1, SDA1 simultaneously in the
interrupt control registers.
Note 2: Do not select the bit if UART1 reception is selected by interrupt factor selection
register 5.
Fig.DD-12 Interrupt factor selection register(2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 57 of 290
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
AA
A
AA
A
AAAA
AA
Interrupt factor selection register 3
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR3
Address
035816
Bit symbol
Bit name
IFSR30
Interrupt factor selection bits
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005616)
IFSR31
IFSR32
IFSR33
IFSR34
IFSR35
IFSR36
IFSR37
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005816)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005916)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005C16)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005D16)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005E16)
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the
address of 005F16)
When reset
0016
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer A1
0 1 : INT7 (Note 1)
1 0 : SIO3 (Note 2)
1 1 : Inhibited
0 : Timer A3
1 : IBF2
0 : Timer A4
1 : IBF3
0 : Timer B2
1 : Key input interrupt 1
0 : INT0
1 : PS20
0 : INT1
1 : PS21
0 : INT2
1 : PS22
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
A
A
AA
R W
Note 1: Do not select the bit if INT7 are selected by interrupt factor selection register 1.
Note 2: Do not select the bit if SIO3 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 0.
Interrupt factor selection register 4
AAAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR4
0 0
Bit symbol
Address
035916
Bit name
INT6 Interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR41
INT7 Interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR42
INT8 Interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR43
INT9 Interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR44
INT10 Interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
IFSR45
INT11 Interrupt polarity
switching bit
0 : One edge
1 : Two edges
Fig.DD-13 Interrupt factor selection register(3)
Jun 06, 2003
Function
IFSR40
Reserved bits
Rev.1.00
When reset
0016
page 58 of 290
Must be "0"
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
A
A
AA
R W
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
Interrupt factor selection register 5
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0 0 0
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR 5
Bit symbol
Address
035A16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
IFSR50
Interrupt factor selection bit
0 : SCL2,SDA2
(Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : DMA0
address of 004216)
IFSR51
Interrupt factor selection bit
0 : Timer B5
(Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : LRESET
address of 004316)
IFSR52
b1 b0
Interrupt factor selection bit
(Selecting interrupt factor in the 0 0 : Timer B4
0 1 : UART1 reception (Note 1)
address of 004616)
1 0 : SIO4(Note 2)
1 1 : Inhibited
IFSR53
IFSR54
R W
Interrupt factor selection bit
0 : Timer B3
(Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : UART1 transmission (Note 3)
address of 004716)
Reserved bits
Must be "0"
Note 1. Do not select the bit if UART1 reception is selected by interrupt factor selection
register 2.
Note 2. Do not select the bit if SIO4 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 0.
Note 3. Do not select the bit if UART1 transmission is selected by interrupt factor selection
register 1.
Fig. DD-14 Interrupt factor selection register(4)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 59 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
________
NMI Interrupt
______
NMI Interrupt
______
______
______
An NMI interrupt is generated when the input to the P85/NMI pin changes from “H” to “L”. The NMI interrupt
is a non-maskable external interrupt. The pin level can be checked in the port P85 register (bit 5 at address
03F016).
This pin cannot be used as a normal port input.
Key Input Interrupt 0
If the direction register of any of P50 to P57 is set for input and a falling edge is input to that port, a key input
interrupt 0 is generated. A key input interrupt 0 can also be used as a key-on wakeup function for cancelling
the wait mode or stop mode. Fig.DD-14 shows the block diagram of the key input interrupt 0. Note that if an
“L” level is input to any pin that has not been disabled for input, inputs to the other pins are not detected as an
interrupt.
Pull-up select bit
Pull-up
transistor
Key input interrupt 0 control register
(address 004D16)
Port P57 direction register
Port P57 direction register
P57/KI07
Pull-up
transistor
Port P56 direction
register
P56/KI06
Interrupt control circuit
Pull-up
transistor
Port P55 direction
register
P55/KI05
Pull-up
transistor
Port P54 direction
register
P54/KI04
Pull-up
transistor
Port P53 direction
register
P53/KI03
Pull-up
transistor
Port P52 direction
register
P52/KI02
Pull-up
transistor
Port P51 direction
register
P51/KI01
Pull-up
transistor
Port P50 direction
register
P50/KI00
Fig.DD-15 Block diagram of key input interrupt 0
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 60 of 290
Key input interrupt 0
request
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Key Input Interrupt 1
If any of the bits of key input interrupt 1 enable register (Address: 02F416) are set to “1”, the key input
interrupt 1 request occurs when a falling or a rising edge is input to one of the corresponding pins.
The effective input edge of key input interrupt 1 is determined by the edge selection bit of key input
interrupt 1 edge selection register (Address: 02F516). When the bit is set to “0”, at the falling edge,
when the bit is set to “1”, at the rising edge of the input signal to the corresponding pin, the interrupt
request occurs respectively.
When an effective rising edge or falling edge is input, “1” is set to the corresponding bit of P14 event
register (Address: 02F616). By reading the register after the interrupt occurs, the pin, which the effective edge is input, can be confirmed even if the status of that pin has been changed.
At the completion of the reading of P14 event register, the bits, whose value is “1” in reading, will be
cleared automatically. A dummy write clears the register too.
The registers, the block diagram and the timing of key input interrupt 1 are shown in Fig. DD-17, Fig.
DD-18 and Fig. DD-19 respectively.
After changing the effective edge by modifying key input interrupt 1 edge selection register, the value
of P14 event register and interrupt request bit may become “1”. A dummy write to the P14 event
register and a clear to the interrupt request bit should be done after changing the effective edge.
Same as key input interrupt edge selection register, when enabling/disabling key input interrupt 1 by
setting key input interrupt 1 enable register, the value of P14 event register and interrupt request bit
may become “1”. A dummy write to the P14 event register and a clear to the interrupt request bit
should be done after the setting of enabling/disabling.
P14 event register
AA
A
AA
AA
AAAA
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
KIN1EV
Bit symbol
Address
02F616
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
KIN1EV0
P14 event bit0
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV1
P14 event bit1
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV2
P14 event bit2
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV3
P14 event bit3
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV4
P14 event bit4
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV5
P14 event bit5
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV6
P14 event bit6
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
KIN1EV7
P14 event bit7
0 : Without event
1 : with an event
Note : The register is "0" cleared by dummy write.
Fig.DD-16 P14 event register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 61 of 290
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
R W(Note)
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
AAA
Key input interrupt 1 enable register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
KIN1EN
Address
02F416
Bit Symbol
AAA
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
KIN1EN0
0 : Disable
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 0 1 : Enable
KIN1EN1
0 : Disable
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 1 1 : Enable
KIN1EN2
0 : Disable
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 2 1 : Enable
KIN1EN3
0 : Disable
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 3 1 : Enable
KIN1EN4
0 : Disable
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 4 1 : Enable
KIN1EN5
0 : Disable
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 5 1 : Enable
KIN1EN6
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 6 0 : Disable
1 : Enable
KIN1EN7
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 7 0 : Disable
1 : Enable
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
Key input interrupt 1 edge selection register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
KIN1SEL
Address
02F516
Bit Symbol
Bit name
Jun 06, 2003
Function
KIN1SEL0
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 0
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL1
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 1
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL2
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 2
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL3
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 3
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL4
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 4
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL5
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 5
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL6
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 6
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
KIN1SEL7
Key input interrupt 1 edge
selection bit 7
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
Fig.DD-17 Key input interrupt 1 registers
Rev.1.00
When reset
0016
page 62 of 290
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 63 of 290
Fig.DD-18 The block diagram of key input interrupt 1
P140/KI10
P141/KI11
P142/KI12
P143/KI13
P144/KI14
P145/KI15
P146/KI16
P147/KI17
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Pull-up
transistor
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 0
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 1
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 2
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 3
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 4
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 5
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 6
Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 7
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit0
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit1
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit2
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit3
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit4
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit5
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit6
Edge selection one-shot
generation circuit
Key input interrupt 1
edge selection bit7
P147 direction register
Pull-up selection bit
Q
R
D
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P140 event latch circuit
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P141 event latch circuit
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P142 event latch circuit
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P143 event latch circuit
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P144 event latch circuit
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P145 event latch circuit
The write to address 02F616
The read from address 02F616
P146 event latch circuit
Delay circuit
RESET
The read from
address 02F616
P147 event latch circuit
Interrupt control circuit
D
R
DB0
The read from address 02F616
DB1
The read from address 02F616
DB2
The read from address 02F616
DB3
The read from address 02F616
DB4
The read from address 02F616
DB5
The read from address 02F616
DB6
The read from address 02F616
Q
Event register
The read from
address 02F616
Q
The read from
address 02F616
R
S
Event data
Key input interrupt 1 request
Key input interrupt 1 control register (Address 005C16)
The read from
address 02F616
DB7
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
P140
P141
(Note 1)
P140 request
P141 request
Interrupt request bit
P140 event data
(Note 2)
P141 event data
P14 event register
0016
0116
0316
0016
The read signal from 02F616
The read from 02F616
0116
Interrupt
procession
0316
Interrupt
procession
0016
Interrupt
procession
Note 1: If there are several effective edge inputs, the input sequential order can not be confirmed.
Note 2: If another interrupt request occurs between the setting of prior key input interrupt 1 request bit and the read of
P14 event register, the interrupt request bit will be set again same as P14 event register. After the read of P14
event register, both the bits, which were set to “1”, will be automatically cleared. However, the interrupt processing
will be executed twice because of the re-setting of interrupt request bit (the value of P14 event register in the 2nd
reading will be “0”).
Fig.DD-19 The timing of key input interrupt 1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 64 of 290
Interrupt
M16C/6K9 Group
Address Match Interrupt
An address match interrupt is generated when the address match interrupt address register contents match
the program counter value. Two address match interrupts can be set, each of which can be enabled and
disabled by an address match interrupt enable bit. Address match interrupts are not affected by the interrupt
enable flag (I flag) and processor interrupt priority level (IPL). The stacked value of the program counter (PC)
for an address match interrupt varies depending on the instruction being executed.
Fig.DD-20 shows the address match interrupt-related registers.
Address match interrupt enable register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
AIER
Address
000916
When reset
XXXXXX002
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Bit symbol
Bit name
Function
AIER0
Address match interrupt 0
enable bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
AIER1
Address match interrupt 1
enable bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
RW
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to
be indeterminate.
Address match interrupt register i (i = 0, 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
RMAD0
RMAD1
Address
001216 to 001016
001616 to 001416
Function
Address setting register for address match interrupt
When reset
X0000016
X0000016
0000016 to FFFFF16
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to
be indeterminate.
Fig.DD-20 Address match interrupt-related registers
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 65 of 290
A
A
Values that can be set R W
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Precautions for Interrupts
(1) Reading address 0000016
• When maskable interrupt is occurred, CPU read the interrupt information (the interrupt number and
interrupt request level) in the interrupt sequence.
The interrupt request bit of the certain interrupt written in address 0000016 will then be set to “0”.
Reading address 0000016 by software sets the request bit, which the interrupt source is enabled with the
highest priority, to “0”.
Though the interrupt is generated, the interrupt routine may not be executed.
Hence do not read address 0000016 by software.
(2) Setting the stack pointer
• The value of the stack pointer is initialized to 0000 16 right after the reset. Accepting an interrupt
before setting a value in the stack pointer may become a factor of runaway. Be sure to set a value in the
_______
stack pointer before accepting an interrupt. When using the NMI interrupt, initialize the stack point at the
beginning of a program. Concerning the first instruction immediately after reset, generating any interrupts
_______
including the NMI interrupt is prohibited.
_______
(3) The NMI interrupt
_______
• As for the NMI interrupt pin, an interrupt cannot be disabled. Connect it to the Vcc pin via a resistor (pullup) if unused. Be sure to work on it.
_______
• The NMI pin also serves as P85, which is exclusively input. Reading the contents of the P8 register
allows reading the pin value. Use the reading of this pin only for establishing the pin level at the time
_______
when the NMI interrupt is input.
_______
• Do not reset the CPU with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state.
_______
• Do not attempt to go into stop mode with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. With the input to the
_______
NMI being in the “L” state, the CM10 is fixed to “0”, so attempting to go into stop mode is turned down.
_______
• Do not attempt to go into wait mode with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. With the input to the
_______
NMI pin being in the “L” state, the CPU stops but the oscillation does not stop, so no power is saved. In this
instance, the CPU is returned to the normal state by a later interrupt.
_______
• Signals input to the NMI pin require an "L" level of 1 clock or more, from the operation clock of the CPU.
(4) External interrupt
________
• Either an “L” level or an “H” level of at least 380 ns width is necessary for the signal input to pins INT0
_________
through INT11 regardless of the CPU operation clock.
________
_________
• When the polarity of the INT0 to INT11 pins is changed, the interrupt request bit is sometimes set to "1".
After changing the polarity, set the interrupt request bit to "0". Fig.DD-21 shows the procedure for changing
______
the INT interrupt generate factor.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 66 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Interrupt
Clear the interrupt enable flag to “0”
(Disable interrupt)
Set the interrupt priority level to level 0
(Disable INTi interrupt)
Set the polarity select bit
Clear the interrupt request bit to “0”
Set the interrupt priority level to level 1 to 7
(Enable the accepting of INTi interrupt request)
Set the interrupt enable flag to “1”
(Enable interrupt)
______
Fig.DD-21 Switching condition of INT interrupt request
(5) Rewrite the interrupt control register
• To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that
register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occurs, rewrite the interrupt control register after the
interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow:
• When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed when the interrupt is disabled, the
Example 1:
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
NOP
NOP
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 2:
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
MOV.W MEM, R0
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Dummy read.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 3:
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
POPC FLG
; Push Flag register onto stack
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Enable interrupts.
The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted
before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the
interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue.
interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated.
This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the register.
Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 67 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Watchdog Timer
Watchdog Timer
The watchdog timer has the function of detecting when the program is out of control. The watchdog timer is
a 15-bit counter which down-counts the clock derived by dividing the BCLK using the prescaler. A watchdog
timer interrupt is generated when an underflow occurs in the watchdog timer. When XIN is selected for the
BCLK, bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register (address 000F16) selects the prescaler division ratio (by 16
or by 128). When XCIN is selected as the BCLK, the prescaler is set for division by 2 regardless of bit 7 of the
watchdog timer control register (address 000F16). Thus the watchdog timer's period can be calculated as
given below. The watchdog timer's period is, however, subject to an error due to the prescaler.
With XIN chosen for BCLK
Watchdog timer period =
prescaler dividing ratio (16 or 128) X watchdog timer count (32768)
BCLK
With XCIN chosen for BCLK
Watchdog timer period =
prescaler dividing ratio (2) X watchdog timer count (32768)
BCLK
For example, suppose that BCLK runs at 16 MHz and that 16 has been chosen for the dividing ratio of the
prescaler, then the watchdog timer's period becomes approximately 32.7 ms.
The watchdog timer is initialized by writing to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16) and when a
watchdog timer interrupt request is generated. The prescaler is initialized only when the microcomputer is
reset. After a reset is cancelled, the watchdog timer and prescaler are both stopped. The count is started by
writing to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16).
Fig.DG-1 shows the block diagram of the watchdog timer. Fig.DG-2 shows the watchdog timer-related registers.
Prescaler
1/16
BCLK
1/128
“CM07 = 0”
“WDC7 = 0”
“CM07 = 0”
“WDC7 = 1”
Watchdog timer
HOLD
“CM07 = 1”
1/2
Write to the watchdog timer
start register
(address 000E16)
Set to
“7FFF16”
RESET
Fig.DG-1 Block diagram of watchdog timer
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 68 of 290
Watchdog timer
interrupt request
Watchdog Timer
M16C/6K9 Group
Watchdog timer control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
WDC
0 0
Bit symbol
Address
000F16
When reset
000XXXXX2
Bit name
Function
High-order bit of watchdog timer
Reserved bit
Must always be set to “0”
Reserved bit
Must always be set to “0”
WDC7
Prescaler select bit
0 : Divided by 16
1 : Divided by 128
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
R W
Watchdog timer start register
b7
b0
Symbol
WDTS
Address
000E16
When reset
Indeterminate
Function
The watchdog timer is initialized and starts counting after a write instruction to
this register. The watchdog timer value is always initialized to “7FFF16”
regardless of whatever value is written.
Fig.DG-2 Watchdog timer control and start registers
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 69 of 290
A
RW
M16C/6K9 Group
DMAC
DMAC
This microcomputer has two DMAC (direct memory access controller) channels that allow data to be sent to
memory without using the CPU. DMAC shares the same data bus with the CPU. The DMAC is given a higher
right of using the bus than the CPU, which leads to working the cycle stealing method. On this account, the
operation from the occurrence of DMA transfer request signal to the completion of 1-word (16-bit) or 1-byte
(8-bit) data transfer can be performed at high speed. Fig.EC-1 shows the block diagram of the DMAC.
Table.EC-1 shows the DMAC specifications. Fig.EC-2 to EC-4 show the registers used by the DMAC.
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AAAAAAA
AA
A
AA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
AA
A
AAA A
AAA
AAA
A
AA
AAA A AA
AA
AA
AAA
AA
A
A
AA
AA
A
A
AAAA
A
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
A
A
AA
A
AA
AA
A
A
A
AA
A
A AA
AA
Address bus
DMA0 source pointer SAR0(20)
(addresses 002216 to 002016)
DMA0 destination pointer DAR0 (20)
(addresses 002616 to 002416)
DMA0 forward address pointer (20) (Note)
DMA0 transfer counter reload register TCR0 (16)
DMA1 source pointer SAR1 (20)
(addresses 003216 to 003016)
(addresses 002916, 002816)
DMA0 transfer counter TCR0 (16)
DMA1 destination pointer DAR1 (20)
DMA1 transfer counter reload register TCR1 (16)
DMA1 forward address pointer (20) (Note)
(addresses 003616 to 003416)
(addresses 003916, 003816)
DMA1 transfer counter TCR1 (16)
Data bus low-order bits
Data bus high-order bits
DMA latch high-order bits
DMA latch low-order bits
AA
AA
Note: Pointer is incremented by a DMA request.
Fig.EC-1 Block diagram of DMAC
Either a write signal to the software DMA request bit or an interrupt request signal is used as a DMA transfer
request signal. But the DMA transfer is affected neither by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) nor by the interrupt
priority level. The DMA transfer doesn't affect any interrupts neither.
If the DMAC is active (the DMA enable bit is set to 1), data transfer starts every time a DMA transfer request
signal occurs. If the cycle of the occurrences of DMA transfer request signals is higher than the DMA transfer
cycle, there can be instances in which the number of transfer requests doesn't agree with the number of
transfers. For details, see the description of the DMA request bit.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 70 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
DMAC
Table.EC-1 DMAC specifications
Item
Specification
No. of channels
2 (cycle steal method)
Transfer memory space
• From any address in the 1M bytes space to a fixed address
• From a fixed address to any address in the 1M bytes space
• From a fixed address to a fixed address
(Note that DMA-related registers [002016 to 003F16] cannot be accessed)
Maximum No. of bytes transferred 128K bytes (with 16-bit transfers) or 64K bytes (with 8-bit transfers)
________
________
DMA request factors (Note)
Falling edge of INT0 or INT1 or both edge
Timer A0 to timer A4 interrupt requests
Timer B0 to timer B5 interrupt requests
UART0 transfer and reception interrupt requests
UART1 transfer and reception interrupt requests
UART2 transfer and reception interrupt requests
Serial I/O3, 4 interrupt requests
A-D conversion interrupt requests
IBF0 to IBF3 interrupt requests
Software triggers
Channel priority
DMA0 takes precedence if DMA0 and DMA1 requests are generated simultaneously
Transfer unit
8 bits or 16 bits
Transfer address direction
forward/fixed (forward direction cannot be specified for both source and
destination simultaneously)
Transfer mode
• Single transfer mode
After the transfer counter underflows, the DMA enable bit turns to
“0”, and the DMAC turns inactive
• Repeat transfer mode
After the transfer counter underflows, the value of the transfer counter
reload register is reloaded to the transfer counter.
The DMAC remains active unless a “0” is written to the DMA enable bit.
DMA interrupt request generation timing When an underflow occurs in the transfer counter
Active
When the DMA enable bit is set to “1”, the DMAC is active.
When the DMAC is active, data transfer starts every time a DMA
transfer request signal occurs.
Inactive
• When the DMA enable bit is set to “0”, the DMAC is inactive.
• After the transfer counter underflows in single transfer mode
At the time of starting data transfer immediately after turning the DMAC active, the
Forward address pointer and
value of one of source pointer and destination pointer - the one specified for the
reload timing for transfer
forward direction - is reloaded to the forward direction address pointer, and the value
counter
of the transfer counter reload register is reloaded to the transfer counter.
Writing to register
Registers specified for forward direction transfer are always write enabled.
Registers specified for fixed address transfer are write-enabled when
the DMA enable bit is “0”.
Reading the register
Can be read at any time.
However, when the DMA enable bit is “1”, reading the register set up as the
forward register is the same as reading the value of the forward address pointer.
Note: DMA transfer is not effective to any interrupt. DMA transfer is affected neither by the interrupt enable
flag (I flag) nor by the interrupt priority level.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 71 of 290
DMAC
M16C/6K9 Group
DMA0 request factor selection register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
DM0SL
b0
Bit symbol
DSEL0
Address
03B816
When reset
0016
Function
Bit name
DMA request factor
selection bits
DSEL1
DSEL2
DSEL3
b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 : Falling edge of INT0 pin
0 0 0 1 : Software trigger
0 0 1 0 : Timer A0
0 0 1 1 : Timer A1
0 1 0 0 : Timer A2
0 1 0 1 : Timer A3
0 1 1 0 : Timer A4 (DMS=0)
/two edges of INT0 pin (DMS=1)
0 1 1 1 : Timer B0 (DMS=0)
Timer B3 (DMS=1)
1 0 0 0 : Timer B1 (DMS=0)
Timer B4 (DMS=1)
1 0 0 1 : Timer B2 (DMS=0)
Timer B5 (DMS=1)
1 0 1 0 : UART0 transmit (DMS=0)
/IBF0(DMS=1)
1 0 1 1 : UART0 receive (DMS=0)
/IBF1(DMS=1)
1 1 0 0 : UART2 transmit (DMS=0)
/IBF2(DMS=1)
1 1 0 1 : UART2 receive(DMS=0)
/IBF3(DMS=1)
1 1 1 0 : A-D conversion
1 1 1 1 : UART1 transmit
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMS
DMA request factor
expansion bit
0 : Normal
1 : Expanded factor
DSR
Software DMA
request bit
If software trigger is selected, a
DMA request is generated by
setting this bit to “1” (When read,
the value of this bit is always “0”)
Fig.EC-2 DMAC register (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 72 of 290
AAA
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
R
W
AA
AA
DMAC
M16C/6K9 Group
DMA1 request factor selection register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
DM1SL
b0
Address
03BA16
Function
Bit name
Bit symbol
DSEL0
When reset
0016
DMA request factor
selection bits
DSEL1
DSEL2
DSEL3
b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 : Falling edge of INT1 pin
0 0 0 1 : Software trigger
0 0 1 0 : Timer A0
0 0 1 1 : Timer A1
0 1 0 0 : Timer A2
0 1 0 1 : Timer A3(DMS=0)
/serial I/O3 (DMS=1)
0 1 1 0 : Timer A4 (DMS=0)
/serial I/O4 (DMS=1)
0 1 1 1 : Timer B0 (DMS=0)
/two edges of INT1 (DMS=1)
1 0 0 0 : Timer B1
1 0 0 1 : Timer B2
1 0 1 0 : UART0 transmit (DMS=0)
/IBF0(DMS=1)
1 0 1 1 : UART0 receive (DMS=0)
/IBF1(DMS=1)
1 1 0 0 : UART2 transmit(DMS=0)
/IBF2(DMS=1)
1 1 0 1 : UART2 receive(DMS=0)
/IBF3(DMS=1)
1 1 1 0 : A-D conversion
1 1 1 1 : UART1 receive
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMS
DMA request factor
expansion bit
0 : Normal
1 : Expanded factor
DSR
Software DMA
request bit
If software trigger is selected, a
DMA request is generated by
setting this bit to “1” (When read,
the value of this bit is always “0”)
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
R
W
AA
AA
DMAi control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
DMiCON(i=0,1)
b0
Address
002C16, 003C16
When reset
00000X002
Bit symbol
Bit name
DMBIT
Transfer unit bit select bit
0 : 16 bits
1 : 8 bits
DMASL
Repeat transfer mode
select bit
0 : Single transfer
1 : Repeat transfer
DMAS
DMA request bit (Note 1)
0 : DMA not requested
1 : DMA requested
DMA enable bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
DSD
Source address direction
select bit (Note 3)
0 : Fixed
1 : Forward
DAD
Destination address
0 : Fixed
direction select bit (Note 3) 1 : Forward
DMAE
Function
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
AA
R
W
(Note 2)
Note 1: DMA request can be cleared by resetting the bit to "0".
Note 2: This bit can only be set to “0”.
Note 3: Source address direction select bit and destination address direction select bit
cannot be set to “1” simultaneously.
Fig.EC-3 DMAC register (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 73 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
DMAC
DMAi source pointer (i = 0, 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
SAR0
SAR1
Address
002216 to 002016
003216 to 003016
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transfer count
specification
Function
• Source pointer
Stores the source address
A
RW
0000016 to FFFFF16
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
DMAi destination pointer (i = 0, 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16) (b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0
b7
b0
Symbol
DAR0
DAR1
Address
002616 to 002416
003616 to 003416
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transfer count
specification
Function
• Destination pointer
Stores the destination address
0000016 to FFFFF16
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
A
RW
DMAi transfer counter (i = 0, 1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0
b7
b0
Symbol
TCR0
TCR1
Address
002916, 002816
003916, 003816
Function
• Transfer counter
Set a value one less than the transfer count
Fig.EC-4 DMAC register (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 74 of 290
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transfer count
specification
000016 to FFFF16
A
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
DMAC
(1) Transfer cycle
The transfer cycle consists of the bus cycle in which data is read from memory or from the SFR area (source
read) and the bus cycle in which the data is written to memory or to the SFR area (destination write). The
number of read and write bus cycles depends on the source and destination addresses.
* Effect of source and destination addresses
When 16-bit data is transferred on a 16-bit data bus, and the source and destination both start at odd
addresses, there are one more source read cycle and destination write cycle than when the source and
destination both start at even addresses.
Fig.EC-5 shows the example of the transfer cycles for a source read. For convenience, the destination write
cycle is shown as one cycle and the source read cycles for the different conditions are shown. In reality, the
destination write cycle is subject to the same conditions as the source read cycle, with the transfer cycle
changing accordingly. When calculating the transfer cycle, remember to apply the respective conditions to
both the destination write cycle and the source read cycle.
(2) DMAC transfer cycles
Any combination of even or odd transfer read and write addresses is possible. Table.EC-2 shows the number of DMAC transfer cycles.
The number of DMAC transfer cycles can be calculated as follows:
No. of transfer cycles per transfer unit = No. of read cycles x j + No. of write cycles x k
Table.EC-2 No. of DMAC transfer cycles
Transfer unit
Bus width
Access address
8-bit transfers
(DMBIT= “1”)
16-bit transfers
(DMBIT= “0”)
16-bit
(BYTE= “L”)
16-bit
(BYTE= “L”)
Even
Odd
Even
Odd
Coefficient j, k
Internal memory
Internal ROM/RAM Internal ROM/RAM
No wait
With wait
1
2
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 75 of 290
SFR area
2
Single-chip mode
No. of read
No. of write
cycles
cycles
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
DMAC
M16C/6K9 Group
(1) 8-bit transfers
16-bit transfers from even address and the source address is even.
BCLK
Address
bus
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
WR signal
Data
bus
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
(2) One wait is inserted into the source read under the conditions in (1)
BCLK
Address
bus
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
WR signal
Data
bus
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
Note: The same thing changes occur with the respective conditions at the destination as at the source.
Fig.EC-5 Example of the transfer cycles for a source read
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 76 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
DMAC
DMA enable bit
Setting the DMA enable bit to "1" makes the DMAC active. The DMAC carries out the following operations at
the time data transfer starts immediately after DMAC is turned active.
(1) Reloads the value of one of the source pointer and the destination pointer - the one specified for the
forward direction - to the forward direction address pointer.
(2) Reloads the value of the transfer counter reload register to the transfer counter.
Thus overwriting "1" to the DMA enable bit with the DMAC being active carries out the operations given above,
so the DMAC operates again from the initial state at the instant "1" is overwritten to the DMA enable bit.
DMA request bit
The DMAC can generate a DMA transfer request signal triggered by a factor chosen in advance out of DMA
request factors for each channel.
DMA request factors include the following.
* Factors effected by using the interrupt request signals from the built-in peripheral functions and software
DMA factors (internal factors) effected by a program.
* External factors effected by utilizing the input from external interrupt signals.
For the selection of DMA request factors, see the descriptions of the DMAi factor selection register.
The DMA request bit turns to "1" if the DMA transfer request signal occurs regardless of the DMAC's state
(regardless of whether the DMA enable bit is set "1" or to "0"). It turns to "0" immediately before data transfer
starts.
In addition, it can be set to "0" by use of a program, but cannot be set to "1".
There can be instances in which a change in DMA request factor selection bit causes the DMA request bit to
turn to "1". So be sure to set the DMA request bit to "0" after the DMA request factor selection bit is changed.
The DMA request bit turns to "1" if a DMA transfer request signal occurs, and turns to "0" immediately just
before data transfer starts. If the DMAC is active, data transfer starts immediately, so the value of the DMA
request bit, if read by use of a program, turns out to be "0" in most cases. To examine whether the DMAC is
active, read the DMA enable bit.
Here follows the timing of changes in the DMA request bit.
(1) Internal factors
Except the DMA request factors triggered by software, the timing for the DMA request bit to turn to "1" due to
an internal factor is the same as the timing for the interrupt request bit of the interrupt control register to turn
to "1" due to several factors.
Turning the DMA request bit to "0" due to an internal factor is timed to be effected immediately just before the
transfer starts.
(2) External factors
An external factor is a factor caused to occur by the edge of input from the INTi pin (i depends on which
DMAC channel is used).
Selecting the INTi pins as external factors using the DMA request factor selection bit causes input from these
pins to become the DMA transfer request signals.
The timing for the DMA request bit to turn to "1" when an external factor is selected synchronizes with the
signal's edge applicable to the function specified by the DMA request factor selection bit (synchronizes with
the falling edge of the input signal to each INTi pin, for example).
With an external factor selected, the DMA request bit is timed to turn to "0" immediately just before data
transfer starts similarly to the state in which an internal factor is selected.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 77 of 290
DMAC
M16C/6K9 Group
(3) The priorities of channels and DMA transfer timing
If a DMA transfer request signal falls on the same sampling cycle (a sampling cycle means one period from
the rising edge to the falling edge of BCLK), the DMA request bits of applicable channels concurrently turn to
"1". If the channels are active at that moment, DMA0 is given a high priority to start data transfer. When
DMA0 finishes data transfer, it gives the bus right to the CPU. When the CPU finishes single bus access,
then DMA1 starts data transfer and gives the bus right to the CPU.
An example in which DMA transfer is carried out in minimum cycles at the time when DMA transfer request
signals due to external factors concurrently occur.
Fig.EC-6 An example of DMA transfer effected by external factors.
An example in which DMA transmission is carried out in minimum
cycles at the time when DMA transmission request signals due to
external factors concurrently occur.
BCLK
DMA0
DMA1
CPU
INT0
AAAA
AAAA
AAAAAA
AAA
AAAAAA
AA
AAAAAA AAA AAAAAA
AA
Obtaining
the bus
right
DMA0
request bit
INT1
DMA1
request bit
Fig.EC-6 An example of DMA transfer effected by external factors
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 78 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer
Timer
There are eleven 16-bit timers. These timers can be classified by function into timers A (five) and timers B
(six). All these timers function independently. Fig.FB-1 and FB-2 show the block diagram of timers.
Clock prescaler
f1
XIN
f8
1/8
1/4
f32
XCIN
Clock prescaler reset flag (bit 7
at address 038116) set to “1”
1/32
Reset
fC32
f1 f8 f32 fC32
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Noise
filter
TA0IN
Timer A0 interrupt
Timer A0
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Noise
filter
TA1IN
Timer A1 interrupt
Timer A1
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Noise
filter
TA2IN
Timer A2 interrupt
Timer A2
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Noise
filter
TA3IN
Timer A3 interrupt
Timer A3
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• One-shot mode
• PWM mode
Timer A4 interrupt
Noise
filter
TA4IN
Timer A4
• Event counter mode
Timer B2 overflow
Note 1: The TA0IN pin (P71) is shared with RxD2 and the TB5IN pin, so be careful.
Fig.FB-1 Timer A block diagram
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 79 of 290
Timer
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock prescaler
f1
XIN
f8
1/8
1/4
f32
XCIN
Clock prescaler reset flag (bit 7
at address 038116) set to “1”
1/32
Reset
fC32
f1 f8 f32 fC32
Timer A
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
Noise
filter
TB0IN
Timer B0 interrupt
Timer B0
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
Noise
filter
TB1IN
Timer B1 interrupt
Timer B1
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
Noise
filter
TB2IN
Timer B2 interrupt
Timer B2
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
Noise
filter
TB3IN
Timer B3 interrupt
Timer B3
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
Noise
filter
TB4IN
Timer B4 interrupt
Timer B4
• Event counter mode
• Timer mode
• Pulse width measuring mode
Noise
filter
TB5IN
Timer B5
• Event counter mode
Note 1: The TB5IN pin (P71) is shared with RxD2 and the TA0IN pin, so be careful.
Fig.FB-2 Timer B block diagram
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 80 of 290
Timer B5 interrupt
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer A
Fig.FB-3 shows the block diagram of timer A. Fig.FB-4 to FB-6 show the timer A-related registers.
Except in event counter mode, timers A0 through A4 all have the same function. Use the timer Ai mode
register (i = 0 to 4) bits 0 and 1 to choose the desired mode.
Timer A has the four operation modes listed as follows:
• Timer mode: The timer counts an internal count source.
• Event counter mode: The timer counts pulses from an external source or a timer over flow.
• One-shot timer mode: The timer stops counting when the count reaches “000016”.
• Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode: The timer continually outputs pulse with arbitrary width.
Data bus high-order bits
Clock source
selection
Low-order
8 bits
• Timer
(gate function)
fC32
AAA
A
AAA
A
Data bus low-order bits
• Timer
• One shot
• PWM
f1
f8
f32
High-order
8 bits
Reload register (16)
• Event counter
Counter (16)
Polarity
selection
Up count/down count
Clock selection
TAiIN
(i = 0 to 4)
Always down count except
in event counter mode
Count start flag
(Address 038016)
Down count
TB2 overflow
External
trigger
TAj overflow
(j = i – 1. Note, however, that j = 4 when i = 0)
Up/down flag
(Address 038416)
TAi
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Addresses
038716 038616
038916 038816
038B16 038A16
038D16 038C16
038F16 038E16
TAj
Timer A4
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
TAk
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer A0
TAk overflow
(k = i + 1. Note, however, that k = 0 when i = 4)
Pulse output
TAiOUT
(i = 0 to 4)
Toggle flip-flop
Fig.FB-3 Block diagram of timer A
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
TAiMR(i=0 to 4)
b0
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
MR0
MR1
Address
When reset
039616 to 039A16
0016
Bit name
Function
b1 b0
Operation mode selection bits 0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Event counter mode
1 0 : One-shot timer mode
1 1 : Pulse width modulation
(PWM) mode
Function varies with each operation mode
MR2
MR3
TCK0
TCK1
Fig.FB-4 Timer A-related registers (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 81 of 290
Count source selection bits
(Function varies with each operation mode)
AA
A
A
AA
A
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
R W
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer Ai register (Note)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
Symbol
TA0
TA1
TA2
TA3
TA4
b0
Address
038716,038616
038916,038816
038B16,038A16
038D16,038C16
038F16,038E16
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
AA
AAA
AA
AAA
AA
AA
AA
Values that can be set
• Timer mode
Count the internal count source
000016 to FFFF16
• Event counter mode
Count pulses from external input or the overflow of timer
000016 to FFFF16
• One-shot timer mode
Count one shot width
000016 to FFFF16
• Pulse width modulation mode (16-bit PWM)
Function as a 16-bit pulse width modulator
000016 to FFFE16
• Pulse width modulation mode (8-bit PWM)
Timer low-order address functions as an 8-bit
prescaler and high-order address functions as an 8-bit
pulse width modulator
0016 to FE16
(Both high-order
and low-order
addresses)
RW
Note: Read and write data in 16-bit units.
Count start flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
TABSR
b0
Address
038016
When reset
0016
AA
AAA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
A
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
Bit symbol
Bit name
TA0S
Timer A0 count start flag
TA1S
Timer A1 count start flag
TA2S
Timer A2 count start flag
TA3S
Timer A3 count start flag
TA4S
Timer A4 count start flag
TB0S
Timer B0 count start flag
TB1S
Timer B1 count start flag
TB2S
Timer B2 count start flag
Function
RW
0 : Stop count
1 : Start count
Up/down flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
UDF
b0
Bit symbol
Timer A0 up/down flag
TA1UD
Timer A1 up/down flag
TA2UD
Timer A2 up/down flag
TA3UD
Timer A3 up/down flag
TA4UD
Timer A4 up/down flag
TA3P
TA4P
Fig.FB-5 Timer A-related registers (2)
Jun 06, 2003
Bit name
TA0UD
TA2P
Rev.1.00
Address
038416
page 82 of 290
When reset
0016
Function
0 : Down count
1 : Up count
This specification becomes valid
when the up/down flag content is
selected for up/down switching
factor
Timer A2 two-phase pulse 0 : two-phase pulse signal
processing disabled
signal processing select bit
1 : two-phase pulse signal
Timer A3 two-phase pulse
processing enabled
signal processing select bit
When not using the two-phase
Timer A4 two-phase pulse pulse signal processing function,
signal processing select bit set the select bit to “0”
AA
AAAAAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
One-shot start flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
ONSF
b0
Address
038216
Bit symbol
When reset
00X000002
Bit name
Function
TA0OS
Timer A0 one-shot start flag
TA1OS
Timer A1 one-shot start flag
TA2OS
Timer A2 one-shot start flag
TA3OS
Timer A3 one-shot start flag
TA4OS
Timer A4 one-shot start flag
1 : Timer start
When read, the value is “0”
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AAA
AA
A
AAA
R W
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
TA0TGL
Timer A0 event/trigger
selection bits
TA0TGH
b7 b6
0 0 : Input on TA0IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA4 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA1 overflow is selected
Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Trigger selection register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TRGSR
Address
038316
Bit symbol
TA1TGL
Bit name
Timer A1 event/trigger
selection bits
TA1TGH
TA2TGL
Timer A2 event/trigger
selection bits
TA2TGH
TA3TGL
Function
b1 b0
b3 b2
0 0 : Input on TA2IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA1 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA3 overflow is selected
b5 b4
Timer A4 event/trigger
selection bits
b7 b6
TA4TGH
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AAA
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AAA
R W
0 0 : Input on TA1IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA0 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA2 overflow is selected
Timer A3 event/trigger
selection bits
TA3TGH
TA4TGL
When reset
0016
0 0 : Input on TA3IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA2 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA4 overflow is selected
0 0 : Input on TA4IN is selected (Note)
0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected
1 0 : TA3 overflow is selected
1 1 : TA0 overflow is selected
Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Clock prescaler reset flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CPSRF
Address
038116
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
0XXXXXXX2
Function
R W
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
CPSR
Clock prescaler reset flag
Fig.FB-6 Timer A-related registers (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 83 of 290
0 : No effect
1 : Prescaler is reset
(When read, the value is “0”)
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
(1) Timer mode
In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. (See Table.FB-1) Fig.FB-7 shows the
timer Ai mode register in timer mode.
Table.FB-1 Specifications of timer mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
f1, f8, f32, fC32
• Down count
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and then continuing counting
1/(n+1) n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
When the timer underflows
Programmable I/O port or gate input
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Programmable I/O port or pulse output
Count value can be read out by reading timer Ai register
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
• Gate function
Counting can be started and stopped by the TAiIN pin’s input signal
• Pulse output function
Each time the timer underflows, the TAiOUT pin’s polarity is reversed
Select function
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TAiMR(i=0 to 4)
0 0
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
When reset
039616 to 039A16
0016
Bit name
Operation mode
selection bits
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 1)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR0
Pulse output function
selection bit
MR1
Gate function selection bits 0 X (Note 2): Gate function not available
b4 b3
(TAiIN pin is a normal port pin)
1 0 : Timer counts only when TAiIN pin is
held “L” (Note 3)
1 1 : Timer counts only when TAiIN pin is
held “H” (Note 3)
MR2
MR3
TCK0
0 (Must always be fixed to “0” in timer mode)
Count source selection bits
TCK1
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
A
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register
are invalid.
Note 2: The bit can be “0” or “1”.
Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Fig.FB-7 Timer Ai mode register in timer mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 84 of 290
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
(2) Event counter mode
In this mode, the timer counts an external signal or an internal timer’s overflow. Timers A0 and A1 can count
a single-phase external signal. Timers A2, A3, and A4 can count a single-phase and a two-phase external
signals. Table.FB-2 lists timer specifications and Fig. FB-8 shows the timer Ai mode register in event count
mode when counting a single-phase external signal.
Table.FB-3 lists timer specifications and Fig. FB-8 shows the timer Ai mode register in event count mode
when counting a two-phase external signals.
Table.FB-2 Timer specifications in event counter mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal)
Item
Specification
Count source
• External signal input to TAiIN pin (effective edge can be selected by software)
• TB2 overflow, TAj overflow
Count operation
• Up count or down count can be selected by external signal or software
• When the timer overflows or underflows, it reloads the reload register con
tents and then continuing counting (Note)
Divide ratio
1/ (FFFF16 - n + 1) for up count
1/ (n + 1) for down count
n : Set value
Count start condition
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count stop condition
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Interrupt request generation timing The timer overflows or underflows
TAiIN pin function
Programmable I/O port or count source input
TAiOUT pin function
Programmable I/O port, pulse output, or up/down count select input
Read from timer
Count value can be read out by reading timer Ai register
Write to timer
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Select function
• Free-run count function
Even when the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content is not reloaded to it
• Pulse output function
Each time the timer overflows or underflows, the TAiOUT pin’s polarity is reversed
Note: This does not apply when the free-run function is selected.
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TAiMR(i = 0, 1)
0 1
Address
039616, 039716
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode selection
bits
TMOD1
When reset
0016
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode (Note 1)
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AA
MR0
Pulse output function
selection bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 2)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
Count polarity
selection bit (Note 3)
0 : Counts external signal's falling edge
1 : Counts external signal's rising edge
MR2
Up/down switching factor
selection bit
0 : Up/down flag's content
1 : TAiOUT pin's input signal (Note 4)
MR3
0 (Must always be fixed to “0” in event counter mode)
TCK0
Count operation type
selection bit
TCK1
Invalid in event counter mode
Can be “0” or “1”
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
R
W
RW
Note 1: In event counter mode, the count source is selected by the event / trigger select bit
(addresses 038216 and 038316).
Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 3: Valid only when counting an external signal.
Note 4: When an “L” signal is input to the TAiOUT pin, the downcount is activated. When “H”,
the upcount is activated. Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Fig.FB-8 Timer Ai mode register in event counter mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 85 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer A
Table.FB-3 Timer specifications in event counter mode (when processing two-phase pulse signals with timers A2, A3, and A4)
Item
Count source
Count operation
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select function
Specification
• Two-phase pulse signals input to TAiIN and TAiOUT pin
• Up count or down count can be selected by two-phase pulse signals
• When the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content is
reloaded and the timer starts over again (Note)
1/ (FFFF16 - n + 1) for up count
1/ (n + 1) for down count
n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Timer overflows or underflows
Two-phase pulse input
Two-phase pulse input
Count value can be read out by reading timer A2, A3, or A4 register
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer A2, A3, or A4 register, it is written to both
reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer A2, A3, or A4 register, it is written to only
reload register. (Transferred to counter at next reload time.)
• Normal processing operation
The timer up-counts by the rising edge of TAiIN pin and down-counts by the
falling edge fo TAiIN pin during the "H" level period of input signal in TAiOUT
pin.
TAiOUT
TAiIN
(i=2,3)
Up
count
Up
count
Up
count
Down
count
Down
count
Down
count
• Multiply-by-4 processing operation
If the phase relationship is such that the TAiIN pin goes “H” when the input
signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”, the timer counts up rising and falling edges
on the TAiOUT and TAiIN pins. If the phase relationship is such that the
TAiIN pin goes “L” when the input signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”, the timer
counts down rising and falling edges on the TAiOUT and TAiIN pins.
TAiOUT
Count up all edges
Count down all edges
Count up all edges
Count down all edges
TAiIN
(i=3,4)
Note: This does not apply when the free-run function is selected.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 86 of 290
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer Ai mode register
(When not using two-phase pulse signals' processing)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
Address
When reset
TAiMR(i = 2 to 4) 039816 to 039A16
0016
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Bit name
Operation mode selection
bits
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 1)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
MR0
Pulse output function
selection bit
MR1
Count polarity selection bit 0 : Counts external signal's falling edges
1 : Counts external signal's rising edges
(Note 2)
MR2
Up/down switching
factor selection bit
MR3
0 : (Must always be “0” in event counter mode)
TCK0
Count operation type
selection bit
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
TCK1
Two-phase pulse signals'
processing operation
selection bit
(Note 4)(Note 5)
0 : Normal processing operation
1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation
0 : Up/down flag's content
1 : TAiOUT pin's input signal (Note 3)
Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 2: This bit is valid when only counting an external signal.
Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Note 4: This bit is valid for the timer A3 mode register.
For timer A2 and A4 mode registers, this bit can be “0 ”or “1”.
Note 5: When performing two-phase signal processing, make sure the two-phase pulse signals'
processing operation selection bit (address 038416) is set to “1”. Also, always be sure
to set the event/trigger selection bit (addresses 038216 and 038316) to “00”.
Timer Ai mode register
(When using two-phase pulse signals' processing)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1 0 0 0 1
Symbol
Address
When reset
TAiMR(i = 2 to 4) 039816 to 039A16
0016
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Bit name
Operation mode selection
bits
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode
MR0
0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
MR1
0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
MR2
1 (Must always be “1” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
MR3
0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal
processing)
TCK0
TCK1
Count operation type
selection bit
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
A
A
AA
A
A
AA
RW
Two-phase pulse processing 0 : Normal processing operation
operation selection bit
1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation
(Note 1)(Note 2)
Note 1: This bit is valid for timer A3 mode register.
For timer A2 and A4 mode registers, this bit can be “0” or “1”.
Note 2: When performing two-phase pulse signals' processing, make sure the two-phase pulse
signals' processing operation selection bit (address 038416) is set to “1”. Also, always be
sure to set the event/trigger selection bit (addresses 038216 and 038316) to “00”.
Fig.FB-9 Timer Ai mode register in event counter mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 87 of 290
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
(3) One-shot timer mode
In this mode, the timer operates only once. (See Table.FB-4) When a trigger occurs, the timer starts to
operate for a given period. Fig.FB-10 shows the timer Ai mode register in one-shot timer mode.
Table.FB-4 Timer specifications in one-shot timer mode
Item
Specification
Count source
Count operation
f1, f8, f32, fC32
• The timer counts down
• When the count reaches 000016, the timer stops counting after reloading a new count
• If a trigger occurs when counting, the timer reloads a new count and restarts counting
1/n
n : Set value
• An external trigger is input
• The timer overflows
• The one-shot start flag is set (= 1)
• A new count is reloaded after the count has reached 000016
• The count start flag is reset (= 0)
The count reaches 000016
Programmable I/O port or trigger input
Programmable I/O port or pulse output
When timer Ai register is read, it indicates an indeterminate value
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload
register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
When reset
TAiMR(i = 0 to 4) 039616 to 039A16
0016
1 0
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Bit name
Operation mode
selection bits
Function
b1 b0
1 0 : One-shot timer mode
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
MR0
Pulse output function
selection bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output (Note 1)
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
External trigger selection
bit (Note 2)
0 : Falling edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 3)
1 : Rising edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 3)
MR2
Trigger selection bit
0 : One-shot start flag is valid
1 : Selected by event/trigger selection register
MR3
TCK0
TCK1
0 (Must always be “0” in one-shot timer mode)
Count source selection bits
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
RW
Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 2: Valid only when the TAiIN pin is selected by the event/trigger selection bit
(addresses 038216 and 038316). If timer overflow is selected, this bit can be “1” or “0”.
Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Fig.FB-10 Timer Ai mode register in one-shot timer mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 88 of 290
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
(4) Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode
In this mode, the timer outputs pulses of a given width in succession. (See Table.FB-5) In this mode, the
counter functions as either a 16-bit pulse width modulator or an 8-bit pulse width modulator. Fig.FB-11
shows the timer Ai mode register in pulse width modulation mode. Fig.FB-12 shows the example of how a
16-bit pulse width modulator operates. Fig.FB-13 shows the example of how an 8-bit pulse width modulator
operates.
Table.FB-5 Timer specifications in pulse width modulation mode
Item
Specification
Count source
Count operation
f1, f8, f32, fC32
• The timer counts down (operating as an 8-bit or a 16-bit pulse width modulator)
• The timer reloads a new count at a rising edge of PWM pulse and continues counting
• The timer is not affected by a trigger that occurs when counting
• High level width
n / fi n : Set value
• Cycle time
(216-1) / fi fixed
• High level width n (m+1) / fi
n : values set to timer Ai register’s high-order address
8
• Cycle time
(2 -1) (m+1) / fi
m : values set to timer Ai register’s low-order address
• External trigger is input
• The timer overflows
• The count start flag is set (= 1)
• The count start flag is reset (= 0)
The falling edge of PWM pulse
Programmable I/O port or trigger input
Pulse output
When timer Ai register is read, it indicates an indeterminate value
• When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload
register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
16-bit PWM
8-bit PWM
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TAiIN pin function
TAiOUT pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Timer Ai mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
1
Symbol
TAiMR(i=0 to 4)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
When reset
039616 to 039A16
0016
Bit name
Function
Operation mode selection b1 b0
1 1 : PWM mode
bits
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
MR0
1 (Must always be “1” in PWM mode)
MR1
External trigger selection 0: Falling edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 2)
1: Rising edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 2)
bit (Note 1)
MR2
Trigger selection bit
0: Count start flag is valid
1: Selected by event/trigger selection register
MR3
16/8-bit PWM mode
selection bit
0: Functions as a 16-bit pulse width modulator
1: Functions as an 8-bit pulse width modulator
b7 b6
TCK0
TCK1
Count source selection bits 0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
RW
Note 1: Valid only when the TAiIN pin is selected by the event/trigger selection bit
(addresses 038216 and 038316). If timer overflow is selected, this bit can be “1” or “0”.
Note 2: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Fig.FB-11 Timer Ai mode register in pulse width modulation mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 89 of 290
Timer A
M16C/6K9 Group
Condition : Reload register = 000316, when external trigger
(rising edge of TAiIN pin input signal) is selected
1 / fi X (2 16 – 1)
Count source
“H”
TAiIN pin
input signal
“L”
Trigger is not generated by this signal
1 / fi X n
“H”
PWM pulse output
from TAiOUT pin
“L”
“1”
Timer Ai interrupt
request bit
“0”
fi : Frequency of count source
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
(f1, f8, f32, fC32)
Note: n = 000016 to FFFE16.
Fig.FB-12 Example of how a 16-bit pulse width modulator operates
Condition : Reload register high-order 8 bits = 0216
Reload register low-order 8 bits = 0216
External trigger (falling edge of TAiIN pin input signal) is selected
1 / fi X (m + 1) X (2 8 – 1)
Count source (Note1)
TAiIN pin input signal
“H”
“L”
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
1 / fi X (m + 1)
“H”
Underflow signal of
8-bit prescaler (Note2) “L”
1 / fi X (m + 1) X n
PWM pulse output
from TAiOUT pin
“H”
Timer Ai interrupt
request bit
“1”
“L”
“0”
fi : Frequency of count source
(f1, f8, f32, fC32)
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Note 1: The 8-bit prescaler counts the count source.
Note 2: The 8-bit pulse width modulator counts the 8-bit prescaler's underflow signal.
Note 3: m = 0016 to FE16; n = 0016 to FE16.
Fig.FB-13 Example of how an 8-bit pulse width modulator operates
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 90 of 290
Timer B
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer B
Fig.FB-14 shows the block diagram of timer B. Fig.FB-15 and FB-16 show the timer B-related registers.
Use the timer Bi mode register (i = 0 to 5) bits 0 and 1 to choose the desired mode.
Timer B has three operation modes listed as follows:
• Timer mode: The timer counts an internal count source.
• Event counter mode: The timer counts pulses from an external source or a timer overflow.
• Pulse period/pulse width measuring mode: The timer measures an external signal's pulse period or
pulse width.
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Clock source selection
High-order 8 bits
Low-order 8 bits
f1
• Timer
• Pulse period/pulse width measurement
f8
f32
fC32
Reload register (16)
Counter (16)
• Event counter
Count start flag
Polarity switching
and edge pulse
TBiIN
(i = 0 to 5)
(address 038016)
Counter reset circuit
Can be selected in only
event counter mode
TBi
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B2
Timer B3
Timer B4
Timer B5
TBj overflow
(j = i – 1. Note, however,
j = 2 when i = 0,
j = 5 when i = 3)
Address
039116 039016
039316 039216
039516 039416
035116 035016
035316 035216
035516 035416
TBj
Timer B2
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B5
Timer B3
Timer B4
Fig.FB-14 Block diagram of timer B
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
TBiMR(i = 0 to 5) 039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode selection
bits
Function
b1 b0
TMOD1
MR0
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Event counter mode
1 0 : Pulse period/pulse width
measurement mode
1 1 : Inhibited
Function varies with each operation mode
MR1
MR2
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
A
AA
R
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
MR3
TCK0
TCK1
Count source selection bits
(Function varies with each operation mode)
Note 1: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 2: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Fig.FB-15 Timer B-related registers (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 91 of 290
W
Timer B
M16C/6K9 Group
Timer Bi register (Note)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TB0
TB1
TB2
TB3
TB4
TB5
Address
039116, 039016
039316, 039216
039516, 039416
035116, 035016
035316, 035216
035516, 035416
Function
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
AAA
AA
A
AA
Values that can be set
• Timer mode
Counts the timer's period
000016 to FFFF16
• Event counter mode
Counts external pulses input or a timer overflow
000016 to FFFF16
• Pulse period / pulse width measurement mode
Measures a pulse period or width
RW
Note: Read and write data in 16-bit units.
Count start flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
TABSR
b0
Address
038016
When reset
0016
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
AAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAA
Bit symbol
Bit name
TA0S
Timer A0 count start flag
TA1S
Timer A1 count start flag
TA2S
Timer A2 count start flag
TA3S
Timer A3 count start flag
TA4S
Timer A4 count start flag
TB0S
Timer B0 count start flag
TB1S
Timer B1 count start flag
TB2S
Timer B2 count start flag
Function
RW
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Timer B3, 4, 5 count start flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
TBSR
b0
Address
034016
When reset
000XXXXX2
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAA
Bit symbol
Bit name
Function
RW
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
TB3S
Timer B3 count start flag
TB4S
Timer B4 count start flag
TB5S
Timer B5 count start flag
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Clock prescaler reset flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
CPSRF
b0
Bit symbol
Address
038116
Bit name
When reset
0XXXXXXX2
Function
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
R W
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
AA
A
AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA
CPSR
Fig.FB-16 Timer B-related registers (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 92 of 290
Clock prescaler reset flag
0 : No effect
1 : Prescaler is reset
(When read, the value is “0”)
Timer B
M16C/6K9 Group
(1) Timer mode
In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. (See Table.FB-6.) Fig.FB-17 shows the
timer Bi mode register in timer mode.
Table.FB-6 Timer specifications in timer mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TBiIN pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
AA
A
AA
A
f1, f8, f32, fC32
•Counts down
•When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and
then continuing counting
1/(n+1) n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
The timer underflows
Programmable I/O port
Count value is read out by reading timer Bi register
•When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
TBiMR(i=0 to 5)
Address
039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode selection
bits
TMOD1
MR0
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
MR1
Invalid in timer mode
Can be “0” or “1”
MR2
0 (Set to “0” in timer mode ; i = 0, 3)
Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5).
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out
to be indeterminate.
MR3
Invalid in timer mode.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read in
timer mode, turns out to be indeterminate.
TCK0
Count source selection bits
TCK1
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
Note 1: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 2: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Fig.FB-17 Timer Bi mode register in timer mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 93 of 290
AA
A
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
A
AA
AA
R
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
W
Timer B
M16C/6K9 Group
(2) Event counter mode
In this mode, the timer counts an external signal or an internal timer's overflow. (See Table.FB-7) Fig.FB-18
shows the timer Bi mode register in event counter mode.
Table.FB-7 Timer specifications in event counter mode
Item
Count source
Specification
•External signals input to TBiIN pin
•Effective edge of count source can be a rising edge, a falling edge, or both
edges as selected by software
•Counts down
•When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and
then continuing counting
1/(n+1) n : Set value
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
Count operation
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TBiIN pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
AA
AA
The timer underflows
Count source input
Count value can be read out by reading timer Bi register
•When counting stopped
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to both reload register and counter
•When counting in progress
When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter at next reload time)
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
TBiMR(i=0 to 5)
Address
039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit symbol
Bit name
TMOD0
Operation mode selection
bits
TMOD1
MR0
Count polarity selection
bits (Note 1)
MR1
MR2
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
Function
b1 b0
0 1 : Event counter mode
b3 b2
0 0 : Counts external signal's
falling edges
0 1 : Counts external signal's
rising edges
1 0 : Counts external signal's
falling and rising edges
1 1 : Inhibited
0 (Fixed to “0” in event counter mode; i = 0, 3)
Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5).
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read,
turns out to be indeterminate.
MR3
Invalid in event counter mode.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read in
event counter mode, turns out to be indeterminate.
TCK0
Invalid in event counter mode.
Can be “0” or “1”.
TCK1
Event clock selection
0 : Input from TBiIN pin (Note 4)
1 : TBj overflow
AA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AAAA
AA
AA
AAAA
AAAA
(j = i – 1; however, j = 2 when i = 0,
j = 5 when i = 3)
Note 1: Valid only when input from the TBiIN pin is selected as the event clock.
If timer's overflow is selected, this bit can be “0” or “1”.
Note 2: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 3: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Note 4: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Fig.FB-18 Timer Bi mode register in event counter mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 94 of 290
R
(Note 2)
(Note 3)
W
Timer B
M16C/6K9 Group
(3) Pulse period/pulse width measurement mode
In this mode, the timer measures the pulse period or pulse width of an external signal. (See Table.FB-8)
Fig.FB-19 shows the timer Bi mode register in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode. Fig.FB-20
shows the operation timing when measuring a pulse period. Fig.FB-21 shows the operation timing when
measuring a pulse width.
Table.FB-8 Timer specifications in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
Specification
f1, f8, f32, fC32
•Up count
•At measurement pulse's effective edge, after the count value is transferred
to reload register, it is cleared to "000016" and then continues counting.
Count start flag is set (= 1)
Count start flag is reset (= 0)
•When measurement pulse's effective edge is input (Note 1)
•When an overflow occurs. (Simultaneously, the timer Bi overflow flag becomes
“1”. The timer Bi overflow flag becomes “0” when the count start flag is “1”
and a value is written to the timer Bi mode register.)
Measurement pulse input
When timer Bi register is read, it indicates the reload register’s content
(measurement result) (Note 2)
Cannot be written to
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
TBiIN pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Note 1: An interrupt request is not generated when the first effective edge is input after the timer has started counting.
Note 2: After count starts, the value read out from the timer Bi register is indeterminate until the second
effective edge is input .
Timer Bi mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
TBiMR(i=0 to 5)
Bit symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
MR0
Address
039B16 to 039D16
035B16 to 035D16
Bit name
Operation mode
selection bits
Measurement mode
selection bits
MR1
MR2
When reset
00XX00002
00XX00002
Function
b1 b0
1 0 : Pulse period / pulse width
measurement mode
b3 b2
0 0 : Pulse period measurement (Interval between
measurement pulse's falling edge to falling edge)
0 1 : Pulse period measurement (Interval between
measurement pulse's rising edge to rising edge)
1 0 : Pulse width measurement (Interval between
measurement pulse's falling edge to rising edge,
and between rising edge to falling edge)
1 1 : Inhibited
0 (Fixed to “0” in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode; i = 0, 3)
Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5).
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be
indeterminate.
MR3
Timer Bi overflow
flag ( Note 1)
TCK0
Count source
selection bits
TCK1
0 : Timer did not overflow
1 : Timer has overflowed
b7 b6
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
AAAA
AAA
AA
AAA
AAA
AAA
AAAA
AAA
R
W
(Note 2)
(Note 3)
Note 1: The timer Bi overflow flag becomes “0” when the count start flag is “1” and a value is written to the
timer Bi mode register. This flag cannot be set to “1” by software.
Note 2: Timer B0, timer B3.
Note 3: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Fig.FB-19 Timer Bi mode register in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 95 of 290
Timer B
M16C/6K9 Group
When measuring a pulse time interval from falling edge to falling edge
Count source
“H”
Measurement pulse
Reload register
transfer timing
“L”
Transfer
(indeterminate value)
Transfer
(measured value)
counter
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
Timing at which counter
reaches “000016”
“1”
Count start flag
“0”
“1”
Timer Bi interrupt
request bit
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software.
Timer Bi overflow flag
“1”
“0”
Note 1: Counter is initialized at completion of measurement.
Note 2: Timer has overflowed.
Fig.FB-20 Operation timing when measuring a pulse period
Count source
“H”
Measurement pulse
Reload register
transfer timing
“L”
counter
Transfer
(indeterminate
value)
(Note 1)
Transfer
(measured value)
(Note 1)
Transfer
(measured
value)
(Note 1)
Transfer
(measured value)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
Timing at which counter
reaches “000016”
“1”
Count start flag
“0”
“1”
Timer Bi interrupt
request bit
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software.
Timer Bi overflow flag
“1”
“0”
Note 1: Counter is initialized at completion of measurement.
Note 2: Timer has overflowed.
Fig.FB-21 Operation timing when measuring a pulse width
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 96 of 290
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
Serial I/O
Serial I/O is configured as five channels: UART0, UART1, UART2, S I/O3 and S I/O4.
UART0 to 2
Each of UART0 - UART2 has an exclusive timer to generate a transfer clock, operating independently from
each other.
Fig.GA-1 shows the block diagram of UART0, UART1 and UART2. Fig.GA-2 and GA-3 show the block
diagram of the transmit/receive unit.
UARTi (i = 0 to 2) has two operation modes: a clock synchronous serial I/O mode and a clock asynchronous
serial I/O mode (UART mode). The contents of the serial I/O mode selection bits (bits 0 to 2 at addresses
03A016, 03A816 and 037816) determine whether UARTi is used as a clock synchronous serial I/O or as a
UART. Although a few functions are different, UART0, UART1 and UART2 have almost the same functions.
UART0 through UART2 are almost equal in their functions with minor exceptions. UART2, in particular, is
compliant with the SIM interface with some extra settings added in clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode
(Note). It also has the bus collision detection function that generates an interrupt request if the TxD pin and
the RxD pin are different in level.
Table.GA-1 shows the comparison of functions of UART0 through UART2, and Fig.GA-4 to GA-8 show the
registers related to UARTi.
Note: SIM : Subscriber Identity Module
Table.GA-1 Comparison of functions of UART0 through UART2
Function
UART0
UART1
UART2
CLK polarity selection
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
LSB first / MSB first selection
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 2)
Continuous receive mode selection
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Possible
(Note 1)
Transfer clock output from multiple
pins selection
Impossible
Possible
(Note 1)
Impossible
Separate CTS/RTS pins
Possible
Impossible
Impossible
Serial data logic switch
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
Sleep mode selection
Possible
TxD, RxD I/O polarity switch
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
TxD, RxD port output format
CMOS output
CMOS output
N-channel open-drain
output
Parity error signal output
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
Bus collision detection
Impossible
Impossible
Possible
(Note 3)
Possible
Note 1: Only in clock synchronous serial I/O mode.
Note 2: Only in clock synchronous serial I/O mode and 8-bit UART mode.
Note 3: Only in UART mode.
Note 4: Can be used for SIM interface.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 97 of 290
(Note 3)
(Note 4)
Impossible
(Note 4)
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
(UART0)
RxD0
TxD0
UART reception
1/16
Clock source selection
Bit rate generator
Internal (address 03A116)
f1
f8
f32
Reception
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
1 / (n0+1)
UART transmission
1/16
Transmission
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
External
Receive
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
Transmit
clock
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
1/2
CLK
polarity
switching
circuit
CLK0
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is
selected)
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS/RTS selected
CTS0 / RTS0
RTS0
Vcc
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS0
CTS/RTS separated
CTS0 from UART1
(UART1)
RxD1
TxD1
Clock source selection
Bit rate generator
Internal (address 03A916)
f1
f8
f32
UART reception
1/16
1 / (n1+1)
Reception
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
UART transmission
1/16
Transmission
control circuit
Clock synchronous type
Clock synchronous type
External
Receive
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
Transmit
clock
(when internal clock is selected)
1/2
CLK1
CLK
polarity
switching
circuit
CTS1 / RTS1
/ CTS0 / CLKS1
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is
selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS/RTS separated
Clock output pin
select switch
RTS1
VCC
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS0
CTS1
CTS0 to UART0
(UART2)
RxD2
TxD
polarity
switching
circuit
RxD polarity
switching circuit
UART reception
Clock source selection
Bit rate generator
f1
Internal
(address 037916)
f8
f32
1 / (n2+1)
1/16
Clock synchronous type
UART transmission
1/16
Clock synchronous type
External
Reception
control circuit
Transmission
control circuit
Receive
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
Transmit
clock
Clock synchronous type
1/2
CLK2
CLK
polarity
switching
circuit
(when internal clock is selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CTS/RTS
selected
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is
selected)
CTS/RTS disabled
RTS2
CTS2 / RTS2
Vcc
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS2
n0 : Values set to UART0 bit rate generator (BRG0)
n1 : Values set to UART1 bit rate generator (BRG1)
n2 : Values set to UART2 bit rate generator (BRG2)
Fig.GA-1 Block diagram of UARTi (i = 0 to 2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 98 of 290
TxD2
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock
synchronous type
1SP
RxDi
SP
UART (7 bits)
UART (8 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
PAR
disabled
UARTi receive register
UART (7 bits)
PAR
SP
PAR
enabled
2SP
UART
UART (9 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
UART (8 bits)
UART (9 bits)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
UARTi receive
buffer register
Address 03A616
Address 03A716
Address 03AE16
Address 03AF16
MSB/LSB conversion circuit
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
MSB/LSB conversion circuit
D7
D8
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
UART (8 bits)
UART (9 bits)
UART (9 bits)
PAR enabled
2SP
SP
1SP
Clock synchronous
type
TxDi
PAR
disabled
“0”
Clock
synchronous
type
UART (7 bits)
Jun 06, 2003
page 99 of 290
UARTi transmit register
UART (7 bits)
UART (8 bits)
Clock synchronous
type
Fig.GA-2 Block diagram of UARTi (i = 0, 1) transmit/receive unit
Rev.1.00
UARTi transmit
buffer register
Address 03A216
Address 03A316
Address 03AA16
Address 03AB16
UART
PAR
SP
D0
SP: Stop bit
PAR: Parity bit
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
No reverse
RxD data
reverse circuit
RxD2
Reverse
Clock
synchronous type
PAR
disabled
1SP
SP
UART2 receive register
UART(7 bits)
PAR
SP
2SP
UART
PAR
enabled
0
UART
(7 bits)
UART
(8 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
0
0
0
0
Clock
synchronous type
UART
(9 bits)
0
0
UART
(8 bits)
UART
(9 bits)
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit
UART2 receive
buffer register
Address 037E16
Address 037F16
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Address 037A16
Address 037B16
UART
(8 bits)
UART
(9 bits)
PAR
enabled
2SP
SP
SP
UART
UART
(9 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
PAR
1SP
PAR
disabled
Clock
synchronous
type
“0”
UART
(7 bits)
UART
(8 bits)
UART(7 bits)
UART2 transmit register
Clock
synchronous type
Error signal output
disable
Not reverse
Error signal
output circuit
Error signal output
enable
TxD data
reverse circuit
Reverse
SP: Stop bit
PAR: Parity bit
Fig.GA-3 Block diagram of UART2 transmit/receive unit
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
UART2 transmit
buffer register
page 100 of 290
TxD2
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
UARTi transmit buffer register
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
Symbol
U0TB
U1TB
U2TB
b0
Address
03A316, 03A216
03AB16, 03AA16
037B16, 037A16
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
A
A
R W
Transmit data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turn out to be indeterminate.
UARTi receive buffer register
(b8)
b0 b7
(b15)
b7
Symbol
U0RB
U1RB
U2RB
b0
Bit
symbol
Address
03A716, 03A616
03AF16, 03AE16
037F16, 037E16
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
Receive data
Function
(During UART mode)
Receive data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
OER
Overrun error flag (Note 1) 0 : No overrun error
1 : Overrun error found
0 : No overrun error
1 : Overrun error found
FER
Framing error flag (Note 1) Invalid
0 : No framing error
1 : Framing error found
PER
Parity error flag (Note 1)
Invalid
0 : No parity error
1 : Parity error found
SUM
Error sum flag (Note 1)
Invalid
0 : No error
1 : Error found
A
A
A
A
AA
R W
Note 1: Bits 15 through 12 are set to “0” when the serial I/O mode selection bits (bits 2 to 0 at addresses
03A016, 03A816 and 037816) are set to “0002” or the receive enable bit is set to “0”.
(Bit 15 is set to “0” when bits 14 to 12 all are set to “0”.) Bits 14 and 13 are also set to “0” when the
lower byte of the UARTi receive buffer register (addresses 03A616, 03AE16 and 037E16) is read out.
UARTi bit rate generator
b7
Symbol
U0BRG
U1BRG
U2BRG
b0
Address
03A116
03A916
037916
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
Assuming that set value = n, BRGi divides the count source by
n+1
Fig.GA-4 Serial I/O-related registers (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 101 of 290
Values that can be set
0016 to FF16
A
R W
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
UARTi transmit/receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UiMR(i=0,1)
Bit
symbol
SMD0
Address
03A016, 03A816
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
Must be fixed to 001
Serial I/O mode selection
bits
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
SMD1
SMD2
Function
(During UART mode)
b2 b1 b0
R W
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
CKDIR Internal/external clock
selection bit
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 1)
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 1)
STPS
Stop bit length selection
bit
Invalid
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd/even parity selection Invalid
bit
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
Invalid
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
SLEP
Sleep selection bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Sleep mode deselected
1 : Sleep mode selected
Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to "0".
UART2 transmit/receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
U2MR
b0
Bit
symbol
SMD0
Address
037816
Bit name
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
b2 b1 b0
Serial I/O mode selection
bits
SMD1
SMD2
Must be fixed to 001
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 1)
Must always be "0"
STPS
Stop bit length selection
bit
Invalid
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd/even parity selection Invalid
bit
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
Invalid
IOPOL
TxD, RxD I/O polarity
switching bit
0 : Not reverse
1 : Reverse
Usually set to “0”
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
0 : Not reverse
1 : Reverse
Usually set to “0”
Fig.GA-5 Serial I/O-related registers (2)
Jun 06, 2003
page 102 of 290
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
AA
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid
0 1 0 : Inhibited
0 1 1 : Inhibited
1 1 1 : Inhibited
CKDIR Internal/external clock
selection bit
Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to "0".
Rev.1.00
Function
(During UART mode)
R W
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
UARTi transmit/receive control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UiC0(i=0,1)
Bit
symbol
Address
When reset
03A416, 03AC16
0816
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
b1 b0
CLK0
BRG count source
selection bits
CLK1
CRS
TXEPT
CTS/RTS function
selection bit
Function
(During UART mode)
b1 b0
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : Data present in transmit
0 : Data present in transmit register
Transmit register empty
register (during transmission)
(during transmission)
1 : No data present in transmit
flag
1 : No data present in transmit
register
(transmission completed)
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(Pins function as
programmable I/O port)
register (transmission completed)
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(Pins function as programmable
I/O port)
CRD
CTS/RTS disable bit
NCH
Data output selection bit 0 : TXDi pin is CMOS output
0: TXDi pin is CMOS output
1: TXDi pin is N-channel open-drain
output
CKPOL
CLK polarity selection bit 0 : Transmit data is output at
Must always be “0”
1 : TXDi pin is N-channel opendrain output
falling edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at
rising edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
falling edge
UFORM Transfer format selection 0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
bit
Must always be “0”
AA
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
R W
Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
UART2 transmit/receive control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U2C0
Bit
symbol
CLK0
Address
037C16
Bit name
TXEPT
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
b1 b0
b1 b0
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
0 0 : f1 is selected
0 1 : f8 is selected
1 0 : f32 is selected
1 1 : Inhibited
CTS/RTS function
selection bit
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
Valid when bit 4 = “0”
0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1) 0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1)
1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2) 1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2)
0 : Data present in transmit register
Transmit register empty 0 : Data present in transmit
register (during transmission)
(during transmission)
flag
1 : No data present in transmit 1 : No data present in transmit register
register
(transmission completed)
CRD
Function
(During UART mode)
BRG count source
selection bits
CLK1
CRS
When reset
0816
CTS/RTS disable bit
(transmission completed)
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled 1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
(Pins function programmable
(Pins function programmable
I/O port)
I/O port)
0 : TXDi pin is CMOS output
Nothing is assigned.
: TXDi pin is N-channel
In an attempt to write to this bit, write1“0”.
The value, if read, turns
open-drain output
0 : Transmit data is output at
CKPOL CLK polarity selection bit
falling edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at
rising edge of transfer clock
and receive data is input at
falling edge
UFORM Transfer format selection 0 : LSB first
bit (Note 3)
1 : MSB first
0: TXDi pin is CMOS output
1: TXDi pin is N-channel
out
to be “0”.
open-drain output
Must always be “0”
0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
AA
A
AA
R W
A
A
A
A
Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”.
Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid.
Note 3: Only clock synchronous serial I/O mode and 8-bit UART mode are valid.
Fig.GA-6 Serial I/O-related registers (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 103 of 290
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
UARTi transmit/receive control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
UiC1(i=0,1)
b0
Bit
symbol
Address
03A516,03AD16
When reset
0216
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
Function
(During UART mode)
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
TI
Transmit buffer empty flag 0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
RE
Receive enable bit
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
RI
Receive complete flag
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
TE
Transmit enable bit
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
AA
A
AA
A
A
R W
UART2 transmit/receive control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
U2C1
b0
Bit
symbol
Address
037D16
Bit name
Function
(During UART mode)
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
TI
Transmit buffer empty flag 0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
0 : Data present in
transmit buffer register
1 : No data present in
transmit buffer register
RE
Receive enable bit
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
RI
Receive complete flag
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
0 : No data present in
receive buffer register
1 : Data present in
receive buffer register
UART2 transmit interrupt
factor selection bit
0 : Transmit buffer empty
(TI = 1)
1 : Transmit is completed
(TXEPT = 1)
0 : Transmit buffer empty
(TI = 1)
1 : Transmit is completed
(TXEPT = 1)
U2RRM UART2 continuous
receive mode enable bit
0 : Continuous receive
mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive
mode enabled
Invalid
U2LCH Data logic selection bit
0 : Not reverse
1 : Reverse
0 : Not reverse
1 : Reverse
U2ERE Error signal output
enable bit
Must be fixed to “0”
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
U2IRS
Transmit enable bit
Fig.GA-7 Serial I/O-related registers (4)
Jun 06, 2003
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
TE
Rev.1.00
When reset
0216
page 104 of 290
AA
A
A
A
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
R W
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
UART transmit/receive control register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UCON
Bit
symbol
U0IRS
U1IRS
Address
03B016
When reset
X00000002
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Bit name
UART0 transmit interrupt
factor selection bit
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
UART1 transmit interrupt
factor selection bit
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
(TXEPT = 1)
(TXEPT = 1)
U0RRM UART0 continuous
receive mode enable bit
0 : Continuous receive
mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive
mode enabled
U1RRM UART1 continuous
receive mode enable bit
Function
(During UART mode)
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
(TXEPT = 1)
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1)
1 : Transmission completed
(TXEPT = 1)
Invalid
0 : Continuous receive
mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive
mode enabled
CLKMD0 CLK/CLKS selection bit 0 Valid when bit 5 = “1”
0 : Clock output to CLK1
1 : Clock output to CLKS1
Invalid
CLKMD1 CLK/CLKS selection bit 1 0 : Normal mode
(CLK output is CLK1 only)
(Note)
1 : Transfer clock output
from multiple pins
function selected
Must always be “0”
RCSP
0 : CTS/RTS shared pin
1 : CTS/RTS separated
Separate CTS/RTS bit
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
Invalid
0 : CTS/RTS shared pin
1 : CTS/RTS separated
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
Note: When using multiple pins to output the transfer clock, the following requirements must be met:
• UART1 internal/external clock selection bit (bit 3 at address 03A816) = “0”.
UART2 special mode register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
U2SMR
0 0 0 0
Bit
symbol
Address
037716
Bit name
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Function
(During UART mode)
Reserved bits
Must always be “0”
ABSCS
Bus collision detect
sampling
clock selection bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Rising edge of transfer
clock
1 : Underflow signal of timer A0
ACSE
Auto clear function
selection bit of
transmit enable bit
Must always be “0”
0 : No auto clear function
1 : Auto clear at occurrence of
bus collision
SSS
Transmit start condition
selection bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Ordinary
1 : Falling edge of RxD2
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Fig.GA-8 Serial I/O-related registers (5)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 105 of 290
R W
A
A
A
M16C/6K9 Group
Serial I/O
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(1) Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
The clock synchronous serial I/O mode uses a transfer clock to transmit and receive data. Tables.GA-2 and
GA-3 list the specifications of the clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Fig.GA-9 shows the UARTi transmit/
receive mode register.
Table.GA-2 Specifications of clock synchronous serial I/O mode (1)
Item
Specification
Transfer data format
• Transfer data length: 8 bits
Transfer clock
• When internal clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816
= “0”) : fi/ 2(n+1) (Note 1) fi = f1, f8, f32
• When external clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816
= “1”) : Input from CLKi pin
_______
_______
_______ _______
Transmission/reception control • Selecting from CTS function/RTS function/Disable CTS, RTS function
Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met:
_ Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
_ Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0”
_______
_______
_ When CTS function selected, CTS input level = “L”
• Furthermore, if external clock is selected, the following requirements must also be met:
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”:
CLKi input level = “H”
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”:
CLKi input level = “L”
Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met:
_ Receive enable bit (bit 2 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
_ Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
_ Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0”
• Furthermore, if external clock is selected, the following requirements must
also be met:
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”:
CLKi input level = “H”
_ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”:
CLKi input level = “L”
• When transmitting
_ Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit 4 at
Interrupt request
address 037D16) = “0”: At the completion of data transmission from UARTi
generation timing
transfer buffer register to UARTi transmit register
_ Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit 4 at
address 037D16) = “1”: At the completion of data transmission from
UARTi transfer register is completed
• When receiving
_ At the completion of data transferring from UARTi receive register to
UARTi receive buffer register
Error detection
• Overrun error (Note 2)
This error occurs when the next data is ready before contents of UARTi
receive buffer register are read out
Note 1: “n” denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UART bit rate generator.
Note 2: If an overrun error occurs, the UARTi receive buffer will have the next data written in. Note also that
the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 106 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Serial I/O
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
Table.GA-3 Specifications of clock synchronous serial I/O mode (2)
Item
Function selection
Specification
• CLK polarity selection
Whether transmit data is output/input at the rising edge or falling edge of the
transfer clock can be selected
• LSB first/MSB first selection
Whether transmission/reception begins with bit 0 or bit 7 can be selected
• Continuous receive mode selection
Reception is enabled simultaneously by a read from the receive buffer register
• Transfer clock output from multiple pins selection (UART1) (Note)
UART1 transfer clock can be chosen by software to be output from one of
the two pins set
_______ _______
• Separate CTS/RTS pins (UART0) (Note)
_______
_______
Each of UART0 CTS and RTS pins can be assigned to separate pins
• Switching serial data logic (UART2)
Whether to reverse data in writing to the transmission buffer register or
reading the reception buffer register can be selected.
• TxD, RxD I/O polarity switching (UART2)
This function is reversing TxD port output and RxD port input. All I/O data
level is reversed.
_______ _______
Note: The transfer clock output from multiple pins and the separate CTS/RTS pins functions cannot be
selected simultaneously.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 107 of 290
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
UARTi transmit/receive mode registers
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
0 0 1
Symbol
UiMR(i=0,1)
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
03A016, 03A816
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
Serial I/O mode selection bits
SMD1
SMD2
CKDIR
Internal/external clock
selection bit
b2 b1 b0
0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial
I/O mode
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 1)
STPS
PRY
Invalid in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
PRYE
0 (Must always be “0” in clock synchronous serial I/O mode)
SLEP
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
A
A
AA
AA
AA
RW
Note 1: The corresponding port direction register should be "0".
UART2 transmit/receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
0
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U2MR
0 0 1
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
037816
Bit name
Serial I/O mode selection bit
SMD1
SMD2
CKDIR
When reset
0016
Internal/external clock
selection bit
Function
b2 b1 b0
0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial
I/O mode
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 2)
STPS
PRY
Invalid in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
PRYE
IOPOL
TxD, RxD I/O polarity
reverse bit (Note 1)
A
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
AA
RW
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
Note 1: Usually sent to "0".
Note 2: The corresponding port direction register should be "0".
Fig.GA-9 UARTi transmit/receive mode register in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 108 of 290
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
Table.GA-4 lists the functions of the input/output pins during clock synchronous serial I/O mode. This table
_______ _______
shows the pin functions that the transfer clock output from multiple pins and the separation of CTS/RTS pins
are not selected. Note that for a period from when the UARTi operation mode is selected to when transfer
starts, the TxDi pin outputs a “H”. (If the N-channel open-drain is selected, this pin is in floating state.)
Table.GA-4 Input/output pin functions in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(The function that the transfer clock output from multiple pin is not selected. The function that separates
CTS/RTS pins is not selected.)
Pin name
Function
Method of selection
TxDi
Serial data output
(Outputs dummy data when performing reception only)
RxDi
Serial data input
The corresponding bit of port direction register = “0”
(Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only)
CLKi
Transfer clock output
Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “0”
Transfer clock input
Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “1”
The corresponding bit of port direction register = “0”
CTS input
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) =“0”
CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
The corresponding port direction bit = “0”
RTS output
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
Programmable I/O port
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
CTSi/RTSi
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 109 of 290
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
• Example of transmit timing (when internal clock is selected)
Tc
Transfer clock
“1”
Transmit enable
bit (TE)
“0”
Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag (Tl)
“0”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
“H”
CTSi
TCLK
“L”
Stopped because CTS = “H”
Stopped because transfer enable bit = “0”
CLKi
TxDi
D 0 D1 D2 D 3 D 4 D 5 D 6 D 7
Transmit
register empty
flag (TXEPT)
D0 D1 D2 D 3 D 4 D5 D 6 D7
D0 D 1 D2 D 3 D 4 D 5 D 6 D 7
“1”
“0”
Transmit interrupt “1”
“0”
request bit (IR)
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
Tc = TCLK = 2(n + 1) / fi
fi: frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
n: value set to BRGi
The above timing applies to the following settings:
• Internal clock is selected.
• CTS function is selected.
• CLK polarity selection bit = “0”.
• Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “0”.
• Example of receive timing (when external clock is selected)
“1”
Receive enable
bit (RE)
“0”
Transmit enable
bit (TE)
“0”
Transmit buffer
empty flag (Tl)
“1”
“0”
“H”
RTSi
Dummy data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register
“1”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
“L”
1 / fEXT
CLKi
Receive data is taken in
D0 D1 D 2 D 3 D4 D5 D 6 D7
RxDi
“1”
Receive complete
“0”
flag (Rl)
Receive interrupt
request bit (IR)
Transferred from UARTi receive register
to UARTi receive buffer register
D 0 D1 D 2
D 3 D4 D5
Read out from UARTi receive buffer register
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings:
• External clock is selected.
• RTS function is selected.
• CLK polarity selection bit = “0”.
fEXT: frequency of external clock
The following conditions should be matched when the input level of
CLKi pin is "H" before the data reception.
• Transmit enable bit “1”
• Receive enable bit “1”
• Dummy data write to UARTi transmit buffer register
Fig.GA-10 Typical transmit/receive timings in clock synchronous serial I/O mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 110 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Serial I/O
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(a) Polarity selection function
As shown in Fig.GA-11, the CLK polarity selection bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) allows to
select the polarity of the transfer clock.
• When CLK polarity selection bit = “0”
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note 1: The CLK pin level is "H" when
there is no transferring.
• When CLK polarity select bit = “1”
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note 2: The CLK pin level is "L" when
there is no transferring.
Fig.GA-11 Polarity of transfer clock
(b) LSB first/MSB first selection function
As shown in Fig.GA-12, when the transfer format selection bit (bit 7 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16)
= “0”, the transfer format is “LSB first”; when the bit = “1”, the transfer format is “MSB first”.
• When transfer format selection bit = “0”
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
LSB first
• When transfer format selection bit = “1”
CLKi
TXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
RXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
MSB first
Note: This applies when the CLK polarity selection bit = “0”.
Fig.GA-12 Transfer format
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 111 of 290
Serial I/O
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
(c) Transfer clock output from multiple pins function (UART1)
This function allows to set two transfer clock output pins and chooses one to output a clock by the setting of
CLK and CLKS selection bits (bits 4 and 5 at address 03B016). (See Fig.GA-13) The function is valid only
_______ _______
when the UART1 internal clock is selected. Note that when this function is selected, UART1 CTS/RTS
function cannot be used.
Microcomputer
TXD1
CLKS1
CLK1
IN
IN
CLK
CLK
Fig.GA-13 The sample of transfer clock output from the multiple pins function
(d) Continuous receive mode
If the continuous receive mode enable bits (bits 2 and 3 at address 03B016, bit 5 at address 037D16) are set
to “1”, the unit is placed in continuous receive mode. In this mode, when the receive buffer register is read
out, the unit simultaneously goes to a receive enable state without having to set dummy data to the transmit
buffer register back again.
_______ _______
(e) Separate CTS/RTS pins function (UART0)
This function works the same way as in the clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode. The method of
setting and the input/output pin functions are both the same, so refer to the selection function in the next
section, “(2) Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode.” Note that this function is invalid if the transfer
clock output from the multiple pins function is selected.
(f) Serial data logic switch function (UART2)
When the data logic selection bit (bit6 at address 037D16) = “1”, the data writing to transmit buffer register or
reading from receive buffer register, are reversed. Fig.GA-14 shows the example of serial data logic switch
timing.
•When LSB first
Transfer clock
“H”
“L”
TxD2
“H”
(no reverse) “L”
TxD2
“H”
(reverse) “L”
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Fig.GA-14 Serial data logic switch timing
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 112 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
(2) Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
The UART mode allows transmitting and receiving data after setting the desired transfer rate and transfer
data format. Tables.GA-5 and GA-6 list the specifications of the UART mode. Fig.GA-15 shows the UARTi
transmit/receive mode register.
Table.GA-5 Specifications of UART Mode (1)
Item
Transfer data format
Specification
• Character bit (transfer data): 7 bits, 8 bits, or 9 bits as selected
• Start bit: 1 bit
• Parity bit: Odd, even, or nothing as selected
• Stop bit: 1 bit or 2 bits as selected
Transfer clock
• When internal clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816 = “0”) :
fi/16(n+1) (Note 1) fi = f1, f8, f32
• When external clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816 =“1”) :
fEXT/16(n+1)(Note 1) (Note 2)
• Do not select the external clock in UART2.
_______
_______
_______ _______
Transmission/reception control • Selecting from CTS function/ RTS function/ Disable CTS, RTS function
Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met:
- Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
- Transmit
buffer empty flag (bit 1 at
addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0”
_______
_______
- When CTS function is selected CTS input level = “L”
Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met:
- Receive enable bit (bit 2 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1”
- Start bit detection
Interrupt request
• When transmitting
generation timing
- Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0,1 at address 03B016, bit4 at
address 037D16) = “0”: At the completion of data transferring from UARTi
transfer buffer register to UARTi transmit register
- Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit4 at
address 037D16) = “1”: At the completion of data transmission from
UARTi transfer register
• When receiving
- At the completion of data transferring from UARTi receive register to
UARTi receive buffer register
Error detection
• Overrun error (Note 3)
This error occurs when the bit prior to the stop bit of next data is received
before the contents of UARTi receive buffer register are read out.
• Framing error
This error occurs when the number set for stop bits is not detected
• Parity error
This error occurs in the case that parity is enabled and the number of "1" in
parity bit and character bits does not match the number of "1" in parity odd/
even setting.
• Error sum flag
This flag is set (= 1) when any of the overrun, framing, and parity errors is
encountered
Note 1: ‘n’ denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UARTi bit rate register.
Note 2: fEXT is input from the CLKi pin.
Note 3: If an overrun error occurs, the UARTi receive buffer will have the next data written in. Also note
that the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 113 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
Table.GA-6 Specifications of UART Mode (2)
Item
Specification
_______ _______
Function selection
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
• Separate CTS/RTS pins (UART0)
_______
_______
Each of UART0 CTS and RTS pins can be assigned to separate pins
• Sleep mode selection (UART0, UART1)
This mode is used to transfer data to and from one of multiple slave microcomputers
• Serial data logic switch (UART2)
This function is reversing logic value of transferring data. Start bit,and stop
bit are not reversed.
• TXD, RXD I/O polarity switch (UART2)
This function is reversing TXD port output and RXD port input. All I/O data
level are reversed.
page 114 of 290
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
UARTi transmit / receive mode registers
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UiMR(i=0,1)
Bit symbol
SMD0
Address
03A016, 03A816
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
Serial I/O mode selection bits
SMD1
SMD2
b2 b1 b0
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
CKDIR
Internal / external clock
selection bit
0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock (Note 1)
STPS
Stop bit length select bit
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd / even parity select bit
Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
SLEP
Sleep selection bit
0 : Sleep mode deselected
1 : Sleep mode selected
AA
A
AA
A
A
A
A
A
A
AA
AA
A
A
AA
R W
Note 1: The corresponding port direction register should be "0".
UART2 transmit / receive mode register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
U2MR
b0
Address
037816
Bit symbol
SMD0
When reset
0016
Bit name
Serial I/O mode selection bits
SMD1
SMD2
Function
b2 b1 b0
1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long
CKDIR
Internal / external clock
selection bit
Must always be "0"
STPS
Stop bit length select bit
0 : One stop bit
1 : Two stop bits
PRY
Odd / even parity selection bit Valid when bit 6 = “1”
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
PRYE
Parity enable bit
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
IOPOL
TxD, RxD I/O polarity
switching bit (Note)
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
Note: Usually set to “0”.
Fig.GA-15 UARTi transmit/receive mode register in UART mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 115 of 290
A
A
A
A
AA
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
AA
AA
R W
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Table.GA-7 lists the functions of the input/output pins during UART mode. This table shows the pin functions
_______ _______
when the separate CTS/RTS pins function is not selected. Note that for a period from when the UARTi
operation mode is selected to when transfer starts, the TxDi pin outputs a “H”. (If the N-channel open-drain
is selected, this pin is in floating state.)
________________
Table.GA-7 Input/output pin functions in UART mode (when CTS/RTS separate function is not selected)
Pin name
Function
Method of selection
TxDi
Serial data output
RxDi
Serial data input
Corresponding port direction register bit = "0".(Can be used as an input port
when performing transmission only)
CLKi
Programmable I/O port
Internal/external clock selection bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “0”
Transfer clock input
Internal/external clock selection bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816) = “1”
Corresponding port direction register bit = “0” (Don't select the external clock
for UART2)
CTS input
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) =“0”
CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
Corresponding port direction register bit = “0”
RTS output
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”
CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
Programmable I/O port
CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”
CTSi/RTSi
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 116 of 290
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
• Example of transmit timing when transfer data are 8 bits long (parity enabled, one stop bit)
The transfer clock stops momentarily as CTS is “H” when the stop bit is checked.
The transfer clock starts as the transfer starts immediately CTS changes to “L”.
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register.
“0”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
“H”
CTSi
“L”
Start
bit
TxDi
Parity
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stopped because transmit enable bit = “0”
Stop
bit
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
ST D0 D1
P SP
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT)
“0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• CTS function is selected.
• Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
fEXT : frequency of BRGi count source (external clock)
n : value set to BRGi
• Example of transmit timing when transfer data are 9 bits long (parity disabled, two stop bits)
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register
“0”
Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register
Start
bit
TxDi
Stop
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP
Stop
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SPSP
ST D0 D1
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT) “0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is disabled.
• Two stop bits.
• CTS function is disabled.
• Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “0”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
fEXT : frequency of BRGi count source (external clock)
n : value set to BRGi
Fig.GA-16 Typical transmit timings in UART mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 117 of 290
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
• Example of transmit timing when transfer data are 8 bits long (parity enabled, one stop bit)
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in USAR2 transmit buffer register
Note1
“0”
Transferred from UART2 transmit buffer register to UART2 transmit register
Start
bit
TxD2
Parity Stop
bit
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
“1”
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT)
“0”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi
fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32)
n : value set to BRGi
Note1. According to the above timing, the transmission is started by the timing of BRG overflow after writing to the transmit buffer.
Fig.GA-17 Typical transmit timings in UART mode (UART2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 118 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
• Example of receive timing when transfer data are 8 bits long (parity disabled, one stop bit)
BRGi count
source
Receive enable bit
“1”
“0”
Stop bit
Start bit
RxDi
D0
D1
D7
Sampled “L”
Receive data taken in
Transfer clock
Receive
complete flag
RTSi
Receive interrupt
request bit
Reception triggered when transfer clock
“1” is generated by falling edge of start bit
“0”
“H”
“L”
“1”
“0”
Transferred from UARTi receive register to
UARTi receive buffer register
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
The above timing applies to the following settings :
•Parity is disabled.
•One stop bit.
•RTS function is selected.
Fig.GA-18 Typical receive timing in UART mode
_______ _______
(a) Separate CTS/RTS pins function (UART0)
_______ _______
_______
_______
Setting the CTS/RTS separate bit (bit 6 of address 03B016) to "1" separates the RTS and CTS signals to
_______
_______
_______ _______
different input/out pins.(Fig GA-19). Choosing one from CTS or RTS, by using of the CTS/RTS function
selection bit (bit 2 of address 03A416). This function is effective in UART0 only. If the function is used, the
_______ _______
_______ _______
user cannot use the CTS/RTS function of UART1. Set "0" both to the CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 of
_______ _______
address 03AC16) and to the CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 of address 03AC16).
IC
Microcomputer
TXD0
IN
RXD0
OUT
RTS0
CTS
CTS0
RTS
Note : The user cannot use CTS and RTS at the same time.
_______ _______
Fig.GA-19 The separate CTS/RTS pins function usage
(b) Sleep mode (UART0, UART1)
This mode is used to transfer data between specific microcomputers among multiple microcomputers connected with UARTi. The sleep mode is selected when the sleep selection bit (bit 7 at addresses 03A016,
03A816) is set to “1” during reception. In this mode, the unit performs receive operation when the MSB of the
received data = “1” and does not perform receive operation when the MSB = “0”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 119 of 290
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
(c) Function for switching serial data logic (UART2)
When the data logic selection bit (bit 6 of address 037D16) is assigned 1, data is inverted in writing to the
transmission buffer register or reading the reception buffer register. Fig.GA-20 shows the example of timing
for switching serial data logic.
• When LSB first, parity enabled, one stop bit
Transfer clock
“H”
“L”
TxD2
“H”
(no reverse)
“L”
TxD2
“H”
(reverse)
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
“L”
ST : Start bit
P : Even parity
SP : Stop bit
Fig.GA-20 Timing for switching serial data logic
(d) TxD, RxD I/O polarity switching function (UART2)
This function is to reverse TXD pin output and RXD pin input. The level of any data to be input or output
(including the start bit, stop bit(s), and parity bit) is reversed. Set this function to “0” (not to reverse) for usual
use.
(e) Bus collision detection function (UART2)
This function is to sample the output level of the TXD pin and the input level of the RXD pin at the rising edge
of the transfer clock; if their values are different, then an interrupt request occurs. Fig.GA-21 shows the
example of detection timing of a bus collision (in UART mode).
Transfer clock
“H”
“L”
TxD2
“H”
“L”
RxD2
“H”
ST
SP
ST
SP
“L”
Bus collision detection
interrupt request signal
“1”
Bus collision detection
interrupt request bit
“1”
“0”
“0”
ST : Start bit
SP : Stop bit
Fig.GA-21 Detection timing of a bus collision (in UART mode)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 120 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
(3) Clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface)
The SIM interface is used for connecting the microcomputer with a memory card IC or the like; adding some extra
settings in UART2 clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode allows the user to effect this function. Table.GA-8 shows
the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface).
Table.GA-8 Specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with SIM I/F)
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Specification
• Transfer data 8-bit UART mode (bit 2 through bit 0 of address 037816 = “1012”)
• One stop bit (bit 4 of address 037816 = “0”)
• With the direct format chosen
Set parity to “even” (bit 5 and bit 6 of address 037816 = “1” and “1” respectively)
Set data logic to “direct” (bit 6 of address 037D16 = “0”).
Set transfer format to LSB (bit 7 of address 037C16 = “0”).
• With the inverse format chosen
Set parity to “odd” (bit 5 and bit 6 of address 037816 = “0” and “1” respectively)
Set data logic to “inverse” (bit 6 of address 037D16 = “1”)
Set transfer format to MSB (bit 7 of address 037C16 = “1”)
• With the internal clock chosen (bit 3 of address 037816 = “0”) : fi / 16 (n + 1) (Note 1) : fi=f1, f8, f32
• Don't chose external clock.
_______
_______
Transmission / reception control • Disable the CTS and RTS function (bit 4 of address 037C16 = “1”)
Other settings
• The sleep mode selection function is not available for UART2
• Set transmission interrupt factor to “transmission completed” (bit 4 of address 037D16 = “1”)
Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met:
- Transmit enable bit (bit 0 of address 037D16) = “1”
- Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 of address 037D16) = “0”
Reception start condition
• To start reception, the following requirements must be met:
- Reception enable bit (bit 2 of address 037D16) = “1”
- Detection of a start bit
Interrupt request
• When transmitting
generation timing
When data transmission from the UART2 transfer register is completed
(bit 4 of address 037D16 = “1”)
• When receiving
When data transfer from the UART2 receive register to the UART2 receive
buffer register is completed
Error detection
• Overrun error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O) (Note 2)
• Framing error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O)
• Parity error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O)
- On the reception side, an “L” level is output from the TXD2 pin by use of the parity error
signal output function (bit 7 of address 037D16 = “1”) when a parity error is detected
- On the transmission side, a parity error is detected by the level of input to
the RXD2 pin when a transmission interrupt occurs
• The error sum flag (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O)
Note 1: ‘n’ denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UARTi bit rate generator.
Note 2: If an overrun error occurs, the UART2 receive buffer will have the next data written in. Also Note
that the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 121 of 290
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Tc
Transfer clock
Transmit enable
bit(TE)
“1”
Transmit buffer
empty flag(TI)
“1”
“0”
Data is set in UART2 transmit buffer register
Note1
“0”
Transferred from UART2 transmit buffer register to UART2 transmit register
Start
bit
TxD2
Parity
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stop
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
SP
RxD2
P
SP
P
SP
A "L" level returns from TxD2 due to the
occurrence of a parity error
Signal conductor level
(Note1)
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
Transmit register
empty flag (TXEPT)
“1”
Transmit interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
P
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
SP
The level is detected by
the interrupt routine
The level is detected by
the interrupt routine
“0”
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi
fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32)
n : value set to BRG2
Note 1. According to the above timing, the transmission is started by the timing of BRG overflow after writing to the transmit buffer.
Tc
Transfer clock
Receive enable
bit(RE)
“1”
“0”
Start
bit
RxD2
Parity
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
Stop
bit
SP
TxD2
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
P
SP
P
SP
A "L" level returns from TxD2 due to the
occurrence of a parity error
Signal conductor level
(Note 2)
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
Receive complete
flag (RI)
“1”
Receive interrupt
request bit (IR)
“1”
P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
“0”
Read to receive buffer
Read to receive buffer
“0”
Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software
Shown in ( ) are bit symbols.
The above timing applies to the following settings :
• Parity is enabled.
• One stop bit.
• Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”.
Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi
fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32)
n : value set to BRG2
Note 2. The waveforms are the same because TxD2 and RxD2 are connected.
Fig.GA-22 Typical transmit/receive timing in UART mode (compliant with the SIM interface)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 122 of 290
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
M16C/6K9 Group
(a) Function for outputting a parity error signal
With the error signal output enable bit (bit 7 of address 037D16) assigned “1”, an “L” level from the TxD2 pin
will be output when a parity error is detected. Link with this function, the timing to generate a transmission
completion interrupt varies according to the timing of a parity error signal detection. Fig.GA-23 shows the
timing of the parity error signal output.
• LSB first
Transfer
clock
“H”
“L”
RxD2
“H”
TxD2
“H”
ST
D0
D1
D2
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
Hi-Z
“L”
Receive
complete flag
D3
“L”
“1”
“0”
ST : Start bit
P : Even parity
SP : Stop bit
Fig.GA-23 Timing of the parity error signal output
(b) Direct format/inverse format
Connecting the SIM card allows you to switch between direct format and inverse format. If you choose the
direct format, data are output from TxD2 beginning with D0. If you choose the inverse format, data are
inverted and output from TxD2 beginning with D7.
Fig.GA-24 shows the SIM interface format.
Transfer clcck
TxD2
(direct)
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
TxD2
(inverse)
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
P
P : Even parity
Fig.GA-24 SIM interface format
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 123 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
Fig.GA-25 shows the example of connecting the SIM interface. Connect TXD2 and RXD2 and apply pull-up.
Microcomputer
SIM card
TxD2
RxD2
Fig.GA-25 Connecting the SIM interface
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 124 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
UART2 Special Mode Register
The UART2 special mode register (address 037716) is used to control UART2 in various ways.
Fig.GA-26 shows the UART2 special mode register.
UART2 special mode register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
U2SMR
0 0 0 0
Bit
symbol
Address
037716
Bit name
When reset
0016
Function
(During clock synchronous
serial I/O mode)
Function
(During UART mode)
Reserved bits
Must always be “0”
ABSCS
Bus collision detect
sampling clock selection
bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Rising edge of transfer
clock
1 : Underflow signal of timer A0
ACSE
Auto clear function
selection bit of
transmit enable bit
Must always be “0”
0 : No auto clear function
1 : Auto clear at occurrence of
bus collision
Transmit start condition
selection bit
Must always be “0”
0 : Ordinary
1 : Falling edge of RxD2
Reserved bit
Must always be “0”
SSS
R W
A
A
A
Fig.GA-26 UART2 special mode register
Some other functions added are explained here. Fig.GA-27 shows their workings.
Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the bus collision detect sampling clock selection bit. The
bus collision detect interrupt occurs when the RxD2 level and TxD2 level do not match, but the nonconformity is detected in synchronization with the rising edge of the transfer clock signal if the bit is set to “0”. If this
bit is set to “1”, the nonconformity is detected at the timing of the overflow of timer A0 rather than at the rising
edge of the transfer clock.
Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the auto clear function selection bit of transmit enable bit.
Setting this bit to “1” automatically resets the transmit enable bit to “0” when “1” is set in the bus collision
detect interrupt request bit (nonconformity).
Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the transmit start condition selection bit. Setting this bit
to “1” starts the TxD transmission in synchronization with the falling edge of the RxD pin.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 125 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
1. Bus collision detect sampling clock select bit (Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register)
0: Rising edges of the transfer clock
CLK
TxD/RxD
1: Timer A0 overflow
Timer A0
2. Auto clear function selection bit of transmit enable bit (Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register)
CLK
TxD/RxD
Bus collision
detect interrupt
request bit
Transmit
enable bit
3. Transmit start condition selection bit (Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register)
0: In normal state
CLK
TxD
Enabling transmission
With "1: falling edge of RxD2" selected
CLK
TxD
RxD
Fig.GA-27 Some other functions added
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 126 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
S I/O3, 4
S I/O3, 4
S I/O 3 and S I/O 4 are exclusive clock-synchronous serial I/Os.
Fig.GA-28 shows the S I/O 3, 4 block diagram, and Fig.GA-29 shows the S I/O 3, 4 control register.
Table.GA-9 shows the specifications of S I/O 3, 4.
f1
Data bus
SMi1
SMi0
f8
f32
Synchronous
circuit
1/2
1/(ni+1)
Transfer rate register (8)
SMi3
SMi6
SMi6
S I/O counter i (3)
CLKi
SMi2
SMi3
SMi5 LSB
MSB
SOUTi
S I/Oi transmission/reception register (8)
SINi
8
Note: i = 3, 4.
ni = A value set in the S I/O transfer rate register i (036316, 036716).
Fig.GA-28 S I/O3, 4 block diagram
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 127 of 290
S I/Oi
interrupt request
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
S I/O3, 4
S I/Oi control register (i = 3, 4) (Note 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
SiC
0
Bit
symbol
SMi0
Address
036216, 036616
When reset
4016
Description
Bit name
R W
b1 b0
Internal synchronous
clock selection bits
0 0 : Selecting f1
0 1 : Selecting f8
1 0 : Selecting f32
1 1 : Not to be used
SMi1
SMi2
SOUTi output disable bit
0 : SOUTi output
1 : SOUTi output disable (high impedance)
SMi3
S I/Oi port selection bit
(Note 2)
0 : Input-output port
1 : SOUTi output, CLK function
Reserved bit
Must be "0"
SMi5
Transfer direction
selection bit lect bitç
0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
SMi6
Synchronous clock
selection bit (Note 2)
0 : External clock
1 : Internal clock
SMi7
SOUTi initial value
set bit
Effective when SMi3 = 0
0 : L output
1 : H output
Note 1: Set "1" in bit 2 of the protection register (000A16) in advance to write to the
S I/Oi control register (i = 3, 4).
Note 2: When SI/Oi port selection bit (i= 3, 4) is set to "0" as for I/O port, set the
synchronous clock selection bit to "1".
SI/Oi bit rate generator
b7
Symbol
S3BRG
S4BRG
b0
Address
036316
036716
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Values that can be set
Assuming that set value = n, BRGi divides the count
source by n + 1
R W
0016 to FF16
SI/Oi transmission/reception register
b7
Symbol
S3TRR
S4TRR
b0
Address
036016
036416
When reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Transmission/reception starts by writing data to this register.
After transmission/reception finishes, reception data is input.
Fig.GA-29 S I/O3, 4 control registers
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 128 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
S I/O3, 4
Table.GA-9 Specifications of S I/O3, 4
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Conditions for
transmission/
reception start
Interrupt request
generation timing
Select function
Precaution
Specifications
• Transfer data length: 8 bits
• With the internal clock selected (bit 6 of 036216, 036616 = “1”): f1/2(ni+1),
f8/2(ni+1), f32/2(ni+1) (Note 1)
• With the external clock selected (bit 6 of 036216, 036616 = 0):Input from the CLKi terminal (Note 2)
• To start transmit/reception, the following requirements must be met:
- Select the synchronous clock (use bit 6 of 036216, 036616).
Select a frequency dividing ratio if the internal clock has been selected (use bits
0 and 1 of 036216, 036616).
- SOUTi initial value set bit (use bit 7 of 036216, 036616)= 1.
- S I/Oi port select bit (bit 3 of 036216, 036616) = 1.
- Select the transfer direction (use bit 5 of 036216, 036616)
- Write transfer data to SI/Oi transmission/reception register(036016, 036416)
• To use S I/Oi interrupts, the following requirements must be met:
- S I/Oi interrupt request bit (bit 3 of 004916, 004816) = 0.
• At the rising edge of the last transfer clock (Note3)
• LSB first or MSB first selection
Whether transmission/reception begins with bit 0 (LSB) or bit 7 (MSB) can be
selected.
• The SOUTi default value setting function
If the transfer clock is selected to external clock, the output level of SOUTi pin
can be selected when it is not in transferring please refer to Fig.GA-30.
• The SI/Oi (i=3,4) is different from UART0 to 2 that the register and buffer can not
be separated, so don't write the next transfer data to the transmission/reception
register(036016, 036416) during transferring.
• If the transfer clock is selected to internal clock, at the end of transferring, the
SOUTi holds the last data during the last 1/2 transfer clock, and then to high impedance.
If the transmission/reception register(036016, 036416) is written during the period,
the SOUTi becomes the high impedance right the writing ,the data hold time will be
shortened.
Note 1: n is a value from 0016 through FF16 set in the S I/Oi transfer rate register (i = 3, 4).
Note 2: With the external clock selected:
• Please write to the SI/Oi transmission/reception register(036016, 036416) under the status that the
CLKi pin is input to "H" level. Also please write to the bit 7(SOUTi default value setting bit) under
the status that the CLKi pin is input to "H" level.
• The S I/Oi circuit keeps on with the shift operation as long as the synchronous clock is entered in it,
so stop the synchronous clock at the instant when it counts to eight. The internal clock, if selected,
automatically stops.
Note 3: If the internal clock is used for the synchronous clock, the transfer clock signal stops at the “H” state.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 129 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode
S I/O3, 4
Functions for setting an SOUTi initial value
In carrying out transmission, the output level of the SOUTi pin as it is before transmitting 1-bit data can be set
either to “H” or to “L”. Fig.GA-30 shows the timing chart for setting an SOUTi initial value and how to set it.
(Example) With "H" selected for SOUTi
Signal written to the SI/Oi
transmission /reception
register
SI/Oi port selection bit SMi3 = 0
SOUTi initial value selection bit
SMi7 = 1
"H" level)
(SOUTi: Internal
SOUTi's initial value
set bit (SMi7)
SI/Oi port selection bit
(SMi3)
SI/Oi port selection bit
SMi3 = 0 1
(Port selection: Normal port SOUTi)
D0
SOUTi (internal)
SOUTi pin = "H" output
D0
Port output
SOUTi pin output
Initial value = "H"(Note)
(i = 3, 4)
Setting the SOUTi initial
value to H
Signal written to the SI/Oi register
="L" "H"
"L"
(Falling edge )
Port selection
(normal port SOUTi)
Note: The set value is output only when the external clock has been selected. Please
set the SOUTi default under the status that the CLKi is input to "H" level.
If the internal clock has been selected or if SOUTi output inhibition has been set,
this output goes to the high-impedance state.
SOUTi pin = Outputting
stored data in the SI/Oi transmission/
reception register
Fig.GA-30 Timing chart for setting SOUTi’s initial value and how to set it
S I/Oi operation timing
Fig.GA-31 shows the S I/Oi operation timing
MAX:1.5 cycle
SI/Oi internal clock
Transfer clock
(Note 1)
Signal written to the
SI/Oi register
(Note 2)
S I/Oi output SOUTi
(i= 3, 4)
Hiz
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Hiz
SI/Oi input SINi
(i= 3, 4)
SI/Oi interrupt "1"
request bit (i=3,4)
"0"
Note 1: With the internal clock selected for the transfer clock, the frequency dividing ratio can be selected using bits 0 and 1 of the
SI/Oi control register (i = 3,4). (No frequency division, 8-division frequency, 32-division frequency.)
Note 2: With the internal clock selected for the transfer clock, the SOUTi (i = 3,4) pin becomes to the high-impedance state after the
transfer finishes.
Note 3: The figure shows when the port selection bit of SOUTi (i = 3,4) is set to "1".
Fig.GA-31 S I/Oi operation timing chart
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 130 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
A-D Converter
A-D Converter
The A-D converter consists of one 10-bit successive approximation A-D converter circuit with a capacitive
coupling amplifier. Pins P100 to P107, P95, and P96 also function as the analog signal input pins. The
direction registers of these pins for A-D conversion must therefore be set to input. The Vref connect bit (bit 5
at address 03D716) can be used to isolate the resistance ladder of the A-D converter from the reference
voltage input pin (VREF) when the A-D converter is not used. Doing so stops any current flowing into the
resistance ladder from VREF, reducing the power dissipation. When using the A-D converter, start A-D conversion only after setting bit 5 of 03D716 to connect VREF.
The result of A-D conversion is stored in the A-D registers of the selected pins. When set to 10-bit precision,
the low 8 bits are stored in the even addresses and the high 2 bits in the odd addresses. When set to 8-bit
precision, the low 8 bits are stored in the even addresses.
Table.JA-1 shows the performance of the A-D converter. Fig.JA-1 shows the block diagram of the A-D
converter, and Fig.JA-2 and JA-3 show the A-D converter-related registers.
Table.JA-1 Performance of A-D converter
Item
Performance
Method of A-D conversion Successive approximation (capacitive coupling amplifier)
Analog input voltage
0V to AVCC (VCC)
Operating clockφAD (Note1) fAD/divide-by-2 of fAD/divide-by-4 of fAD, fAD=f(XIN)
Resolution
8-bit or 10-bit (selectable)
Absolute precision
• 8-bit resolution
±2LSB
• 10-bit resolution
±6LSB
Operating modes
One-shot mode, repeat mode, single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0,
and repeat sweep mode 1
Analog input pins
8pins (AN0 to AN7) + 2pins (ANEX0 and ANEX1)
A-D conversion start condition
• Software trigger
A-D conversion starts when the A-D conversion start flag changes to “1”
• External trigger (can be retriggered)
A-D conversion starts when the A-D conversion start flag is “1” and the
___________
ADTRG/P97 input changes from “H” to “L”
Conversion speed per pin
• Without sample and hold function
8-bit resolution : 49 φAD cycles
10-bit resolution : 59 φAD cycles
• With sample and hold function
8-bit resolution : 28 φAD cycles
10-bit resolution : 33 φAD cycles
Note 1: The frequency φAD should be set to 250kHz min and 8MHz max.
Without sample and hold function,set the φAD frequency to 250kHz min.
With the sample and hold fucntion, set the φAD frequency to 1MHz min.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 131 of 290
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
A-D conversion rate selection
CKS1=1
φAD
CKS0=1
fAD
1/2
1/2
CKS1=0
CKS0=0
VREF
VCUT=0
Resistor ladder
AVSS
VCUT=1
Successive conversion register
A-D control register 1 (address 03D716)
A-D control register 0 (address 03D616)
Addresses
(03C116, 03C016)
A-D register 0(16)
(03C316, 03C216)
A-D register 1(16)
A-D register 2(16)
A-D register 3(16)
(03C516, 03C416)
(03C716, 03C616)
(03C916, 03C816)
(03CB16, 03CA16)
(03CD16, 03CC16)
(03CF16, 03CE16)
Vref
Decoder
A-D register 4(16)
A-D register 5(16)
A-D register 6(16)
A-D register 7(16)
VIN
Comparator
Data bus high-order
Data bus low-order
AN0
CH2,CH1,CH0=000
AN1
CH2,CH1,CH0=001
AN2
CH2,CH1,CH0=010
AN3
CH2,CH1,CH0=011
AN4
CH2,CH1,CH0=100
AN5
CH2,CH1,CH0=101
AN6
CH2,CH1,CH0=110
AN7
CH2,CH1,CH0=111
OPA1,OPA0=0,0
OPA1, OPA0
OPA1,OPA0=0,1
ANEX0
ANEX1
OPA1,OPA0=1,0
Fig.JA-1 Block diagram of A-D converter
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 132 of 290
0
0
1
1
0 : AN0-AN7
1 : ANEX0
0 : ANEX1
1 : Inhibited
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
A-D control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
CH0
Analog input pin selection
bits
CH1
CH2
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected
0 0 : One-shot mode
0 1 : Repeat mode
1 0 : Single sweep mode
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0
Repeat sweep mode 1
TRG
Trigger selection bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
MD0
MD1
(Note 2)
b4 b3
A-D operation mode
selection bits 0
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
Function
b2 b1 b0
(Note 2)
0 : FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD/2 selected
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is
indeterminate.
Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again.
CKS0
Frequency selection bit 0
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
SCAN0
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
RW
A-D sweep pin selection bits When single sweep and repeat sweep
mode 0 are selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected
SCAN1
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0 (1 pin)
0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
MD2
A-D operation mode
selection bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep
mode 1
1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
BITS
8/10-bit mode selection bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency selection bit 1
0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
0 : Vref not connected
1 : Vref connected
b7 b6
OPA0
ANEX0,1 selection bits
OPA1
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted
1 1 : Inhibited
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is
indeterminate.
Fig.JA-2 A-D converter-related registers (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 133 of 290
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
A-D control register 2 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
ADCON2
b0
0 0 0 0
Address
03D416
Bit symbol
SMP
When reset
000100002
Bit name
A-D conversion method
select bit
Function
0 : Without sample and hold
1 : With sample and hold
Must be “0”.
Reserved bits
Nothing is assigned.
AAA
AA
A
AAA
R W
In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turn out to be “0”.
Symbol
A-D register i
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
ADi(i=0 to 7)
Address
When reset
03C016 to 03CF16 Indeterminate
b0
Function
Eight low-order bits of A-D conversion result
• During 10-bit mode
Two high-order bits of A-D conversion result
• During 8-bit mode
When read, the content is indeterminate
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if
read, turns out to be “0”.
Fig.JA-3 A-D converter-related registers (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 134 of 290
AA
AA
AA
R W
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
(1) One-shot mode
In one-shot mode, the pin selected using the analog input pin selection bits is used for one-shot A-D conversion. Table.JA-2 shows the specifications of one-shot mode. Fig.JA-4 shows the A-D control register in oneshot mode.
Table.JA-2 One-shot mode specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The pin selected by the analog input pin selection bits is used for one A-D conversion
Start condition
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Stop condition
• End of A-D conversion (A-D conversion start flag changes to “0”, except
when external trigger is selected)
• Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
Interrupt request generation timing End of A-D conversion
Input pin
One of AN0 to AN7, as selected
Reading of result of A-D converter Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin
A-D control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
ADCON0
Address
03D616
Bit symbol
Bit name
CH0
Analog input pin selection
bits
CH1
CH2
MD0
MD1
TRG
A-D operation mode
selection bits 0
Trigger selection bit
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
CKS0
Frequency selection bit 0
When reset
00000XXX2
Function
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected
(Note 2)
b4 b3
0 0 : One-shot mode
A
AA
A
AA
AA
A
RW
b2 b1 b0
(Note 2)
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0 : FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD/2 selected
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
1
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
SCAN0
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
A-D sweep pin selection Invalid in one-shot mode
bits
SCAN1
0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep
mode 1
MD2
A-D operation mode
selection bit 1
BITS
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected
Frequency selection bit 1
1 : FAD selected
CKS1
VCUT
8/10-bit mode select bit
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
b7 b6
OPA0
ANEX0,1 selection bis
OPA1
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted
1 1 : Inhibited
AA
A
AA
AA
A
A
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Fig.JA-4 A-D conversion register in one-shot mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 135 of 290
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
(2) Repeat mode
In repeat mode, the pin selected using the analog input pin selection bits is used for repeated A-D conversion. Table.JA-3 shows the specifications of repeat mode. Fig.JA-5 shows the A-D control register in repeat
mode.
Table.JA-3 Repeat mode specifications
Item
Specification
The pin selected by the analog input pin selection bits is used for repeated A-D conversion
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
Not generated
One of AN0 to AN7, as selected
Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin
Function
Star condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
A-D control register 0 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Function
CH0
CH1
CH2
MD0
(Note 2)
b4 b3
MD1
A-D operation mode
selection bits 0
TRG
Trigger selection bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
CKS0
Frequency selection bit 0
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0 : FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD/2 selected
0 1 : Repeat mode
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AAA
RW
b2 b1 b0
Analog input pin selection
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
bits
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected
(Note 2)
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again.
A-D control register 1 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
1
b4
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit symbol
Bit name
SCAN0
A-D sweep pin selection
bits
Invalid in repeat mode
Function
MD2
A-D operation mode
selection bit 1
Should be “0” in this mode
BITS
8/10-bit mode selection
bit
SCAN1
CKS1
VCUT
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected
Frequency selection bit 1
1 : FAD selected
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
b7 b6
OPA0
ANEX0,1 selection bis
OPA1
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted
1 1 : Inhibited
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion
result is indeterminate.
Fig.JA-5 A-D conversion register in repeat mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 136 of 290
RW
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
(3) Single sweep mode
In single sweep mode, the pins selected using the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for one-by-one AD conversion. Table.JA-4 shows the specifications of single sweep mode. Fig.JA-6 shows the A-D control
register in single sweep mode.
Table.JA-4 Single sweep mode specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The pins selected by the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for one-by-one A-D conversion
Start condition
Writing “1” to A-D converter start flag
Stop condition
• End of A-D conversion (A-D conversion start flag changes to “0”, except
when external trigger is selected)
• Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
Interrupt request generation timing End of A-D conversion
Input pin
AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins), or AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
Reading of result of A-D converter Read A-D registers corresponding to selected pins
A-D control register 0 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Function
Analog input pin selection bits
Invalid in single sweep mode
CH1
CH2
MD0
A-D operation mode selection
bits 0
b4 b3
1 0 : Single sweep mode
MD1
TRG
Trigger selection bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
CKS0
Frequency selection bit 0
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
0 : FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD/2 selected
A
A
AA
A
AA
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
A-D control register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
1
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
SCAN0
Address
03D716
Bit name
A-D sweep pin select bit
BITS
CKS1
VCUT
Function
When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0
are
selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
SCAN1
MD2
When reset
0016
A-D operation mode
select bit 1
8/10-bit mode select bit
Should be "0" in this mode
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
ANEX0,1 selection bis
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted
1 1 : Inhibited
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected
Frequency selection bit 1
1 : FAD selected
b7 b6
OPA0
OPA1
AA
A
AA
A
AA
R W
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
Fig.JA-6 A-D conversion register in single sweep mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 137 of 290
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
(4) Repeat sweep mode 0
In repeat sweep mode 0, the pins selected using the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for repeat sweep
A-D conversion. Table.JA-5 shows the specifications of repeat sweep mode 0. Fig.JA-7 shows the A-D
control register in repeat sweep mode 0.
Table.JA-5 Repeat sweep mode 0 specifications
Item
Function
Start condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
Specification
The pins selected by the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for repeat sweep A-D conversion
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
Not generated
AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins), or AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
Read A-D registers corresponding to selected pins (at any time)
A-D control register 0 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Function
Analog input pin selection bits Invalid in repeat sweep mode 0
CH1
CH2
MD0
b4 b3
A-D operation mode selection 1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0
bits 0
MD1
TRG
Trigger selection bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
CKS0
Frequency selection bit 0
0 : FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD/2 selected
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AAA
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
A-D control register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
1
b3
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
SCAN0
Address
03D716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
SCAN1
MD2
A-D operation mode
selection bits 1
Should be "0" in this mode
BITS
8/10-bit mode selection bit
CKS1
Frequency selection bit 1
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
b7 b6
OPA0
ANEX0,1 selection bis
OPA1
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
AA
A
AAA
R W
A-D sweep pin selection bits When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0
are selected
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted
1 1 : Inhibited
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
Fig.JA-7 A-D conversion register in repeat sweep mode 0
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 138 of 290
A-D Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
(5) Repeat sweep mode 1
In repeat sweep mode 1, all pins are used for A-D conversion with emphasis on the pin or pins selected using
the A-D sweep pin selection bits. Table.JA-6 shows the specifications of repeat sweep mode 1. Fig.JA-8
shows the A-D control register in repeat sweep mode 1.
Table.JA-6 Repeat sweep mode 1 specifications
Item
Function
Start condition
Stop condition
Interrupt request generation timing
Input pin
Reading of result of A-D converter
Specification
All pins perform repeat sweep A-D conversion, with emphasis on the pin or
pins selected by the A-D sweep pin selection bits
Example : AN0 selected AN0
AN1
AN0
AN2
AN0
AN3, etc
Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag
Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag
Not generated
AN0 (1 pin), AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN2 (3 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
Read A-D registers corresponding to selected pins (at any time)
A-D control register 0 (Note)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit symbol
CH0
Address
03D616
When reset
00000XXX2
Bit name
Function
Analog input pin selection bits Invalid in repeat sweep mode 1
CH1
CH2
MD0
b4 b3
A-D operation mode selection 1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
bits 0
MD1
TRG
Trigger select bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
ADST
A-D conversion start flag
0 : A-D conversion disabled
1 : A-D conversion started
CKS0
Frequency selection bit 0
0 : FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD/2 selected
AAAA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AAA
AAA
RW
Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
A-D control register 1 (Note 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
1
b3
b2
1
b1
b0
Symbol
ADCON1
Bit symbol
SCAN0
Address
03D716
Bit name
A-D sweep pin selection bits
BITS
Function
When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected
b1 b0
0 0 : AN0 (1 pin)
0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
SCAN1
MD2
When reset
0016
A-D operation mode selection 1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
bit 1
0 : 8-bit mode
8/10-bit mode selection bit
1 : 10-bit mode
CKS1
Frequency selection bit 1
0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected
1 : FAD selected
VCUT
Vref connect bit
1 : Vref connected
b7 b6
OPA0
ANEX0,1 selection bis
OPA1
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted
1 1 : Inhibited
AAAA
AA
AA
AA
AAAA
AA
AA
R W
Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result
is indeterminate.
Fig.JA-8 A-D conversion register in repeat sweep mode 1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 139 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
A-D Converter
(a) Extended analog input pins
In one-shot mode and repeat mode, the input via the extended analog input pins ANEX0 and ANEX1 can
also be converted from analog to digital.
When bit 6 of the A-D control register 1 (address 03D716) is “1” and bit 7 is “0”, input via ANEX0 is converted
from analog to digital. The result of conversion is stored in A-D register 0.
When bit 6 of the A-D control register 1 (address 03D716) is “0” and bit 7 is “1”, input via ANEX1 is converted
from analog to digital. The result of conversion is stored in A-D register 1.
(b) Sample and hold
Sample and hold is selected by setting bit 0 of the A-D control register 2 (address 03D416) to “1”. When
sample and hold is selected, the rage of conversion of each pin increases. As a result, a 28 φAD cycle is
achieved with 8-bit resolution and 33φAD cycle with 10-bit resolution. Sample and hold can be selected in all
modes. However, in all modes, be sure to specify before starting A-D conversion whether sample and hold is
to be used.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 140 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
D-A Converter
D-A Converter
This is an 8-bit, R-2R type D-A converter. The microcomputer contains two independent D-A converters of
this type.
DA conversion is performed when a value is written to the corresponding D-A register. Bits 0 and 1 (D-A
output enable bits) of the D-A control register decide if the result of conversion is to be output. Do not set the
corresponding port to output mode if D-A conversion is to be performed. If D-A output is enabled, the pull-up
of corresponding port is inhibited.
Output analog voltage (V) is determined by a set value n (n : decimal) in the D-A register.
V = VREF X n/ 256 (n = 0 to 255)
VREF : reference voltage
Table.JB-1lists the performance of the D-A converter. Fig.JB-1 shows the block diagram of the D-A converter. Fig.JB-2 shows the D-A control register. Fig.JB-3 shows the D-A converter equivalent circuit.
Table.JB-1 Performance of D-A converter
Item
Conversion type
Resolution
Analog output pins
Performance
R-2R type
8 bits
2 channels
Data bus low-order bits
D-A register0 (8)
(Address 03D816)
AAA
D-A0 output enable bit
R-2R resistor ladder
D-A register1 (8)
P93/DA0
(Address 03DA16)
AAA
D-A1 output enable bit
R-2R resistor ladder
Fig.JB-1 Block diagram of D-A converter
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 141 of 290
P94/DA1
D-A Converter
M16C/6K9 Group
D-A control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DACON
Address
03DC16
Bit symbol
DA0E
DA1E
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
D-A0 output enable bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
D-A1 output enable bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
AA
A
AA
A
RW
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”
D-A register
b7
b0
Symbol
DAi (i = 0,1)
Address
03D816, 03DA16
When reset
Indeterminate
AA
A
Function
RW
R
W
Output value of D-A conversion
Fig.JB-2 D-A control register
D-A0 output enable bit
"0"
R
R
R
R
2R
2R
2R
2R
R
R
R
2R
DA0
"1"
2R
MSB
2R
2R
2R
LSB
D-A0 register0
AVSS
VREF
Note 1: The above diagram shows an instance in which the D-A register is assigned 2A16.
Note 2: The same circuit as this is also used for D-A1.
Note 3: To reduce the current consumption when the D-A converter is not used, set the D-A output enable bit to 0 and set the D-A register to 0016
Do not let current flows through R-2R resistors.
Fig.JB-3 D-A converter equivalent circuit
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 142 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Comparator
Comparator Circuit
Comparator Configuration
A comparator circuit consists of a switch tree, ladder resistance, comparators, comparator control circuit, the
comparator control register (address 03DE16), comparator data register (address 03DF16), and analog signal
input pins(P50 - P57). The analog input pins (P50 - P57) are shared with the usual digital port I/O pins.
The comparator control register is a 4-bit register and can generate internal analog voltages in steps of 1/16
Vcc with the contens of bits 0 to 3. In Table.JC-2 contents of bits 0 to 3 of the comparator control register
and corresponding internal analog voltage generated are indicated. The compared result of the analog
input voltage and internal analog voltage is stored in the comparator data register. The value of comparator
control register can not be read out.
Comparator Operation
In order to perform comparator operation, first, set the port P5 direction register (address 03EB16) to "0", as
P5 can be used as the analog input pins. Then write a digital value, which corresponds to the internal
analog voltage to be compared, to bits 0 to 3 of the comparator control register (address 03DE16) . The
voltage comparison starts immediately by the writing operation. After 28 cycles of main clock without division
(the cycles needed for comparison, no relation to the frequency), the compared result of the comparator is stored
in the comparator data register (address 03DF16). Each bit of this register becomes as follows depending on the
status of corresponding P50 to P57 pins:
When analog input voltage > internal analog voltage, it is "1".
When analog input voltage < internal analog voltage, it is "0".
For comparing once more, it is necessary to write data into comparator control register again even if the
internal analog voltage is the same.
To read the result, wait 28 cycles of main clock without division (the cycles needed for comparison, no
relation to the frequency) or more after the comparator operation starts.
During the 28 cycles of the comparison, the ladder resistance is turned on and the reference voltage is
generated. When the comparator is not in operation, the ladder resistance is off. Therefore, unnecessary
consumption is prevented.
The comparison is accomplished by capacitive coupling. If the clock frequency is too low, electric charge
will be lost. While the comparator is in operation, the clock frequency must be 1MHz or higher. During this
time, do not execute a STP instruction, a WIT instruction, or an I/O instruction for port P5.
Data bus
P5 (8)
4
8
8
Comparator data
register(03DF16)
Comparator control
register(03DE16)
b0
b3
b0
P57
Compa
rator
R-ladder
P56
Compa
rator
P50
Compa
rator
Comparator
Comparator connection Control Cricuit
signal
Fig.JC-1 Comparator circuit
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 143 of 290
Switch Tree
R-ladder connection
signal
VSS
Comparator
M16C/6K9 Group
Table.JC-1 Correspondence of internal analog voltage and contents of bits 0 to 3 of the comparator
control register.
Comparator Control Register
Contents of bit 0 to 3
0000
LSB
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
Internal Analog Voltage
1 / 32•Vcc
1 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
2 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
3 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
4 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
5 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
6 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
7 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
8 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
9 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
10 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
11 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
12 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
13 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
14 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
15 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc
AAA
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
Comparator Control register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CMPCON
Bit Symbol
CREFS
Address
03DE16
Bit name
Internal analog voltage
setting bits
Reserved bit
Can't be written. "0" will be read out.
Fig.JC-2 Comparator control register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 144 of 290
When Reset
0016
Function
n/16•VCC+1/32•VCC
n=setting vaule
R W
PWM
M16C/6K9 Group
PWM Output Circuit (PWM : Pulse Width Modulation)
There are 6 PWM output circuits, PWM0 to PWM5, with 8-bit resolution and operating independently. The
input clock f(PC) for PWM is based on XIN, 2 division of XIN or 4 division of XIN.
Data bus
PWM0 prescaler pre-latch
PWM0 register pre-latch
Transmission control circuit
PWM0 prescaler latch
"00"
f(XIN)
PWM0 register latch
Count source
selection bits
P44 latch
P44/PWM01
1/2
1/4
"01"
f(PC)
PWM0 prescaler
PWM0 register
PWM0
"10"
PWM0 output pin selection bit
PWM0 output enable bit
P44 direction register
P93 latch
P93/DA1/PWM00
PWM0 output pin selection bit
PWM0 output enable bit
Note: Refer to page 24 for the addresses of PWM prescaler and PWM register.
Fig.LA-1 PWM circuit (PWM0)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 145 of 290
P93 direction register
M16C/6K9 Group
PWM
Data Setup (PWM0)
PWM0 output pin shares with P93 or P44. PWM0 output pin is selected from either P93/PWM00 or P44/
PWM01 by bit 0 of PWM control register 0 (address 030C16). PWM0 output is enabled and starts to operate
by setting bit 0 of PWM control register 1 (address 030D16) to “1” .
The period of PWM is set by PWM0 prescaler (address 030016), The “H” width of output pulse is set by
PWM0 register (address 030116).
The following are the calculations if the prescaler value is n and PWM0 register value is m.
(n = 0 to 255, m = 0 to 255)
PWM period = 255 ✕ (n+1) = 31.875 ✕ (n+1) µs
f(XIN)
(In the case of f(XIN)=8MHz, PWM counter source selection bits=“002”)
"H" width of output pulse = PWM period ✕ m = 0.125 ✕ (n+1) ✕ mµs
255
(In the case of f(XIN)=8MHz, PWM counter source selection bits=“002”)
The setting of PWM1 to PWM5 are the same.
PWM Operation
By setting bit 0 ( PWM0 output enable bit) of PWM control register 1 to “1”, the PWM output circuit starts to
operate from default state with “H” pulse output.
If the values of PWM0 register and PWM0 prescaler are modified during the PWM output operation, the
corresponding pulse will be output from the next period after the modification.
31.875 ✕ m ✕ (n+1)
µs
255
<
>
PWM0 output
< T = [31.875 ✕ (n+1)] µs
>
m : The content of PWM0 register
n : The content of PWM0 prescaler
T : PWM Period ( in the case of f(XIN) = 8MHz)
Fig.LA-2 The timing of PWM period (PWM0)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 146 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
PWM
A
B
C
B
C
=
T
T2
PWM0 output
T
The write signal to
PWM0 register
The write signal to
PWM0 prescaler
T
T2
( The modification of “H” width from “A” to “B”)
( The modification of PWM period from “T” to “T2”)
In the case that values of PWM0 register and PWM0 prescaler are modified,
the PWM0 output will be changed from the next period after the modification.
Fig.LA-3 The PWM output timing in the case of modification of PWM register and PWM prescaler
(PWM0)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 147 of 290
PWM
M16C/6K9 Group
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
PWM control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PWMCON0
Bit symbol
Address
030C16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PWMSEL0
PWM0 output pin selection bit
0 : P93/PWM00
1 : P44/PWM01
PWMSEL1
PWM1 output pin selection bit
0 : P94/PWM10
1 : P45/PWM11
PWMSEL2
PWM2 output pin selection bit
0 : P95/PWM20
1 : P46/PWM21
PWMSEL3
PWM3 output pin selection bit
0 : P96/PWM30
1 : P47/PWM31
PWMSEL4
PWM4 output pin selection bit
0 : P160/PWM40
1 : P40/PWM41
PWMSEL5 PWM5 output pin selection bit
0 : P161/PWM50
1 : P41/PWM51
R W
b7 b6
PWMCLK0 PWM count source selection bits 0 0 : f(XIN)
0 1 : f(XIN)/2
1 0 : f(XIN)/4
PWMCLK1
1 1 : Inhibit
AAA
AA
A
AAA
AA
A
PWM control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PWMCON1
Bit symbol
Address
030D16
Bit name
PWMEN0
PWM0 output enable bit
PWMEN1
PWM1 output enable bit
0 : Inhibit
1 : Enable
PWMEN2
PWM2 output enable bit
0 : Inhibit
1 : Enable
PWMEN3
PWM3 output enable bit
0 : Inhibit
1 : Enable
PWMEN4
PWM4 output enable bit
0 : Inhibit
1 : Enable
PWMEN5
PWM5 output enable bit
0 : Inhibit
1 : Enable
Fig.LA-4 PWM control registers (1)
Jun 06, 2003
Function
0 : Inhibit
1 : Enable
Nothing is assigned.
Can not be written. The value is “0” in reading.
Rev.1.00
When reset
0016
page 148 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
LPC Bus Interface
LPC bus interface is based on Intel Low Pin Count (LPC) Interface Specification, Revision 1.0. It is I/O cycle
data transfer format of serial communication. 4 channels are built in. The function of data bus buffer and data
bus buffer status are almost the same as that of MELPS8-41 series. It can be written in or read out (as slave
mode) by the control signals from host CPU side. The LPC bus interface functionality block diagram is shown
in Figure GF-2. LPC data bus buffer functional Input / Output ports (P30-P36 ) are shared with GPIO port.
The setting of bit3 (LPC bus buffer enable bit) of LPC control register ( address 02D616 ) is as below:
0: General purpose Input / Output port
1: LPC bus buffer functional Input / Output port
The enabling of channel of LPC bus buffer is controlled by bits 4-7 (LPC bus buffer 0-3 enable bits) of LPC
control register (address 02D616 ). The slave address (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 0 is fixed on 0060h,
0064h. The slave addresses (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 1-3 are definable by setting LPC 1-3 address register H, L (address 02D016 to 02D516 ). The setting value of bit2 of LPC1-3 address register (A2) L
will not be decoded. The bit is “0” when read from slave CPU. The A2 status of slave address is latched to
XA2 flag when written by host CPU. The input buffer full interrupt is generated when written in the data by
host CPU. The Output buffer empty interrupt is generated when read out the data by host CPU. As shown in
GF-1, the input buffer full interrupt request and output buffer empty interrupt request are switched by bit6, 7
of data bus buffer control register0.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 149 of 290
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
Input buffer full flag0
IBF0
Input buffer full flag1
IBF1
Input buffer full flag2
IBF2
Input buffer full flag3
IBF3
Rising edge
detection circuit
Rising edge
detection circuit
Rising edge
detection circuit
Rising edge
detection circuit
One shot pulse
generator
One shot pulse
generator
One shot pulse
generator
One shot pulse
generator
Input Buffer Full0 interrupt request signal
(IBF0 interrupt request)
b7,b6
0 0
1 0
1 1
IBF1INT
b7,b6
0 1
b7,b6
0 0
0 1
1 1
IBF2INT
b7,b6
1 0
b7,b6
0 0
0 1
1 0
IBF3INT
b7,b6
1 1
DBBCON0
bit 7,6
Output buffer full flag0 OBF0
OBE0
Rising edge
detection circuit
One shot pulse
generator
OBE1
Rising edge
detection circuit
One shot pulse
generator
OBE2
Rising edge
detection circuit
One shot pulse
generator
OBE3
Rising edge
detection circuit
One shot pulse
generator
OBE
Output buffer full flag1 OBF1
Output buffer full flag2 OBF2
Output buffer full flag3 OBF3
IBF0
IBF0 interrupt request
IBF1
IBF1INT
IBF2
IBF2INT
IBF3
IBF3INT
OBF0(OBE0)
OBF1(OBE1)
OBF2(OBE2)
OBF3(OBE3)
OBE
(Example) Data bus buffer control register 0 bit 7=1, bit 6=1
IBF1/OBE interrupt request
IBF2/OBE interrupt request
IBF3/OBE interrupt request
Fig.GF-1 Interrupt, request, circuit of Data Bus Buffer
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 150 of 290
Input Buffer Full1/output buffer empty interrupt
request signal (IBF1/OBE interrupt request)
Input Buffer Full2/output buffer empty interrupt
request signal (IBF2/OBE interrupt request)
Input Buffer Full3/output buffer empty interrupt
request signal (IBF3/OBE interrupt request)
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
P33/LAD3
Address register LL (Note1)
Address register LH (Note1)
Address register HL (Note1)
Address register HH (Note1)
RD/WR register
Start register
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
Internal Data Bus
Input Data Buffer [7:4] Input Data Buffer [3:0]
Output Data Buffer [7:4]Output Data Buffer [3:0]
Data bus buffer status register
U7
U6
U5
U4
XA2
U2
IBF
OBF
Output Control Circuit
TAR register
P32/LAD2
Input Control Circuit
SYNC register
P31/LAD1
System Bus
P30/LAD0
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
AA
Input Data Comparator
P34/LFRAME
P35/LRESET
P36/LCLK
Interrupt signal
IBF, OBE
Interrupt generate
Circuit
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
LPC control register (address 02D616)
0
0
Note1 : LPC bus interface channel 0 is fixed on slave address “0060h”, “0064h”.
Fig.GF-2 LPC bus interface function block diagram (LPC1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 151 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
Figure GF-3 Shows Data bus buffer control registers
Figure GF-4 Shows Data bus buffer status register
Figure GF-5, 6 Shows LPC related registers
Data bus buffer status register (DBBSTS0-DBBSTS3)
This is 8-bit register.
The bit 0, 1, 3 are read only bits and indicate the status of data bus buffer.
Bit 2, 4, 5, 6, 7 are user definable and flags which can be read and written by software. The data bus buffer
status register can be read out by host CPU when the slave address (16 bit) bit2 (A2) is high.
• Output buffer full flag (OBF)
The bit will be set to “1” when a data is written into output data bus buffer and will be cleared to “0” when host
CPU read out the data from output data bus buffer.
• Input buffer full flag (IBF)
The bit will be set to “1” while a data is written into input data bus buffer by host CPU and will be cleared to
“0”when the data is read out from input data bus buffer by slave CPU.
• XA2 flag (XA2)
The bit 2 of slave address (16 bits) is latched while a data is written into data bus buffer.
Input data bus buffer register (DBBIN0-DBBIN3)
When there is a write request from host CPU, the data on the data bus will be latched to DBBIN0-3. The data
of DBBIN0-3 can be read out from data bus buffer registers (Address:02C016, 02C216 , 02C416 , 02C616 ) in
SFR field.
Output data bus buffer register (DBBOUT0-DBBOUT3)
When writing data to data bus buffer registers (Address: 02C016 , 02C216 , 02C416 , 02C616 ), the data will
be transferred to DBBOUT0-3 automatically. The data of DBBOUT0-3 will be output to the data bus when
there is a read request from host CPU and the status of bit2 (A2) of slave address (16 bits) is low.
LPCi address register H/L (LPC1ADH-LPC3ADH / LPC1ADL-LPC3ADL)
The slave address (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 0 is fixed on 0060h, 0064h.
The slave addresses (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 1-3 are definable by setting LPC1-3 address registers H/L (02D016 to 02D516 ). The settings are for slave address upper 8 bits and lower 8 bits. And these
registers can be set and cleared in any time.
The bit 2 of LPC 1-3 address L is not decoded regardless of the setting value. When slave CPU reads LPC13 address registers, the bit2 (A2) of address low byte will be fixed to “0”. The bit2 (A2) status of slave address
is latched to XA2 flag when written by host CPU. The slave addresses that are already set in these registers
will be used for comparing with the addresses to be received.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 152 of 290
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
Data bus buffer control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DBBCON0
Address
02C816
Bit symbol
When reset
000000002
Bit name
Nothing is assigned.
Cannot be written. The value is "0" in reading.
IBFSEL
R W
Function
IBF/OBE
interrupt request select bit
b7 b6
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
A
A
AA
(Note 1)
: OBE disable
: OBE enable, IBF1 disable
: OBE enable, IBF2 disable
: OBE enable, IBF3 disable
Note 1: By setting these two bits, one of IBF1 to IBF3 interrupt requests will be switched
to OBE interrupt request.
There is no relative between IBF0 interrupt request and these two bits.
Interrupt
b7, b6
0,0
0,1
1,0
1,1
IBF0 interrupt
IBF0
IBF0
IBF0
IBF0
IBF1 interrupt
IBF1
OBE
IBF1
IBF1
IBF2 interrupt
IBF2
IBF2
OBE
IBF2
IBF3 interrupt
IBF3
IBF3
IBF3
OBE
Data bus buffer control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DBBCON1
Bit symbol
Address
02C916
Bit name
OBF0SEL
OBF0 output selection bit
OBF00EN
OBF00 output enable bit
0 : P40 as GPIO
1 : P40 as OBF00 output
OBF01EN
OBF01 output enable bit
0 : P43 as GPIO
1 : P43 as OBF01 output
OBF1EN
OBF1 output enable bit
0 : P44 as GPIO
1 : P44 as OBF1 output
OBF2EN
OBF2 output enable bit
0 : P45 as GPIO
1 : P45 as OBF2 output
OBF3EN
OBF3 output enable bit
0 : P46 as GPIO
1 : P46 as OBF3 output
Fig.GF-3 Data bus buffer control registers
Jun 06, 2003
Function
0 : OBF00 enable
1 : OBF01 enable
Nothing is assigned.
Cannot be written. The value is "0" in reading.
Rev.1.00
When reset
000000002
page 153 of 290
R W
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
Data bus buffer status register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DBBSTS0
DBBSTS1
DBBSTS2
DBBSTS3
Bit name
Bit symbol
Function
Output buffer full flag
0 : Buffer empty
1 : Buffer full
IBF
Input buffer full flag
0 : Buffer empty
1 : Buffer full
U2
User definable flag
This flag can be freely defined
by user
XA2
XA2 flag
This flag is indication the A2
status of the 16 bit slave address
when IBF flag is set
U4
User definable flag
This flag can be freely defined
by user
U6
U7
Fig.GF-4 Data bus buffer status register
Jun 06, 2003
When reset
000000002
000000002
000000002
000000002
OBF
U5
Rev.1.00
Address
02C116
02C316
02C516
02C716
page 154 of 290
R W
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
LPCi address register L (i=1,2,3)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
(Note2)
Symbol
LPC1ADL
LPC2ADL
LPC3ADL
b0
Bit symbol
Address
02D016
02D216
02D416
When reset
000000002
000000002
000000002
Bit name
LPCSAD0
Slave address0
LPCSAD1
Slave address1
LPCSAD2
Slave address2 (Note1)
LPCSAD3
Slave address3
LPCSAD4
Slave address4
LPCSAD5
Slave address5
LPCSAD6
Slave address6
LPCSAD7
Slave address7
R W
Note1: Always returns “0” when read, even if writing “1” to this bit.
Note2: Do not set the same 16 bits slave address in each channel.
LPCi address register H (i=1,2,3)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
LPC1ADH
LPC2ADH
LPC3ADH
b0
Bit symbol
Fig.GF-5 LPC related registers
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 155 of 290
Address
02D116
02D316
02D516
Bit name
LPCSAD8
Slave address8
LPCSAD9
Slave address9
LPCSAD10
Slave address10
LPCSAD11
Slave address11
LPCSAD12
Slave address12
LPCSAD13
Slave address13
LPCSAD14
Slave address14
LPCSAD15
Slave address15
When reset
000000002
000000002
000000002
R W
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC control register (LPCCON)
• LPC bus interface enable bit (LPCBEN)
“0”: P30 -P36 use as GPIO
“1”: P30 -P36 use as LPC bus interface
• LPC bus buffer 0 enable bit (LPCEN0)
“0”: LPC bus buffer0 disable
“1”: LPC bus buffer0 enable
• LPC bus buffer 1 enable bit (LPCEN1)
“0”: LPC bus buffer1 disable
“1”: LPC bus buffer1 enable
• LPC bus buffer 2 enable bit (LPCEN2)
“0”: LPC bus buffer2 disable
“1”: LPC bus buffer2 enable
• LPC bus buffer 3 enable bit (LPCEN3)
“0”: LPC bus buffer3 disable
“1”: LPC bus buffer3 enable
• LPC software reset bit (LPCSR)
______________
By setting the bit to “1”, LPC interface is reset by the same status as LRESET=“L”. After 1.5 cycles of
BCLK at writing “1”, reset is released and the bit becomes “0”.
Nothing happens if “0” is set.
• SYNC output selection bits (SYNCSEL0,SYNCSEL1)
The content of SYNC output can be selected by bit 0,1 (SYNC output selection bits) of LPC control register.
Fig.GF-6 shows the configuration of LPC control register, Table.GF-1 shows the content of SYNC output
selected by SYNC output selection bits.
Table GF-1 SYNC output
SYNCSEL1
SYNCSEL0
SYNC cycle
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
4
1
4
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 156 of 290
1st cycle
00002
01102
10102
01102
SYNC output
2nd cycle
3rd cycle
4th cycle
01102
01102
00002
01102
01102
10102
M16C/6K9 Group
AA
AA
A
AA
AAAAAA
A
LPC Bus Interface
LPC control register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
LPCCON
Bit symbol
Address
02D616
When reset
000000002
Bit name
Function
b1 b0
SYNCSEL0
SYNC output selection bits
0 0: OK
0 1: Long & OK
1 0: Err
1 1: Long & Err
LPCSR
LPC software reset bit
0 : The release of reset (Note)
1 : Reset
LPCBEN
LPC interface enable bit
0 : P30 - P36 as GPIO
1 : LPC bus buffer enable
LPCEN0
LPC bus buffer 0 enable bit
0 : LPC bus buffer 0 disable
1 : LPC bus buffer 0 enable
LPCEN1
LPC bus buffer 1 enable bit
0 : LPC bus buffer 1 disable
1 : LPC bus buffer 1 enable
LPCEN2
LPC bus buffer 2 enable bit
0 : LPC bus buffer 2 disable
1 : LPC bus buffer 2 enable
LPCEN3
LPC bus buffer 3 enable bit
0 : LPC bus buffer 3 disable
1 : LPC bus buffer 3 enable
SYNCSEL1
Note: For LPC software reset, the bit will automatically return to “0” after writing “1”.
Fig.GF-6 LPC control register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 157 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
Basic operation of LPC bus interface
The status transition of LPC bus interface is shown in Figure GF-7.
Setting steps for using LPC bus interface is explained below.
• Setting bit3 (LPC interface enable bit) of LPC control register ( address 02D616 ) to "1"
• Choosing which LPC bus buffer channel will be used
• Setting "1" to bits 4-7 (LPC bus buffer 0-3 enable bit) of LPC control register ( address 02D616 ).
• The 16-bit slave address of LPC bus buffer channel is defined by writing 16-bit slave address to LPC 1-3
address registers ( address 02D016 to 02D516 ). If channel 1-3 LPC bus buffer is chosen, set the address to
the corresponding address register.
• Selecting IBF/ OBE interrupt in data bus buffer control register0 ( address 02C816 )
• Selecting OBF output port in data bus buffer control register1 ( address 02C916 )
<1> Example of I/O writing cycle from HOST
Writing timing is shown in Figure GF-8.
The basic communication cycles of LPC I/O protocol are 13 cycles. The data of LAD[3:0] will be read by the
_______________
rising edge of LCLK. Communication will start from LFRAME falling edge.
______________
• 1st cycle : When LFRAME is "Low", sending "00002 " to LAD[3:0] for communication start frame detecting.
_______________
• 2nd cycle : When LFRAME is "High", sending "001X2 " to LAD[3:0] for write frame detecting.
• From 3rd cycle to 6th cycle: These four cycles are detecting for 16 bits slave address.
3rd cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [15:12] through LAD[3:0]
4th cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [11:8] through LAD[3:0]
5th cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [7:4] through LAD[3:0]
6th cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [3:0] through LAD[3:0]
• 7th and 8th cycles are used for one data byte transfer.
7th cycle: The data which is from host is written to input data buffer[3:0] through LAD[3:0]
8th cycle: The data which is from host is written to input data buffer[7:4] through LAD[3:0]
• 9th and 10thcycles are for changing the communication direction from host→slave to slave→host
9th cycle: Host outputs "11112 " to LAD[3:0]
10thcycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by HOST to switch the communication direction.
• 11th cycle: The "00002 " (SYNC OK) is output to LAD[3:0] for acknowledge.
• 12th cycle: The "11112 " is output to LAD[3:0]. The XA2 and IBF flag are set. IBF interrupt signal is generated.
• 13th cycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by slave to switch the communication direction.
During the host write period, the bit2 (A2) status of 16 bits slave address will be latched to XA2 flag. When 8
bits data from input data buffer are read out by slave CPU, the IBF flag will be cleared simultaneously.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 158 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
<2> Example for I/O reading cycle from HOST
Reading timing is shown in Figure GF-9.
The basic communication cycles of LPC I/O protocol are 13 cycles. The data of LAD[3:0] will be read by the
_______________
rising edge of LCLK. Communication will start from LFRAME falling edge.
_______________
• 1st cycle: When LFRAME is "Low", sending "00002 " to LAD[3:0] for communication start detecting.
_______________
• 2ndcycle: When LFRAME is "High", the host send "000X2 " on LAD[3:0] to inform the cycle type as I/O read.
• From 3rd cycle to 6thcycle: These four cycles are detecting for 16 bits slave address.
3rdcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [15:12] throughLAD[3:0]
4thcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [11:8] throughLAD[3:0]
5thcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [7:4] throughLAD[3:0]
6thcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [3:0] throughLAD[3:0]
• 7th and 8thcycles are used for changing the communication direction from host→slave to slave→host
7thcycle: Host is output "11112 " to LAD[3:0]
8thcycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by HOST to switch the communication direction.
• 9thcycle : The "00002 " (SYNC OK) is output to LAD[3:0] for acknowledge.
• 10th and 11thcycles are for output 8 bits data from output data buffer or output 8 bits data from status register.
10thcycle: Sending output data buffer [3:0] to LAD[3:0] or sending data of status register [3:0] to LAD[3:0]
11thcycle: Sending output data buffer [7:4] to LAD[3:0] or sending data of status register [7:4] to LAD[3:0].
• 12thcycle: The "11112 " is output to LAD[3:0]. The OBF flag is cleared and OBE interrupt signal is generated.
• 13thcycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by slave to switch the communication direction. OBF flag will be
set when 8 bits data are written to output data buffer by slave CPU.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 159 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
Data WR (I/O write cycle)
START
WR
16 BIT ADDRESS
DATA
TAR
SYNC
TAR
LCLK
LFRAME
(Note1)
LAD [3:0]
Input buffer
XA2 flag
IBF flag
Driven by the HOST
Driven by the SLAVE
Command WR (I/O write cycle)
START
WR
16 BIT ADDRESS
DATA
TAR
SYNC
TAR
LCLK
LFRAME
(Note1)
LAD [3:0]
Input buffer
XA2 flag
IBF flag
Driven by the HOST
Driven by the SLAVE
Note1 : LAD0 to LAD3 pins remain Hi-Z after transfer completion
Fig.GF-7 Data and Command write timing figure
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 160 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
Data RD (I/O read cycle)
START
RD
16 BIT ADDRESS
TAR
SYNC
DATA
TAR
LCLK
LFRAME
(Note1)
LAD [3:0]
OBF flag
Driven by the HOST
Driven by the SLAVE
Status RD (I/O read cycle)
START
RD
16 BIT ADDRESS
TAR
SYNC
DATA
TAR
LCLK
LFRAME
(Note1)
LAD [3:0]
(Note2)
OBF flag
Driven by the HOST
Driven by the SLAVE
Note1 : LAD0 to LAD3 pins become Hi-Z after transfer completion.
Note2 : OBF flag does not change.
Fig.GF-8 Data and Status read timing figure
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 161 of 290
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 162 of 290
1
1
OBF1
OBF2
OBF3
P45/OBF2
P46/OBF3
1
P44/OBF1
0
1
OBF01
P43/OBF01
O
O
O
O
O
OBF00
P40/OBF00
1
I
1
LCLK
P36/LCLK
0
I
1
LRESET
I
I/O
I/O
1
02C916
Bit 6
I/O
1
02C916
Bit 5
1
0
02C916
Bit 4
Input/
Output
P35/LRESET
LAD3
P33/LAD3
02C916
Bit 3
HOSTEN
control bit
1
LAD2
P32/LAD2
02C916
Bit 2
OBF3
output
enable bit
I/O
02C916
Bit 1
OBF1
OBF2
output
output
enable bit enable bit
1
1
02C916
Bit 0
02D616
Bit 3
OBF00
OBF01
output
output
enable bit enable bit
P34/LFRAME LFRAME
LAD1
LAD0
Name
P31/LAD1
P30/LAD0
Pin name
OBF0
output
enable bit
LPC
interface
enable bit
Table GF-2 Function explanation of the control input and output pins in LPC bus interface function
Status output signal.
OBF3 output.
Status output signal.
OBF2 output.
Status output signal.
OBF1 output.
Status output signal.
OBF01 output.
Status output signal.
OBF00 output.
LPC synchronous clock signal.
LPC reset signal.
LPC bus interface function is reset.
It is used for indicating the start of LPC cycle and
termination of abnormal communication cycle.
LPC bus used for transmitting and receiving address,
command and data between Host CPU and peripheral
devices.
Function
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
______________
Table GF-3 Conditions of LPC bus interface function induced by LRESET input
Pin name / Internal register
______________
______________
LRESET=“H”
LRESET=“L”
P30/LAD0
P31/LAD1
LPC bus interface
function(function is
P32/LAD2
P33/LAD3
select)
Note
I/O port
Pin
_________________
P34/LFRAME
_______________
P35/LRESET
I/O port
LPC bus interface function
P36/LCLK
P40/OBF00
I/O port
P43/OBF01
P44/OBF1
Internal register
P45/OBF2
P46/OBF3
OBF output is enable until
LRESET=“L”. A spike pulse may
be output to the port when the port
is already set to L output port and
OBF signal______________
is output to the port
just before LRESET is set to L.
______________
P42/GateA20
Input data bus buffer
unstable
Output data bus buffer
U flag 7,6,5,4,2
It can't be written by slave side.
It can be written and read by Initialization to “0” only for
DBBSTS0.
XA2 flag
slave side.
Initialization to “0”
IBF flag
Initialization to “0”
There is possibility to generate
IBF interrupt request.
OBF flag
Initialization to “0”
There is possibility to generate
OBE interrupt request.
LPCADH/L
It can be written and read by
slave side.
LPCCON
It can be written and read by
slave side.
GA20 circuit
Initialization
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 163 of 290
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
GateA20 output function
The GateA20 pin (port P42) can be controlled by LPC interface function channel 0 in hardware.
Hardware GateA20 is sharing with P42 pin. Setting “1” to bit 0 of GateA20 control register enables the hardware GateA20 function. The default value of hardware GateA20 is “1”.
The GateA20 control register is shown in Fig.GF-9.
When the host CPU writes “D1” command to address 006416, and then writes data to address 006016 in
succession, the value of bit 1 of the data will be output to GateA20 pin. The timing is shown in Fig.GF-10.
The GateA20 operation sequences are shown in Fig.GF-11, Fig.GF-12. As shown in the figures, there is no
change in input buffer full flag(IBF0) and no input buffer full(IBF) interrupt request, but the input data bus
buffer and XA2 flag are changed in these sequences.
The value of the GateA20 output pin will be held till the data next to D1 command is written in. P42 becomes
_____________
I/O port and the the value of GateA20 becomes "0" when LRESET input is “L”. GateA20 will be initialized even
if the sequence is executed. However, the GateA20 enable bit will not be changed and GateA20 output pin
_____________
will be resumed after the LRESET input becomes “H”.
GateA20 control register
AA
A
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
GA20CON
Address
002CA16
Reset
0016
Bit name
Bit Symbol
Function
GateA20 enable bit
GA20EN
R W
0 : P42 as GPIO
1 : Hardware GateA20 function enable
Reserved bit
Must be set to “0”
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing. "0" in reading.
Fig.GF-9 GateA20 control register
START
WRITE
16-bit address
DATA
TAR
SYNC
TAR
LCLK
LFRAME
LAD (3:0)
Previous value
GateA20 pin
Fig.GF-10 GateA20 output timing
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 164 of 290
The value of bit 1 of the data
LPC Bus Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
Sequence 1 (basic operation 1)
LPC communication
GateA20 pin
Write data
to 006016
Write D1
to 006416
Write FF
to 006416
Previous value
Bit 1 value of the data
IBF0 flag refresh
No
No
No
IBF interrupt request
No
No
No
Sequence 2 (basic operation 2)
LPC communication
GateA20 pin
Write data other
than FF and D1
to 006416
Write data
to 006016
Write D1
to 006416
Previous value
Bit 1 value of the data
IBF0 flag refresh
No
No
Yes
IBF interrupt request
No
No
Yes
Sequence 3 (basic operation 3)
LPC communication
GateA20 pin
Write data
to 006016
Previous value
Bit 1 value of the data
IBF0 flag refresh
No
No
Yes
IBF interrupt request
No
No
Yes
Fig.GF-11 GateA20 operation sequence (1)
Rev.1.00
Write data
to 006016
Write D1
to 006416
Jun 06, 2003
page 165 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
LPC Bus Interface
Sequence 4 (re-trigger)
Write D1
to 006416
LPC communication
Write D1
to 006416
GateA20 pin
Write data
to 006016
Previous value
Bit 1 value of the data
IBF0 flag refresh
No
No
No
IBF interrupt request
No
No
No
Sequence 5 (cancel operation)
LPC communication
Write D1
to 006416
GateA20 pin
Previous value
Write data
other than
D1 to 006416
IBF0 flag refresh
No
Yes
IBF interrupt request
No
Yes
Sequence 6 (continuance operation)
LPC communication
GateA20 pin
Write data1
to 006016
Write D1
to 006416
Previous value
Write data2
to 006016
Bit 1 value of the data
The value of bit 1 of data 2
IBF0 flag refresh
No
No
No
No
IBF interrupt request
No
No
No
No
Fig.GF-12 GateA20 operation sequence (2)
Rev.1.00
Write D1
to 006416
Jun 06, 2003
page 166 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Serial Interrupt Output
Serial Interrupt Output
The serial interrupt output is the circuit that outputs the interrupt request to the host with serial interrupt
data format.
Tab.SI-1 shows the specification of serial interrupt output.
Table.SI-1 Specifications of serial interrupt output
Item
The factors of serial interrupt
The number of frame
Operation clock
Clock restart
Clock stop inhibition
OBF sync enable
Specification
The numbers of serial interrupt requests (numbers of channels) that can output simultaneously are 5 factors. Each interrupt factor of each channel is explained as follows.
• Channel 0
➀ By setting “1” to IRQi request bit (bit 5, 6 i=1,12) of IRQ request register 0, the interrupt
request can be generated.
➁ Synchronized with OBF00 and OBF01 that are the host bus interface internal signals,
the serial interrupt request can be generated.
• Channel 1-3
➀ By setting “1” to IRQ request bit (bit 5) of IRQ request register 1-3, the interrupt
request can be generated.
➁ Synchronized with OBF1-3 that are the host bus interface internal signals, the serial
interrupt request can be generated.
• Channel 4
By setting “1” to IRQ request bit (bit 5) of IRQ request register 4, the interrupt request can be
generated.
• Channel 0
➀ Setting the IRQ1 request bit (bit 5) of IRQ request register0 to “1” or detecting
OBF00, which is the host bus interface internal signal, selects Frame 1.
➁ Setting the IRQ12 request bit (bit 6) of IRQ request register0 to “1” or detecting
OBF01, which is the host bus interface internal signal, selects Frame 12.
• Channel 1-4
Selecting the frame select bit (bit 0-4) of IRQ request register1-4 selects Frame 1-15
or extend Frame 0-10.
The operation synchronized with LCLK (Max. 33MHz). (Note)
Setting the clock restart enable bit (bit 6) of serial interrupt control register0 to “1”
requests the clock restart if the clock has stopped or slowed down in serial interrupt
output.
Setting the clock stop inhibition bit (bit 5) of serial interrupt control register0 to “1”
requests the inhibition of clock stop if the clock tends to stop or slow down in serial
interrupt output.
Setting the OBF00, OBF01, OBF1-3 sync enable bit (bit 0-4) of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” enables the OBF synchronization.
Note: To enable LCLK, it is necessary to enable the LPC bus interface function.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 167 of 290
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
internal data bus
Serial interrupt control register0
(address:02B016 )
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Clock stop inhibiting enable
IRQ request register1 - 4
(address:02B316 , 02B416,
02B516 ,02B616)
IRQ request register0
(address:02B216 )
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
IRQ request 00,01
IRQ request 1 - 4
Clock restart enable
OBF sync enable
IRQ request 0 - 4
Serial interrupt enable
Internal signals
OBF00,OBF01,
OBF1 - OBF3
IRQ frame number 1 - 4
Serial interrupt request
Control circuit
IRQ request
0-4
Port control section
IRQ request
clear
Frame number
(CH0 - CH4)
SERIRQ
Serial interrupt output
Control circuit
Clock operation
Status & finish
acknowledge
Clock restart
request & start frame
start request
Clock monitor/
Control circuit
CLKRUN
LCLK
Reset selection
LRESET
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
PRST
Serial interrupt control register1(address:
02B116 )
f1
Internal data bus
Fig.SI-1 Serial interrupt block chart
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 168 of 290
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
(1) Register explanation
Fig.SI-2 shows the configuration of IRQ request register0, Fig.SI-3 shows the configuration of
IRQ request register1-4, Fig.SI-4, SI-5 show the configurations of serial interrupt control register0,1 respectively.
● IRQ request register0 IRQR0
The serial interrupt request of Channel 0 is set by software.
•IRQ1 request bit IR0
Setting the bit to “1” generates the serial interrupt request (Frame 1).
By setting the OBF00 sync enable bit (bit 0) of the serial interrupt control register0 to “1”, the value
of IR0 is the same as that of OBF00, which is the host bus interface internal signal. When the
internal signal OBF00 is “1”, the serial interrupt is generated.
IR0 is cleared to “0” by writing “0” in software.
IR0 can not be cleared to “0” by software when the internal signal OBF00 is “1” if OBF00 sync
enable bit is set to “1”.
•IRQ12 request bit IR1
Setting the bit to “1” generates the serial interrupt request (Frame 12).
By setting the OBF01 sync enable bit (bit 1) of the serial interrupt control register0 to “1”, the value
of IR1 is the same with that of OBF01, which is the host bus interface internal signal. When the
internal signal OBF01 is “1”, the serial interrupt is generated.
IR1 is cleared to “0” by writing “0” in software.
IR1 can not be cleared to “0” by software when the internal signal OBF01 is “1” if OBF01 sync
enable bit is set to “1”.
AAAAAA
A
AAAAAA
A
IRQ request register0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol: IRQR0
Address: 02B216
Bit symbol
Bit name
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, “0” in reading.
IRQ1 request bit
0: No IRQ1 request
1: IRQ1 request
IR1
IRQ12 request bit
0: No IRQ12 request
1: IRQ12 request
Fig.SI-2 Configuration of IRQ request register0
Jun 06, 2003
Function
IR0
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, “0” in reading.
Rev.1.00
When reset: 0016
page 169 of 290
R W
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
● IRQ request register i IRQRi (i=1-4)
The serial interrupt request of Channel 1-4 is set by software, or asserting frame is selected.
•IRQ request bit IR
Setting the bit to “1” generates the serial interrupt request.
By setting the OBFj sync enable bit (bit2-4, j=1-3) of the serial interrupt control register0 to “1”, the
value of IR is the same as that of OBFj, which is the host bus interface internal signal. When the
internal signal OBFj is “1”, the serial interrupt is generated.
IR is cleared to “0” by writing “0” in software.
IR can not be cleared to “0” by software when the internal signal OBFj is “1” if OBFj sync enable
bit is set to “1”.
● IRQ select bit IS0-4
The asserting frame is selected.
AA
A
A
AA
AAA
AA
A
IRQ request register1-4
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IRQR1
IRQR2
IRQR3
IRQR4
Bit symbol
IS0
Address
02B316
02B416
02B516
02B616
When reset
0016
0016
0016
0016
Bit name
IRQ Frame
0 0 0 0 0 : No SERIRQ output
0 0 0 0 1 : Frame 1
0 0 0 1 0 : Frame 2
0 0 0 1 1 : Frame 3
0 0 1 0 0 : Frame 4
0 0 1 0 1 : Frame 5
0 0 1 1 0 : Frame 6
0 0 1 1 1 : Frame 7
0 1 0 0 0 : Frame 8
0 1 0 0 1 : Frame 9
0 1 0 1 0 : Frame 10
0 1 0 1 1 : Frame 11
0 1 1 0 0 : Frame 12
0 1 1 0 1 : Frame 13
0 1 1 1 0 : Frame 14
0 1 1 1 1 : Frame 15
1 0 0 0 0 : Can’t select
1 0 0 0 1 : Can’t select
1 0 0 1 0 : Can’t select
1 0 0 1 1 : Can’t select
1 0 1 0 0 : Can’t select
1 0 1 0 1 : Extend Frame 0
1 0 1 1 0 : Extend Frame 1
1 0 1 1 1 : Extend Frame 2
1 1 0 0 0 : Extend Frame 3
1 1 0 0 1 : Extend Frame 4
1 1 0 1 0 : Extend Frame 5
1 1 0 1 1 : Extend Frame 6
1 1 1 0 0 : Extend Frame 7
1 1 1 0 1 : Extend Frame 8
1 1 1 1 0 : Extend Frame 9
1 1 1 1 1 : Extend Frame 10
IRQ request bit
0: No IRQ request
1: IRQ request
IS1
IS2
IS3
IS4
IR
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, “0” in reading.
Fig.SI-3 Configuration of IRQ request register1-4
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 170 of 290
Function
Frame select bit
b4b3b2b1b0
R W
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
● Serial interrupt control register0 SERCON0
The operation condition of serial interrupt is set.
•OBFi sync enable bit SENi (i=00,01,1-3)
By setting the bit to “1”, sync with the OBFi of host interface, the serialized interrupt can be
generated.
•Clock stop inhibition bit SUPEN
Setting the bit to “1” will request the inhibition of clock if the clock tends to stop or slow down in
serial interrupt request.
•Clock restart enable bit RUNEN
Setting the bit to “1” requests the clock restart during the clock stop or clock slow down in serial
interrupt request.
•Serial interrupt enable bit IRQEN
__________ _______________
0: SERIRQ, PRST, CLKRUN are I/O ports.
__________ _______________
1: SERIRQ, PRST, CLKRUN are serial interrupt function ports.
AA
AA
A
AA
AAAA
A
AA
Serial interrupt control register0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
SERCON0
Bit symbol
Address
02B016
When reset
0016
Bit name
R W
Function
0: Sync inhibition
1: Sync enable
SEN00
OBF00 sync enable bit
SEN01
OBF01 sync enable bit
0: Sync inhibition
1: Sync enable
SEN1
OBF1 sync enable bit
0: Sync inhibition
1: Sync enable
SEN2
OBF2 sync enable bit
SEN3
OBF3 sync enable bit
0: Sync inhibition
1: Sync enable
0: Sync inhibition
1: Sync enable
0: Stop control operation
1: No stop control operation
SUPEN
Clock stop inhibition bit
RUNEN
Clock restart enable bit
0: No clock restart
1: Clock restart
IRQEN
Serial interrupt enable bit
0: Serial interrupt inhibition
1: Serial interrupt enable
(Note 1)
_______________
Note 1 : When IRQEN is set to “1”, if either SUPEN or RUNEN is set to “1”, P46 will function as CLKRUN I/O and the output type
is N channel open drain.
__________
__________
Note 2 : When the bit is set to “1”, P43, P45 function as SERIRQ, PRST respectively. Even the bit is set to “1”, P45/PRST can
function as GPIO if bit 1 of serial interrupt control register 1 (address 02B116) is set to “1”.
Fig.SI-4 Configuration of serial interrupt control register0
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 171 of 290
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
● Serial interrupt control register1 SERCON1
The register is for setting the pins of serial interrupt.
•Reset selection bit RSEL
__________
0: The input of PRST is the reset signal.
______________
1: The input of LRESET is the reset signal. (Note1)
__________
Note 1: The PRST pin becomes I/O port if setting the bit to “1”.
AA
A
AA
A
AAAA
AA
Serial interrupt control register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
0
0
Symbol
SERCON1
Bit symbol
Address
02B116
Bit name
Reset selection bit
OBF0MRG
OBF0 mergence bit
OBF0CLR
OBF0 cut sync bit
Reserved bit
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing. “0” in reading.
Fig.SI-5 Configuration of serial interrupt control register1
Jun 06, 2003
page 172 of 290
0 : Select PRST pin.
1 : Select LRESET pin.
Must be “0”.
Reserved bit
Rev.1.00
Function
Must be “0”.
Reserved bit
RSEL
When reset
0016
0 : OBF00 and OBF01 are
independent.
1 : OBF00 and OBF01 are merged
(logical OR).
0: Normal operation
1: SEN00, SEN01 is cleared
when OBF0 is cleared.
Must be “0”.
R W
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
•OBF0 mergence function
By setting the bit to “1”, the signal, which is logically OR by OBF00 and OBF01 signals from LPC
bus interface, will output to IRQ1 and IRQ12 of serial interrupt circuit.
With the function, the IRQ1 and IRQ12 request bits can be cleared simultaneously by H/W at the
read of output data buffer from system if both IRQ1 and IRQ12 request bits are set in the case
that IRQ1 request bit (or IRQ12 request bit) is set after that of IRQ12 (or IRQ1) because of the
overwrite to the output data buffer.
•OBF0 sync inhabitant function
By setting bit 4 of serial interrupt control register 1 (OBF cut sync bit), simultaneously after the
read of OBF0, the OBF0 sync function can be inhabited.
If the bit is set to “1”, simultaneously after the clear of OBF00 or OBF01, SEN00 (OBF00 sync
enable bit) and SEN01 (OBF01 sync enable bit) bits are cleared (sync inhabitation) by H/W.
The configuration of serial interrupt control register 1 and the switching circuit controlled by
OBF0MRG, OBF0CLR are shown in Fig. SI-5, Fig. SI-6 respectively.
OBF0CLR
OBF0MRG
OBF0
RD
OBF0
“0”
RD/WR
OBF0001
SEN00
To IRQ1 request bit of
serial interrupt circuit
WR
IR0
“1”
OBF0 clear signal
(Triggered by host read)
“0”
OBF0SEL
OBF0001
“1”
SEN01
RD/WR
To IRQ12 request bit of
serial interrupt circuit
WR
IR0
RD
Fig.SI-6 The switching circuit controlled by OBF0MRG, OBF0CLR
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 173 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Serial Interrupt Output
● Serial interrupt control register2 SERCON2
The polarity of serial interrupt output can be selected by bit 0 to bit 5 of serial interrupt control register 2.
When the bit is set to “0”:
If there is a request, Hiz-Hiz-Hiz
If there is no request, L-H-Hiz
When the bit is set to “1”:
If there is a request, L-H-Hiz
If there is no request, Hiz-Hiz-Hiz
Only the default value of bit 4 (serial interrupt polarity bit 3) of serial interrupt control register 2
after reset is “1”.
Fig.SI-7 shows the configuration of serial interrupt control register 2.
AA
A
AA
A
AAAA
AA
Serial interrupt control register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
SERCON2
Bit symbol
Address
02B716
When reset
1016
Bit name
Function
SERSEL00
Serial interrupt polarity selection
bit 00
SERSEL01
Serial interrupt polarity selection
bit 01
SERSEL1
Serial interrupt polarity selection
bit 1
SERSEL2
Serial interrupt polarity selection
bit 2
SERSEL3
Serial interrupt polarity selection
bit 3
SERSEL4
Serial interrupt polarity selection
bit 4
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing. “0” in reading.
Note: “0”
“1”
: If there is a request
If there is no request
: If there is a request
If there is no request
Hiz-Hiz-Hiz
L-H-Hiz
L-H-Hiz
Hiz-Hiz-Hiz
Fig.SI-7 The configuration of serial interrupt control register 2
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 174 of 290
Select serial interrupt
output polarity of IRQ1 in
channel 0. (Note)
Select serial interrupt
output polarity of IRQ12
in channel 0. (Note)
Select serial interrupt
output polarity of IRQ in
channel 1. (Note)
Select serial interrupt
output polarity of IRQ in
channel 2. (Note)
Select serial interrupt
output polarity of IRQ in
channel 3. (Note)
Select serial interrupt
output polarity of IRQ in
channel 4. (Note)
R W
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
(2) The operation of serial interrupt
A cycle operation of serial interrupt starts with start frame and finishes with stop frame. There are
2 kinds of operation mode: continuous mode and quiet mode. The next operation mode is judged
by monitoring the length of stop frame sent from host side.
● The timing of serial interrupt cycle
Fig.SI-8 shows an example of basic timing of serial interrupt cycle.
➀ Start frame
The start frame will be detected if the SERIRQ remains “L” in 4-8 clock cycles.
➁IRQ data frame
Each IRQ data frame is 3 clock cycles.
•Channel 0-2,4:If the IRQ request bit is “0”, then the SERIRQ is driven to “L” during the 1st clock
cycle of the corresponding data frame, to “H” during the 2nd clock cycle, to high impedance during
the 3rd clock cycle. If the IRQ request bit is “1”, then the SERIRQ is high impedance during all of
the 3 clock cycles.
•Channel 3:If the IRQ request bit is “0”, then the SERIRQ is high impedance during all of the 3
clock cycles. If the IRQ request bit is “1”, then the SERIRQ is driven to “L” during the 1st clock
cycle of the corresponding data frame, to “H” during the 2nd clock cycle, to high impedance during
the 3rd clock cycle.
③Stop frame
The stop frame will be detected if the SERIRQ remains “L” in 2 or 3 clock cycles. The next operation mode is quiet mode if the length of “L” is 2 clock cycles, the continuous mode if the length is
3 clock cycles.
Start frame
frame 0
frame 1
frame 15
IOCHK
Stop frame
Clock
SERIRQ
Driver source
System side
Device side
Fig.SI-8 Basic timing of serial interrupt cycle
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 175 of 290
Device side
System side
to the next cycle
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
● Operation mode
Fig.SI-9 shows an example of timing of continuous mode, Fig.SI-10 shows that of quiet mode.
➀Continuous mode
__________
_______________
After reset, at the rising edge of PRST (or LRESET) or the length of the last stop frame of serial
interrupt cycle being 3 clock cycles, it will be the continuous mode.
After receiving the start frame (Note 1), the Frame 1, Frame 12 or frames selected in each channel will be asserted.
Note 1: If the length of “L” is less than 4 clock cycles or more than 9 clock cycles, the start frame
will not be detected and the next start (the falling edge of SERIRQ) is waited.
Start frame (Note1)
IRQ0 frame
IRQ1 frame
IRQ2 frame
IRQ3 frame
Clock
SERIRQ line
System•SERIRQ output
Device•SERIRQ output
Driver source
System side
Device side
Note1 . The start frame is set to 4 clock as setting exemple
Fig.SI-9 Timing diagram of continuous mode
➁Quiet mode
At clock stop or clock slow down, or the length of the last stop frame of serial interrupt cycle being
2 clock cycles, it will be the quiet mode.
In this mode the SERIRQ is driven to “L” in the 1st clock cycle by device and after the receiving of
the rest start frame (Note 1) from host, the IRQ1 Frame , IRQ12 Frame or frames selected in each
channel will be asserted.
Note 1: If the sum of length of “L” that is driven by the device in the 1st clock cycle and by the host
in the rest clock cycles is within 4-8 clock cycles, the start frame will be detected.
If the sum of length of “L” is less than 4 clock cycles or more than 9 clock cycles, the start
frame will not be detected and the next start (the falling edge of SERIRQ) is waited.
Start frame (Note1)
IRQ0 frame
IRQ1 frame
LCLK
SERIRQ line
System•SERIRQ output
Device•SERIRQ output
Driver source
Device side
Device side
System side
Note1 . The start frame is set to 4 clock as setting example
Fig.SI-10 Timing diagram of quiet mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 176 of 290
IRQ2 frame
IRQ3 frame
Serial Interrupt Output
M16C/6K9 Group
(3) Clock restart/ stop inhibition request
_______________
Asserting the CLKRUN signal can request to restart or maintain the clock which stops or slows
down or request the host to tend to stop or slow down.
Fig.SI-11 shows an example of timing of clock restart request, Fig.SI-12 shows an example of
timing of clock stop inhibition request.
➀Clock restart operation
Setting the clock restart bit of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” will request the clock restart if
the clock has slowed down or stopped at serial interrupt request.
LCLK
CLKRUN line
System•CLKRUN
Restart frame
Device•CLKRUN
Start frame
SERIRQ line
System•SERIRQ
Device•SERIRQ
f1
Serial interrupt request
Internal Interrupt restart
request signal
Fig.SI-11 Timing diagram of clock restart request
➁Clock stop inhibition request
Setting the clock stop inhibition bit of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” will request the inhibition of clock stop if the clock tends to stop or slow down during all the period of serial interrupt
output.
Clock
CLKRUN line
System•CLKRUN
Inhibition
request
Device•CLKRUN
A cycle of serial interrupt
SERIRQ line
Serial interrupt request
Internal Interrupt Inhibition
request signal
Fig.SI-12 Example of timing of clock stop inhibition request
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 177 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
The multi-master I2C-BUS interface is a serial communication circuit based on Philips I2C-BUS data transfer
format. 3 independent channels, with both arbitration lost detection and a synchronous functions, are built in
for the multi-master serial communication. Fig.GC-1 shows a block diagram of the multi-master I2C-BUS
interface and Table.GC-1 lists the multi-master I2C-BUS interface functions. The multi-master I2C-BUS interface consists of the I2C address register, the I2C data shift register, the I2C clock control register, the I2C
control register 1, I2C control register 2, the I2C status register, the I2C start/stop condition control register
and other control circuits.
Note 1: 2 independent channels exist in M306K9F8LRP.
Table.GC-1 Multi-master I2C-BUS interface functions
Item
Format
Communication mode
SCL clock frequency
*VIIC=I2C
Rev.1.00
system clock
Jun 06, 2003
page 178 of 290
Function
Based on Philips I2C-BUS standard:
10-bit addressing format
7-bit addressing format
High-speed clock mode
Standard clock mode
Based on Philips I2C-BUS standard:
Master transmission
Master reception
Slave transmission
Slave reception
16.1kHz to 400kHz (at VIIC = 4MHz)
Rev.1.00
S3D
ICK1
b7
Jun 06, 2003
page 179 of 290
b0
Fig.GC-1 Block diagram of multi-master I2C-BUS interface
clock
(SCL)
Serial
Noise
elimination
circuit
I C start/stop condition
control register
2
Clock
control
circuit
circuit
BB
circuit
b7
I2C address register
b0
TOE
I2
C system clock
(VIIC)
Clock division
ICK1,ICK0=1,1
ICK1,ICK0=0,0
ICK1,ICK0=0,1
ICK1,ICK0=1,0
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
f1
10BIT
SAD
ALS
Bit count
ES0 BC2 BC1 BC0
b0
I 2 C status register
I C control register 0
S1D
2
b0
Interrupt request signal
(I2CIRQ)
AL AAS AD0 LRB
ICCK(External clock)
b7
S1
TISS
2 S2
I C clock control register
Interrupt
generating
circuit
MST TRX BB PIN
b7
b0
System clock select circuit
Timeout detection
circuit
TOSEL TOF
Internal data bud
b0
FAST
ACK MODE
CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0
BIT
S4D
2
I C control register 2
I2C data shift register
Address comparator
SAD5 SAD4 SAD3 SAD2 SAD1 SAD0 RBW
b7
S0
b7
S0D
SAD6
ACK
Data
control
circuit
Noise
elimination
circuit
AL
Interrupt request signal
(SCLSDAIRQ)
SIM
Interrupt
generating
circuit
WIT
STSP
SIS SIP SSC4 SSC3 SSC2 SSC1 SSC0
SEL
S2D
(SDA)
Serial data
ICK0 SCLM SDAM
I2C Control register 1
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
I2C Data Shift Register
The I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) is an 8-bit shift register to store receiving data
and write transmission data. When transmit data is written into this register, it is transferred to the outside
from bit 7 in synchronization with the SCL clock, and each time one-bit data is output, the data of this register
are shifted by one bit to the left. When data is received, it is input to this register from bit 0 in synchronization
with the SCL clock, and each time one-bit data is input, the data of this register are shifted by one bit to the
left. The timing of storing received data to this register is shown in figure GC-3.The I2C data shift register is
in a write enable status only when the I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0 bit : bit 3 of address 032316,
033316, 031316) of the I2C control register 0 is “1”. The bit counter is reset by a write instruction to the I2C
data shift register. When both the ES0 bit and the MST bit of the I2C status register (address 032816, 033816,
031816) are “1”, the SCL is output by a write instruction to the I2C data shift register. Reading data from the
I2C data shift register is always enabled regardless of the value of ES0 bit.
2
AAAAAA
I C data shift register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S0i(i=0,1,2)
Address
032016,033016,031016
When reset
--
R W
Function
Transmission data /receiving data are stored.
In the master transmission mode, the start condition/ stop condition are
triggered by writing data to the register (refer to the section on the method to
generate the start/stop condition). The transmission/receiving are started
synchronized with SCL.
Note
Note The write is only enabled when bus interface enable bit (ES0 bit) is "1".
Because the register is used both for storing transmission data/receiving data, the
transmission data should be written after the receiving data are read out before
writing transmission data to this register.
Fig.GC-2 I2C data shift register
SCL
SDA
tdfil
tdfil : Noise elimination circuit delay time
Internal SCL
1 to 2 VIIC cycle
Internal SDA
tdfil
tdsf : Shift clock delay time
1 VIIC cycle
tdsft
Shift clock
Storing data at shift clock rising edge.
Fig.GC-3 The timing of receiving data stored to I2C data shift register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 180 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
I2C Address Register
The I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216) consists of a 7-bit slave address and a read/
write bit. In the addressing mode, the slave address written in this register is compared with the address
data to be received immediately after the START condition is detected.
•Bit 0: Read/write bit (RBW)
This is not used in the 7-bit addressing mode. In the 10-bit addressing mode, the first byte address data to
be received are compared with the contents (SAD6 to SAD0 + RBW) of the I2C address register.
The RBW bit is cleared to “0” automatically when the stop condition is detected.
•Bits 1 to 7: Slave address (SAD0–SAD6)
These bits store slave addresses. Regardless of the 7-bit addressing mode or the 10-bit addressing
mode, the address data transmitted from the master is compared with the contents of these bits.
2
I C address register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
S0Di(i=0,1,2)
b0
Bit Symbol
Address
032216,033216,031216
Bit name
When reset
000000002
Function
RBW
Read/Write bit
This bit is using for comparing
with receiving address data in the
10-bit address mode. (Note)
SAD0
Slave address
For comparing with received
address data
SAD1
SAD2
SAD3
SAD4
SAD5
SAD6
Note.The RBW bit is cleared to "0" automatically when stop condition is detected
Fig.GC-4 I2C address register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 181 of 290
R
W
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
I2C Clock Control Register
The I2C clock control register 0,1 (address 032416, 033416, 031416) is used to set ACK control, SCL mode
and SCL frequency.
•Bits 0 to 4: SCL frequency control bits (CCR0–CCR4)
These bits control the SCL frequency. Refer to Table GC-2.
•Bit 5: SCL mode specification bit (FAST MODE)
This bit specifies the SCL mode. When this bit is set to “0”, the standard clock mode is selected. When the bit
is set to “1” , the high-speed clock mode is selected. When connecting to the bus with the high-speed mode
I2C-BUS standard (maximum 400 kbits/s), set 4 MHz or more to I2C system clock(VIIC).
•Bit 6: ACK bit (ACK BIT)
This bit sets the SDA status when an ACK clock is generated. When this bit is set to “0”, the ACK return mode
is selected and SDA goes to “L” at the occurrence of an ACK clock. When the bit is set to “1”, the ACK
nonreturn mode is selected. The SDA is held in the “H” status at the occurrence of an ACK clock. However,
when the slave address agrees with the address data in the reception of address data at ACK BIT = “0”, the
SDA is automatically made “L” (ACK is returned). If there is a disagreement between the slave address and
the address data, the SDA is automatically made “H” (ACK is not returned).
*ACK clock: Clock for acknowledgment
•Bit 7: ACK clock bit (ACK)
This bit specifies the mode of acknowledgment which responses to the data transferring. When this bit is set
to “0”, the no ACK clock mode is selected. In this case, no ACK clock occurs after data transmission. When
the bit is set to “1”, the ACK clock mode is selected and the master generates an ACK clock at the completion of each 1-byte data transfer. The device for transmitting address data and control data releases the SDA
at the occurrence of an ACK clock (makes SDA “H”) and receives the ACK bit generated by the data receiving
device.
Note: Except for ACK bit (ACKBIT), do not write data into the I2C clock control register during transfer.
If data is written during transfer, the I2C clock generator is reset, so that data cannot be transferred
normally.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 182 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
2
I C clock control register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S2i(i=0,1,2)
Bit Symbol
CCR0
Address
032416,033416,031416
Bit name
When reset
000000002
Function
SCL frequency control bits
Refer to table.GC-2
SCL mode specification bit
0 : Standard clock mode
1 : High-speed clock mode
ACK bit
0 : ACK is returned
1 : ACK is not returned
ACK clock bit
0 : No ACK clock
1 : ACK clock
CCR1
CCR2
CCR3
CCR4
FAST
MODE
ACK BIT
ACK
Fig.GC-5 I2C clock register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 183 of 290
R W
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
→
→
→
→
→
Table.GC-2 Set values of I2C clock control register and SCL frequency
Setting value of CCR4 to CCR0
SCL frequency (at VIIC=4MHz, unit : kHz) (Note1)
CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0
Standard clock mode
High-speed clock mode
0
0
0
0
0
Setting disabled
Setting disabled
0
0
0
0
1
Setting disabled
Setting disabled
0
0
0
1
0
Setting disabled
Setting disabled
0
0
0
1
1
- (Note2)
333
0
0
1
0
0
- (Note2)
250
0
0
1
0
1
100
400 (Note3)
0
0
1
1
0
83.3
166
500 / CCR value
1000 / CCR value
(Note3)
(Note3)
1
1
1
0
1
17.2
34.5
1
1
1
1
0
16.6
33.3
1
1
1
1
1
16.1
32.3
Notes1: Duty of SCL clock output is 50 %. The duty becomes 35 to 45 % only when the high-speed clock
mode is selected and CCR value = 5 (400 kHz, at V IIC = 4 MHz). “H” duration of the clock
fluctuates from –4 to +2 machine cycles in the standard clock mode, and fluctuates from –2 to +2
machine cycles in the high-speed clock mode. In the case of negative fluctuation, the frequency
does not increase because “L” duration is extended instead of “H” duration reduction. These are
value when SCL clock synchronization by the synchronous function is not performed. CCR value
is the decimal notation value of the SCL frequency control bits CCR4 to CCR0.
2: Each value of SCL frequency exceeds the limit at VIIC = 4 MHz or more. When using these
setting value, use VIIC = 4 MHz or less. Refer to I2C system clock selection bits (bit 6,7 of
I 2C control register 1) on VIIC.
3: The data formula of SCL frequency is described below:
VIIC/(8 X CCR value) Standard clock mode
VIIC/(4 X CCR value) High-speed clock mode (CCR value ≠ 5)
VIIC/(2 X CCR value) High-speed clock mode (CCR value = 5)
Do not set 0 to 2 as CCR value regardless of VIIC frequency.
Set 100 kHz (max.) in the standard clock mode and 400 kHz (max.) in the high-speed clock
mode to the SCL frequency by setting the SCL frequency control bits CCR4 to CCR0.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 184 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
I2C Control Register 0
The I2C control register 0 (address 032316, 033316, 031316) of channel 0, 1 controls data communication format.
•Bits 0 to 2: Bit counter (BC0–BC2)
These bits decide the number of bits for the next 1-byte data to be transmitted. The I2C interrupt request
signal occurs immediately after the number of count specified with these bits (ACK clock is added to the
number of count when ACK clock is selected by ACK bit (bit 7 of address 032416, 033416, 031416)) have
been transferred, and BC0 to BC2 are returned to “0002”.
Also when a START condition is detected, these bits become “0002” and the address data is always transmitted and received in 8 bits.
•Bit 3: I2C interface enable bit (ES0)
This bit enables to use the multi-master I2C-BUS interface. When this bit is set to “0”, the interface is disabled
and the SDA and the SCL become high-impedance. When the bit is set to “1”, the interface is enabled.
When ES0 = “0”, the following is performed.
1)Set MST = “0”, TRX = “0”, PIN = “1”, BB =“0”, AL = “0”, AAS = “0”, and AD0 = “0”, of I 2C status
register (Address : 032816, 033816, 031816)
2)Writing data to I2C data shift register (Address : 032016, 033016, 031016) is inhibited.
3)The TOF bit of I2C control register (Address : 032716, 033716, 031716) is cleared to “0”
4)I2C system clock (VIIC) is stopped and the interval counter, flags are initialized.
•Bit 4: Data format selection bit (ALS)
This bit decides if the recognition of slave address should be processed. When this bit is set to “0”, the
addressing format is selected, so that address data will be recognized. The transfer will be processed only
when a comparison is matched between the salve address and the address data or a general call is received
(refer to the item of bit 1 of I2C status register: general call detection flag). When this bit is set to “1”, the free
data format is selected, so that slave address will not be not recognized.
•Bit 5: Addressing format selection bit (DBIT SAD)
This bit selects a slave address specification format. When this bit is set to “0”, the 7-bit addressing format
is selected. In this case, only the high-order 7 bits (slave address) of the I2C address register (address
032216, 033216, 031216) are compared with address data. When this bit is set to “1”, the 10-bit addressing format is selected, and all the bits of the I2C address register are compared with address data.
•Bit 6: I2C-BUS interface reset bit (IHR)
The bit is used to reset I2C-BUS interface circuit in the case that the abnormal communication occurs.
When the ES0 bit is“1” (I2C-BUS interface is enabled), writing“1” to the IHR bit makes a H/W reset.
Flags are processed as follows:
1)Set MST = “0”, TRX = “0”, PIN = “1”, BB =“0”, AL = “0”, AAS = “0”, and AD0 = “0”, of I 2 C status
register (Address : 032816, 033816, 031816)
2)The TOF bit of I2C control register (Address : 032716, 033716, 031716) is cleared to “0”
3)The interval counter, flags are initialized.
After writing“1” to IHR bit, the circuit reset processing will be finished in Max. 2.5 VIIC cycles and IHR bit will
be automatically cleared to “0”. Fig.GC-6 shows the reset timing.
•Bit 7: I2C-BUS interface pin input level selection bit
This bit selects the input level of the SCL and SDA pins of the multi-master I2C-BUS interface. When this bit is
set to“1” the P60,P61/P62,P63/P76,P77 will become SMBus input level.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 185 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
The signal of writing "1" to IHR bit
IHR bit
The reset signal to I2 C-BUS interface circuit
2.5 VIIC cycles
Fig.GC-6 The timing of reset to the I2C-BUS interface circuit
I 2 C control register 0
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S1Di(i=0,1,2)
Address
032316,033316,031316
Bit Symbol
Bit name
b2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
ES0
I 2C-BUS interface
enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
ALS
Data format selection bit
0 : Addressing format
1 : Free data format
DBIT
SAD
Addressing format
selection bit
0 : 7-bit addressing format
1 : 10-bit addressing format
IHR
I2 C-BUS interface reset bit
0 : Release of reset (auto)
1 : Reset
BC1
BC2
TISS
Note
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 186 of 290
Function
Bit counter
(Number of transmitting/
receiving bits)
BC0
Fig.GC-7 I2C control register
When reset
000000002
2
I C-BUS interface pin
input level selection bit
b1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
b0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
(Note)
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 : I 2 C-BUS input
1 : SMBUS input
In the following status, the bit counter will be cleared automatically
•Start condition/stop condition is detected
•Right after the completion of 1 byte data transmission
•Right after the completion of 1 byte data receiving
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
I2C Status Register
The I2C status register (address 032816, 033816, 031816) controls the I2C-BUS interface status. The loworder 6 bits are read-only if it is used for status check. The high-order 2 bits can be both read and written.
Regarding to the function of writing to the low-order 6 bits, refer to the method of start condition/stop condition generation described later.
•Bit 0: Last receive bit (LRB)
This bit stores the last bit value of received data and can also be used for ACK receive confirmation. If ACK
is returned when an ACK clock occurs, the LRB bit is set to “0”. If ACK is not returned, this bit is set to “1”.
Except in the ACK mode, the last bit value of received data is input. The bit will be “0” by executing a
write instruction to the I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016).
•Bit 1: General call detecting flag (AD0)
When the ALS bit is “0”, this bit is set to “1” when a general call* whose address data is all “0” is received in
the slave mode. By a general call of the master device, every slave device receives control data after the
general call. The AD0 bit is set to “0” by detecting the STOP condition, START condition, or ES0 is“0”, or
reset.
*General call: The master transmits the general call address “0016” to all slaves.
•Bit 2: Slave address comparison flag (AAS)
This flag indicates a comparison result of address data when the ALS bit is “0”.
1)In the slave receive mode, when the 7-bit addressing format is selected, this bit is set to “1” in one of the
following conditions:
• The address data, which following the start conduction, is same with upper bits data of I 2C address
register(Address 032216, 033216, 031216)
• A general call is received.
2)In the slave reception mode, when the 10-bit addressing format is selected, this bit is set to “1” with the
following condition:
• When the address data is compared with the I2C address register (8 bits consisting of slave address and
RBW bit), the first bytes agree.
3)This bit is set to “0” by executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016,
031016) when ES0 is set to “1”. The bit is also set to “0” when ES0 is set to “0” or when reset.
•Bit 3: Arbitration lost* detecting flag (AL)
In the master transmission mode, when the SDA is made “L” by any other device, arbitration is judged to have
been lost, so that this bit is set to “1”. At the same time, the TRX bit is set to “0”. Immediately after transmission of the byte whose arbitration was lost is completed, the MST bit is set to “0”. The arbitration lost can be
detected only in the master transmission mode. When arbitration is lost during slave address transmission,
the TRX bit is set to “0” and the reception mode is set. Consequently, it becomes possible to detect the
agreement between its own slave address and address data transmitted by another master device. The bit is
cleared to “0” if writing to I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) when ES0 is “1”.
The bit is also cleared to “0” when ES0 is set to “0” or when reset.
*Arbitration lost: The status in which communication as a master is disabled.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 187 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
•Bit 4: I2C-BUS interface interrupt request bit (PIN)
This bit generates an interrupt request signal. After each byte data is transmitted, the PIN bit changes from
“1” to “0”. At the same time, an I2C interrupt request signal occurs to the CPU. The PIN bit is set to “0”
synchronized with the falling edge of the last internal transmitting clock (including the ACK clock) and an
interrupt request signal occurs synchronized with the falling edge of the PIN bit. When the PIN bit is “0”, the
SCL is kept in the “0” state and clock generation is disabled. In the ACK clock enable mode, if WIT bit (bit 1
of I2C control register 1) is set to “1”, synchronized with the falling edge of last bit clock and ACK clock, PIN
bit becomes to “0” and I2C interrupt request is generated (Refer to the description on bit 1 of I2C control
register 1: the data reception completion interrupt enable bit). Fig.GC-9 shows the timing of I2C interrupt
request generation. The bit is read-only, the value should be “0” in writing.
The PIN bit is set to “0” in one of the following condition:
•Executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016).
•Executing a write instruction to the I2C clock control register (Address : 032416, 033416, 031416)
(only when WIT is “1” and internal WAIT flag is “1”)
•When the ES0 bit is “0”
•At reset
The PIN bit is set to “0” in one of the following condition:
•Immediately after the completion of 1-byte data transmission (including arbitration lost is detected)
•Immediately after the completion of 1-byte data reception
•In the slave reception mode, with ALS = “0” and immediately after the completion of slave address agreement
or general call address reception
•In the slave reception mode, with ALS = “1” and immediately after the completion of address data reception
•Bit 5: Bus busy flag (BB)
This bit indicates the in-use status the bus system. When this bit is set to “0”, bus system is not busy and a
START condition can be generated. The BB flag is set/reset by the SCL, SDA pins input signal regardless of
master/slave. This flag is set to “1” by detecting the start condition, and is set to “0” by detecting the stop
condition. The condition of the detecting is set by the start/stop condition setting bits (SSC4–SSC0) of the
I2C start/stop condition control register (address 032516, 033516, 031516). When the ES0 bit (bit 3) of the I2C
control register (address 032316, 033316, 031316) is “0” or reset, the BB flag is set to “0”. For the writing
function to the BB flag, refer to the sections “START Condition Generating Method” and “STOP Condition
Generating Method” described later.
•Bit 6: Communication mode specification bit (transfer direction specification bit: TRX)
This bit decides a direction of transfer for data communication. When this bit is “0”, the reception mode is
selected and the data from a transmitting device is received. When the bit is “1”, the transmission mode is
selected and address data and control data are output onto the SDA synchronized with the clock generated on the SCL. This bit can be set/reset by software or hardware. This bit is set to “1” by hardware in the
following condition:
In___slave mode with ALS = “0”, if the AAS flag is set to “1” after the address data reception and the received
R/W bit is “1”.
This bit is set to “0” by hardware in one of the following conditions:
•When arbitration lost is detected.
•When a STOP condition is detected.
•When a start condition is prevented by the start condition duplication preventing function (Note).
•When a start condition is detected with MST = “0”.
•When ACK non-return is detected with MST = “0”.
•When ES0 = “0”.
•At reset
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 188 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
•Bit 7: Communication mode specification bit (master/slave specification bit: MST)
This bit is used for master/slave specification for data communication. When this bit is “0”, the slave is
specified, so that a START condition and a STOP condition generated by the master are received. The data
communication is performed synchronized with the clock generated by the master. When this bit is “1”, the
master is specified and a START condition and a STOP condition are generated.
Additionally, the clocks required for data communication are generated on the SCL.
This bit is set to “0” by hardware in one of the following conditions.
•Immediately after the completion of 1-byte data transfer when arbitration lost is detected.
•When a STOP condition is detected.
•Writing a start condition is prevented by the start condition duplication preventing function (Note).
•At reset
Note: START condition duplication preventing function The MST, TRX, and BB bits is set to “1” at the same
time after confirming that the BB flag is “0” in the procedure of a START condition occurrence.
However, when a START condition by an other master device occurs and the BB flag is set to “1”
immediately after the contents of the BB flag is confirmed, the START condition duplication preventing function makes the writing to the MST and TRX bits invalid. The duplication preventing function
becomes valid from the rising of the BB flag to reception completion of slave address. Refer to the
method on the start condition generation in detail.
AA
A
AA
A
AAAA
AA
2
I C status register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S1i(i=0,1,2)
Bit symbol
LRB
Address
032816,033816,031816
When reset
0001000X2
Bit name
Last receive bit
Function
R W
0 : Last bit = "0"
1 : Last bit = "1"
(Note1)
AD0
General call detecting flag
0 : No general call detected
1 : General call detected
(Note1)
AAS
Slave address comparison flag
0 : Address disagreement
1 : Address agreement
(Note1)
0 : Not detected
1 : Detected
(Note1)
AL
Arbitration lost detection flag
PIN
I 2 C-BUS
BB
TRX
MST
interface interrupt
request bit
Bus busy flag
Communication mode
specification bits
0 : Interrupt request issued
1 : No interrupt request issued
0 : Bus free
1 : Bus busy
b7
0
0
1
1
b6
0 : Slave receive mode
1 : Slave transmit mode
0 : Master receive mode
1 : Master transmit mode
Note1.This bit is read only if it is used for the status check.
How to write this bit, please refer to start condition/stop condition generating
method.
Note2.The bit can be read and only can be written with "0" by software.
Note3.Refer to the method of start condition generation on how to write these bits.
How to write this bit, please refer to start condition/stop condition generating
method.
Fig.GC-8 I2C status register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 189 of 290
(Note2)
(Note1)
(Note3)
(Note3)
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
SCL
PIN flag
I2CIRQ
Fig.GC-9 Interrupt request signal generating timing
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 190 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
I2C0, I2C1 control register 1
I2C control register 10, 11, 12 (address 032616, 033616, 031616) controls I2C-BUS interface circuit.
•Bit 0 : Interrupt enable bit by STOP condition (SIM )
It is possible for I2C-BUS interface to request an interrupt by detecting a STOP condition. If the bit set to “1”,
an interrupt from I2C-BUS interface occurs by detecting a STOP condition ( There is no change for PIN flag)
•Bit 1: Interrupt enable bit at the completion of data receiving (WIT)
When with-ACK mode (ACK bit = “1”) is specified, by enabling the interrupt at the completion of data
receiving (WIT bit = “1”), the I2C interrupt request occurs and PIN bit becomes “0” synchronized with the
falling edge of last data bit clock. SCL is fixed “L” and the generation of ACK clock is suppressed.
Table GC-3 and Fig.GC-10 show the I2C interrupt request timing and the method of communication restart.
After the communication restart, synchronized with the falling edge of ACK clock, PIN bit becomes to “0”
and I2C interrupt request occurs.
Table.GC-3 Timing of interrupt generation in data receiving
The timing of I2C interrupt generation
The method of communication restart
1)Synchronized with the falling edge of the
The execution of writing to ACKBIT of I2C clock control
last data bit clock
register. (Do not write to I2C data shift register.
The processing of ACK clock would be incorrect.)
2)Synchronized with the falling edge of the
The execution of writing to I2C data shift register
ACK clock
The state of internal WAIT flag can be read out by reading the WIT bit. The internal WAIT flag is set after
writing to I2C data shift register, and it is reset after writing to I2C clock control register. Consequently, which
of the timing 1) and 2) of interrupt request occurring can be understood. (See Fig.GC-10)In the cases of
transmission and address data reception immediately after the START condition, the interrupt request only
occurs at the falling edge of ACK clock regardless of the value of WIT bit and the WAIT flag remains the reset
state. Write “0” to WIT bit when in NACK is specified. (ACK bit = “0”)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 191 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
•Bits 2,3 : Port function selection bits PED, PEC
When ES0 bit of I2C control register 0 is set to “1”, P61/P63 and P60/P62 function as SCL and SDA respectively. However, if PED is set to “1”, SDA functions as output port so as to SCL if PEC is set to “1”. In this case,
if “0” or “1” is written to the port register, the data can be output on to the I2C-BUS regardless of the internal
SCL/SDA output signals. The functions of SCL/SDA are returned back by setting PED/PEC to “1” again.
If the ports are set in input mode, the values on the I2C-BUS can be known by reading the port register
regardless of the values of PED and PEC.Table GC-4 shows the port specification.
Table.GC-4 Ports specifications
P6 port
direction register
Pin name
ES0 bit
PED bit
P60/P62
0
1
0
1
1
0/1
-
ES0 bit
PEC bit
P6 port
direction register
0
1
0
0/1
-
1
1
-
P61/P63
Function
Port I/O function
SDA I/O function
SDA input function, port output function
Function
Port I/O function
SCL I/O function
SCL input function, port output function
•Bits 4,5 : SDA/SCL logic output value monitor bits SDAM /SCLM
It is possible to monitor the logic value of the SDA and SCL output signals from I2C-BUS interface circuit.
SDAM can monitor the output logic value of SDA. SCLM can monitor the output logic value of SCL. The bits are
read-only. Write “0” if in writing (Writing “1” is reserved)
•Bits 6,7 : I2C system clock selection bits ICK0, ICK1
These bits select the basic operation clock of I2C-BUS interface circuit. It is possible to select I2C system
clock VIIC among 1/2,1/4 and 1/8 of main clock f(XIN) and 1/2 of external I2C clock (ICCK)
Table.GC-5 I2C system clock selecting bits
ICK1
ICK0
I2C system clock
0
0
VIIC = 1 / 2f1
0
1
VIIC = 1 / 4f1
1
0
VIIC = 1 / 8f1
1
1
VIIC = 1 / 2ICCK
Note: f1 = f(XIN)
ICCK = External I2C clock
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 192 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
•The address reception in STOP mode /WAIT mode
It is possible for I2C-BUS interface to receive address data even in STOP mode or in WAIT mode. However
the I2C system clock VIIC should be supplied. Table.GC-6 shows the setting list.
Table.GC-6 Clock setting to the I2C system in different operation mode.
Mode
STOP mode
The setting content
The external clock is selected as the I2C system clock ( ICK1 = 1, ICK0 = 1) and
the external I2C clock is supplied by ICCK.
The external clock is selected as the I2C system clock ( ICK1 = 1, ICK0 = 1) and
the external I2C clock is supplied by ICCK.
Select the peripheral function clock stop bit CMO2 (bit 2 of the system clock
control register 0, address : 000616) to the state of not stopping f1,f8,f32
(CMO2 = 0) when in WAIT mode, and then execute the WAIT command.
The external clock is selected as the I2C system clock ( ICK1 = 1, ICK0 = 1) and
WAIT mode
Low power
the external I2C clock is supplied by ICCK.
consumption mode
When in reception mode, ACK bit = "1" WIT bit = "0"
SCL
SDA
7 clock
7 bit
ACK
clock
8 clock
8 bit
1 clock
ACK bit
1 bit
ACKBIT
PIN flag
Internal WAIT flag
I2C interrupt request signal
The writing signal of I2C
data shift register
When in reception mode, ACK bit = "1" WIT bit = "1"
SCL
SDA
7 clock
7 bit
ACK
clock
8 clock
1 bit
8 bit
ACKBIT
PIN flag
Internal WAIT flag
I2C interrupt request signal
➀
➁
The writing signal of I2C
data shift register
The writing signal of I2C
clock control register
Note. Do not write to I2C clock control register except bit ACKBIT.
Fig.GC-10 The timing of the interrupt generation at the completion of data reception
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 193 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
2
I C control register 1
AAAAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S3Di(i=0,1,2)
Bit Symbol
Address
032616,033616,031616
Bit name
When reset
001100002
Function
SIM
The interrupt enable bit of
STOP condition detection
0 : Disable the interrupt of STOP
condition detection
1 : Enable the interrupt of STOP
condition detection
WIT
The interrupt enable bit of
at the completion of data
reception
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
When in NACK setting
(ACK bit = "0") please write "0"
PED
SDAi/Port function switching
bit
0 : SDA I/O pin(enable ES0 = 1)
1 : GPIO(enable ES0 = 1)
PEC
SCLi/Port function switching
bit
0 : SCL I/O pin(enable ES0 = 1)
1 : GPIO(enable ES0 = 1)
SDAM
The logic value monitor
bit of SDA output
0 : SDA output logic value = "0"
1 : SDA output logic value = "1"
SCLM
The logic value monitor
bit of SCL output
0 : SCL output logic value = "0"
1 : SCL output logic value = "1"
ICK0
I 2 C system clock selection
bits
b7 b6
0 0 : VIIC=1/2f1
0 1 : VIIC=1/4f1 ✼ f1=f(XIN)
1 0 : VIIC=1/8f1
1 1 : VIIC=1/2ICCK
✼ ICCK=External I2C clock
ICK1
Fig.GC-11 I2C control register 1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 194 of 290
R W
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
I2C control register 2
I2C0, 1 control register 2 (address: 032716, 033716, 031716) control the detection of communication abnormality. In I2C-BUS communication, the data transfer is controlled by the SCL clock signal. The devices will stop in
the communication state if SCL stops during transfer. So if the SCL clock stops in “H” state for a period of time,
the I2C-BUS interface circuit can detect the time out and request an I2C interrupt. Please see Fig.GC-12.
SCL clock stop (“H”)
1 clock
SCL
1 bit
SDA
2 clock
2 bit
3 clock
3 bit
BB flag
Internal counter start signal
Internal counter stop, reset signal
The time of timeout detection
Internal counter overflow signal
I2C interrupt request signal
Fig.GC-12 The timing of timeout detection
•Bit0: Time out detection function enable bit (TOE)
The bit enables timeout detection function. By setting this bit to “1”, the I2C interrupt request signal will be
generated if the SCL clock stops in “H” state for a period of time during bus busy (BB flag =“1”).
The time of time out detection which is selected by timeout detection time selection bit (TOSEL) with long
time mode or short time mode will be calculated by internal counter. When time out is detected, please set “0”
to I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0) and then process initialization.
•Bit1: Time out detection flag (TOF )
The bit is the flag showing timeout detection status. If the time which is calculated by the internal counter
overflows, the time out detection flag (TOF) becomes to “1”, and at the same time the I2C interrupt request
signal is generated.
•Bit2: timeout detection time selection bit (TOSEL)
The bit selects timeout detection time from long time and short time mode. If TOSEL = “0”, the long time
mode; TOSEL = “1”, the short mode is selected respectively. The long time is up counted by 16 bits counter
and the short time is up counted by 14 bits counter based on I2C system clock (VIIC). Table GC-7 shows
examples of the timeout detection time.
Table.GC-7 Examples of timeout detection time
VIIC(MHz)
4
2
1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
Long time mode
16.4
32.8
65.6
page 195 of 290
(Unit: ms)
Short time mode
4.1
8.2
16.4
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
2
I Control register 2
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S4Di(i=0,1,2)
Bit symbol
Address
032716,033716,031716
Bit name
When reset
000000002
Function
TOE
Timeout detection function
enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
TOF
Timeout detection flag
0 : Not detected
1 : Detected
Timeout detection time selection bit
0 : Long time
1 : Short time
TOSEL
R
W
Nothing is assigned.
Can not be written in the value is "0"
SCPIN
STOP condition detection interrupt
request bit
0 : No interrupt request
1 : Interrupt request
Fig.GC-13 I2C control register 2
•Bit7: STOP condition detection interrupt request bit (SCPIN)
The bit monitors the stop condition detection interrupt. The bit becomes to “1” when I2C-BUS interface
interrupt is generated by the detecting of STOP condition. Writing “0” clears the bit and “1” can not be written.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 196 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
I2C START/STOP condition control register
I2C START/STOP condition register(address 032516, 033516, 031516) controls the detection of START/STOP
condition.
•Bit0-Bit4: START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4-SSC0)
Because the release time, set up time and hold time of SCL is calculated on the base of I2C system clock(VIIC).
The detecting condition changes depending on the oscillation frequency and I2C system clock selecting bits. It
is necessary to set the suitable value of START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4-SSC0) so that obtain the
release time, set up time and hold time corresponding to the system clock frequency. Refer to Table GC-11. Do
not set odd number or “000002” to START/STOP condition setting bits. The recommended setting value to
START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4-SSC0) at each oscillation frequency under standard clock mode is
shown in Table. GC-8. The detection of START/STOP condition starts immediately after the setting of ES0=1.
•Bit5: SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit (SIP)
The interrupt can be generated by detecting the rising edge or the falling edge of SCL pin or SDA pin. SCL/SDA
interrupt pin polarity selection bit selects the polarity of SCL pin or SDA pin for interrupt.
•Bit6 : SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit (SIS)
SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit selects either SCL pin or SDA pin as SCL/SDA interrupt enable pin.
Note: The SCL/SDA interrupt request may be set when the setting of I2C-BUS interface enable bit ES0 changes.
Thus set the interrupt disable before the setting of SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit (SIP) and
SCL/SDA interrupt selection bit(SIS). After that reset “0” to the interrupt request bit before enabling the
interrupt.
•Bit7: START/STOP condition generation selecting bit (STSPSEL)
The bit selects the length of set up/hold time when START/STOP condition occurs. The length of set up/hold
time is based on the I2C system clock cycles. Refer to Table GC-9. Set the bit to “1” if I2C system clock frequency
is over 4MHz.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 197 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
2
I C start/stop condition control register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
S2Di(i=0,1,2)
Bit Symbol
SSC0
Address
032516,033516,031516
Bit name
START/STOP condition setting
bits
When reset
000110102
Function
R W
The setting of the detecting
condition of START/STOP
condition.Refer to Table GC-8.
SSC1
Note: Prohibit the setting of
"000002" and odd value
SSC2
SSC3
SSC4
SIP
SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity
selection bit
0 : Active in falling edge
1 : Active in rising edge
SIS
SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection
bit
0 : SDA enable
1 : SCL enable
START/STOP condition
generation selection bit
0 : Setup/hold time short mode
1 : Setup/hold time long mode
STSP
SEL
Fig.GC-14 I2C start/stop condition control register
Table.GC-8 Recommended setting value (SSC4 - SSC0) start/stop condition at each oscillation frequency
Oscillation
I2C system
I2C system SSC4-SSC0
SCL release
Setup time
Hold time
f(XIN) (MHz) clock selection clock(MHz)
time(cycle)
(cycle)
(cycle)
10
1 / 2f1
5
XXX11110
6.2µs (31)
3.2µs (16)
3.0µs (15)
8
1 / 2f1
4
XXX11010
6.75µs(27)
3.5µs (14)
3.25µs(13)
XXX11000
6.25µs(25)
3.25µs(13)
3.0µs (12)
8
1 / 8f1
1
XXX00100
5.0µs (5)
3.0µs (3)
2.0µs (2)
4
1 / 2f1
2
XXX01100
6.5µs (13)
3.5µs (7)
3.0µs (6)
XXX01010
5.5µs (11)
3.0µs (6)
2.5µs (5)
2
1 / 2f1
1
XXX00100
5.0µs (5)
3.0µs (3)
2.0µs (2)
Note: Do not set odd value or “000002” to START/STOP condition setting bits.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 198 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
START Condition Generation Method
When ES0 bit of the I2C control register is “1” and the BB flag of I2C status register is “0”, writing “1” to the
MST, TRX, and BB bits and “0” to the PIN and low-order 4 bits of the I2C status register (address 032816,
033816, 031816) simultaneously enters the standby status to generate the start condition. The start condition
is generated after writing slave address data to the I2C data shift register. After that, the bit counter becomes
“0002” and 1 byte SCL are output. The START condition generation timing is different in the standard clock
mode and the high-speed clock mode. Refer to Fig.GC-17 the START condition generation timing diagram,
and Table GC-9 the START condition generation timing table.
Interrupt disable
No
BB=0?
Yes
S1i=E016
S0i=Data
Interrupt enable
Fig.GC-15 Start condition generation flow chart
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 199 of 290
Start condition standby status setting
Start condition trigger occur.
✼ Data=Slave address data
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
Function of protection of duplicate START condition
It is necessary to verify that the bus is not in use via BB flag before setting up a START condition. However,
there is a possibility that right after the verification of BB flag, the BB flag becomes to “1” because a START
condition is generated by another master device .In this case, the function to interrupt the start condition is
built in. When the function starts, it works as follows:
•The prohibition of setting up START condition standby
If the START condition standby has been set up, releases it and resets the bits of MST and TRX.
•The prohibition of writing to the I2C data shift register (The prohibition of generating a START condition
trigger)
•If the generation of start condition is interrupted, sets the AL flag.
The function of protection of duplicate START condition is valid from the falling edge of SDA of START
condition to the completion of slave reception. Fig.GC-16 shows the valid period of the function of protection
of duplicate START condition.
1 clock
SCL
SDA
1 bit
2 clock
2 bit
3 clock
3 bit
8 clock
8 bit
ACK clock
ACK bit
BB flag
The valid period of protection of duplicate START condition
Fig.GC-16 The valid period of the function of protection of duplicate START condition
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 200 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
STOP Condition Generation Method
When the ES0 bit of the I2C control register is “1”, writing “1” to the MST and TRX bits, and “0” to the BB, PIN
and low-order bits of the I2C status register simultaneously enters the standby status to generate the stop
condition. The stop condition is generated after writing dummy data to the I2C data shift register. The STOP
condition generation timing is different in the standard clock mode and the high-speed clock mode. Refer to
Fig.GC-18, the STOP condition generation timing diagram, and Table GC-9, the STOP condition generation
timing table. Do not write data to I2C status register and I2C data shift register, before BB flag becomes to “0”
after the instruction to generate the stop condition to avoid the influence on generating STOP condition waveform.
I2C data shift register
write signal
SCL
Setup
time
SDA
AA
AA
Hold
time
Fig.GC-17 Start condition generation timing diagram
I2C data shift register
write signal
SCL
SDA
AA
AA
AAAA
Setup
time
Hold
time
Fig.GC-18 Stop condition generation timing diagram
Table.GC-9 Start/Stop generation timing table
Item
Start/Stop condition generation
selection bit
Setup
“0”
time
“1”
hold
“0”
time
“1”
Note: VIIC = 4MHz
Standard clock mode
5.0µs (20 cycle)
13.0µs (52 cycle)
5.0µs (20 cycle)
13.0µs (52 cycle)
High-speed clock mode
2.5µs (10 cycle)
6.5µs (26 cycle)
2.5µs (10 cycle)
6.5µs (26 cycle)
As mentioned above, Writing “1” to MST and TRX bits.
Writing “1” or “0” to BB bit, writing “0” to PIN and low-order 4 bits, simultaneously sets up the START or STOP
condition standby. It releases SDA in START condition standby, makes SDA to “L” in STOP condition
standby. The signal of writing to data shift register triggers the generation of START/STOP condition. In the
case of setting MST, and TRX to “1” but do not want to generate a START/STOP condition. Write “1” to the
low-order 4 bits simultaneously. Fig.GC-10 illustrates the function of writing to status register.
Table.GC-10 The function of writing to status register
The value of the data writing to status register
MST TRX BB PIN AL AAS AS0 LRB
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0/1 0/1 0
1
1
1
1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 201 of 290
Function
Setting up the START condition stand by in master transmission mode
Setting up the STOP condition stand by in master transmission mode
Setting up the communication mode (refer to the description on I2C status register)
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
START/STOP Condition Detecting Operation
The START/STOP condition detection operations are shown in Fig.GC-19, GC-20 and Table.GC-11 The
START/STOP condition is set by the START/STOP condition set bit. The START/STOP condition can be detected only when the input signal of the SCL and SDA pins satisfy with three conditions: SCL release time, setup
time, and hold time (see Table.GC-11). The BB flag is set to “1” by detecting the START condition and is reset
to “0” by detecting the STOP condition. The BB flag set/reset timing is different in the standard clock mode and
the high-speed clock mode. Refer to Table GC-11, the BB flag set/reset time.
AAA
AA
SCL release time
SCL
SDA
Setup
time
Hold
time
BB flag
set time
BB flag
Fig.GC-19 Start condition detection timing diagram
AAA
AA
SCL release time
SCL
SDA
Setup
time
Hold
time
BB flag
reset time
BB flag
Fig.GC-20 Stop condition detection timing diagram
Table.GC-11 Start/Stop generation timing table
SCL release time
Setup time
Hold time
BB flag set/reset
time
Standard clock mode
SSC value + 1 cycle (6.25µs)
SSC value + 1 cycle < 4.0µs (3.25µs)
2
SSC value cycle < 4.0µs (3.0µs)
2
SSC value - 1 +2 cycle (3.375µs)
2
High-speed clock mode
4 cycle (1.0µs)
2 cycle (0.5µs)
2 cycle (0.5µs)
3.5 cycle (0.875µs)
Note: Unit : Cycle number of system clock VIIC
SSC value is the decimal notation value of the START/STOP condition set bits SSC4 to SSC0.
Do not set “0” or an odd number to SSC value. The value in parentheses is an example when the
I2C START/STOP condition control register is set to “1816” at VIIC = 4 MHz.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 202 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
Address Data Communication
There are two address data communication formats, namely, 7-bit addressing format and 10-bit addressing
format. The respective address communication formats are described below.
(1) 7-bit addressing format
To adapt the 7-bit addressing format, set the DBIT SAD bit of the I2C control register 0 (address 032316,
033316, 031316) to “0”. The first 7-bit address data transmitted from the master is compared with the highorder 7-bit slave address stored in the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216). At the time of
this comparison, address comparison of the RBW bit of the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216,
031216) is not performed. For the data transmission format when the 7-bit addressing format is selected,
refer to Fig.GC-21 (1) and (2).
(2) 10-bit addressing format
To adapt the 10-bit addressing format, set the DBIT SAD bit of the I2C control register 0 (address 032316,
033316, 031316) to “1”. Also set the WIT bit of I2C control register 1 to “1”. An address comparison is performed between the first-byte address data transmitted from the master and the 8-bit slave address stored in
the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216). At the time of this comparison, an address
____
comparison between the RBW bit of the I2C address register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) and the R/W
bit which is the last bit of the address data transmitted from the master is made. In the 10-bit addressing
mode, the RBW bit which is the last bit of the address data not only specifies the direction of communication
for control data, but also is processed as an address data bit.
When the first-byte address data agree with the slave address, the AAS bit of the I2C status register (address
032816, 033816, 031816) is set to “1”. After the second-byte address data is stored into the I2C data shift
register (address 32016, 33016, 031016), perform an address comparison between the second-byte data and
the slave address by software. When the address data of the 2 bytes agree with the slave address, write “0”
to the ACKBIT to I2C clock control register, to return an ACK. When the address data of the 2 bytes do not
agree with the slave address, it does not return an ACK so that makes the finish of the communication by
writing “1” to the ACKBIT. If the address data agree with each other, set the RBW bit of the I2C address
register (address 032216, 033216, 031216) to “1” by software. This processing can make the 7-bit slave
___
address and R/W data agree, which are received after a RESTART condition is detected, with the value of
the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216). For the data transmission format when the 10-bit
addressing format is selected, refer to Fig.GC-21(3) and (4).
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 203 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
(1) A master-transmitter transmits data to a slave-receiver
S
Slave address
R/W
7 bits
“0”
A
Data
A
Data
A/A
P
A
P
1 - 8 bits
1 - 8 bits
(2) A master-receiver receives data from slave-transmitter
S
Slave address
7 bits
R/W
A
“1”
Data
A
1 - 8 bits
Data
1 - 8 bits
(3) A master-transmitter transmits data to a slave-receiver with a 10-bit address
S
Slave address
1 st 7 bits
7 bits
R/W
A
“0”
Slave address
2nd byte
A
Data
1 - 8 bits
8 bits
Data
A
A/A
P
1 - 8 bits
(4) A master-receiver receives data from slave-transmitter with a 10-bit address
S
Slave address
1 st 7 bits
7 bits
S : START condition
A : ACK bit
Sr : Restart condition
R/W
“0”
A
Slave address
2nd byte
A
Sr
8 bits
P : STOP condition
R/W : Read/Write bit
Fig.GC-21 Address data communication format
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 204 of 290
Slave address
1 st 7 bits
7 bits
R/W
“1”
A
Data
1 - 8 bits
A
Data
1 - 8 bits
A
P
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
Example of Master Transmission
An example of master transmission in the standard clock mode, at the SCL frequency of 100 kHz and in the
ACK return mode is shown below.
1)Set a slave address in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C address register and “0” into the RBW bit.
2)Set the ACK return mode and SCL = 100 kHz by setting “0016” in the I2C control register 1 and “8516” in the
I2C clock control register respectively. (f(XIN)=8MHz)
3)Set “0016” in the I2C status register so that transmission/reception mode is initialized.
4)Set a communication enable status by setting “0816” in the I2C control register 0.
5)Confirm the bus free condition by the BB flag of the I2C status register.
6)Set “E016” in the I2C status register to setup a standby of START condition.
7)Set the destination address data for transmission in high-order 7 bit of I2C data shift register and set “0” in
the least significant bit. And then a START condition occurs. At this time, SCL for 1 byte and an ACK clock
automatically generate.
8)Set transmission data in the I2C data shift register. At this time, an SCL and an ACK clock automatically
generate.
9)When transmitting control data of more than 1 byte, repeat step 8).
10)Set “C016” in the I2C status register to setup a STOP condition if ACK is not returned from slave reception
side or transmission ends.
11)A STOP condition occurs when writing dummy data to I2C data shift register.
Example of Slave Reception
An example of slave reception in the high-speed clock mode, at the SCL frequency of 400 kHz, in the ACK
return mode and using the addressing format is shown below.
1)Set a slave address in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C address register and “0” in the RBW bit.
2)Set the ACK clock mode and SCL = 400 kHz by setting “0016” in the I2C control register 1 and “A516” in the
I2C clock control register respectively. (f(XIN)=8MHz)
3)Set “0016” in the I2C status register so that transmission/reception mode is initialized.
4)Set a communication enable status by setting “0816” in the I2C control register 0.
5)When a START condition is received, an address comparison is performed.
6)•When all transmitted addresses are “0” (general call):
AD0 of the I2C status register is set to “1” and an interrupt request signal occurs.
•When the transmitted addresses agree with the address set in1):
ASS of the I2C status register is set to “1” and an interrupt request signal occurs.
•In the cases other than the above AD0 and AAS of the I2C status register are set to “0” and no interrupt
request signal occurs.
7)Set dummy data in the I2C data shift register.
8)After receiving 1 byte data, it returns an ACK automatically and an interrupt request signal occurs.
9)In the case of whether returning an ACK or not by the content of the received control data, set the WIT bit of
I2C control register 1 to “1”, and after writing dummy data to I2C data shift register, receives the control data.
10)After receiving 1 byte data, an interrupt request signal occurs, set the ACKBIT to “1” or “0” by reading the
content of the data shift register, and then returns or does not return an ACK.
11)When receiving control data of more than 1 byte, repeat step 7) 8) or 7) 10).
12)When a STOP condition is detected, the communication ends.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 205 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
Usage precautions
(1) Access to the registers of I2C-BUS interface circuit
The precaution of read/write to the control registers of I2C-BUS circuit is as follows.
•I2C data shift register (S0i : 032016, 033016, 031016)
Do not write the register during transfer. The transfer bit counter will be reset and makes data communication
incorrect.
•I2C address register (S0Di : address 032216, 033216, 031216)
After the detection of a STOP condition, RBW is reset by H/W. Do not read/write the register at the time,
because data may become undetermined. Fig.GC-22 shows the RBW bit H/W reset timing.
2
•I C control register 0 (S1Di : address 032316, 033316, 031316).
After the detection of a START condition or the completion of 1 byte transfer, bit counter (bits BC0 - BC2)
is reset by H/W. Do not read/write the register at the time, because data may become undetermined.
Fig.GC-23, GC-24 show the bit counter H/W reset timing.
2
•I C clock control register (S2i : address 032416, 033416, 031416)
Do not write to this register except ACKBIT during transfer. The I2C clock generator will be reset and
makes transfer incorrect.
control register 1 (S3Di : address 032616, 033616, 031616)
Write I2C system clock selection bits when I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0)is in disable state. By reading the data reception completion interrupt enable bit (WIT), the internal WAIT flag will be read. Thus, do
not use bit manipulation (read-modify-write instruction) to access the register.
2
•I C status register (S1i : address 032816, 033816, 031816)
Do not use bit manipulation (read-modify-write instruction) to access the register because all bits of this
register are changed by H/W. Do not read/write during the timing when communication mode setting bits
MST and TRX are changed by H/W. Data may become undetermined. Fig.GC-22, GC-23, and GC-24
show the change timing of MST and TRX bits by H/W.
•I2C
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 206 of 290
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
SCL
SDA
BB flag
AAA
AAA
Bit reset signal
Related bits
RBW
MST
TRX
AAAA
1.5VIIC cycle
Fig.GC-22 The timing of bit reset (The detection of STOP condition)
SCL
SDA
BB flag
AAAAA
Bit reset signal
Related bits
BC0 - BC2
TRX(slave mode)
Fig.GC-23 The timing of bit reset (The detection of START condition)
SCL
AA
AAA
PIN bit
Bit reset signal
2VIIC cycle
Bit set signal
The bits referring
to set
1VIIC cycle
Fig.GC-24 Bit set/reset timing ( at the completion of data transfer)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 207 of 290
AAAAA
AAAAA
AAAAA
The bits referring
to reset
BC0 - BC2
MST(When in arbitration lost)
TRX(When in NACK reception in slave
transmission mode)
TRX(ALS="0" meanwhile the slave
reception R/W bit = "1"
M16C/6K9 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface
(2) Generation of RESTART condition
After 1 byte data transfer, a RESTART condition standby can be set up by writing “E016” to I2C
status register and the SDA pin will be released. Wait in software until SDA become “H” stable and then
owing to writing to I2C data shift register a START condition trigger will be generated. Fig.GC-25 shows
the restart condition generation timing.
(3) Limitation of internal clock 0
The registers of I2C-BUS interface circuit can not be read from or written to if the internal clock up selected
to sub clock (XCIN, XCOUT) by system clock selection bit (system clock control register 0, address 000616,
CMO7 bit). Please select main clock (XIN, XOUT) in read/write.
SCL
ACK
clock
8 clock
SDA
S1i writing signal
( Set the standby of start condition)
S0i writing signal
(START condition trigger generation)
Fig.GC-25 The time of generation of RESTART condition
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 208 of 290
Insert software wait
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
PS2 Interface
PS2 interface is supported by 3 channels of serial transmission/reception circuit which is based on PS2
standard specifications.
There are two signal lines, used by PS2 interface : PS2 data(DAT) and PS2 clock(CLK).
The DAT and CLK signal lines are bidirection and should be connected to positive power supply via external
pull-up resistors. These two pins are N-channel open drain output. While bus is released, the states of DAT
and CLK is “High”. Fig.GK-1 shows the system configuration.
Output
Output
DAT
DAT
Input
Output
Input
Output
CLK
CLK
Input
Control side
Fig.GK-1 System configuration
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 209 of 290
Input
Device side
M16C/6K9 Group
PS2 Interface
The PS2 interface performs 1 byte data transfer with the format shown in Fig.GK-2.
Table GK-1 shows the communication specification.
Table GK-1 Communication specification
Item
Data transfer format
*Start bit
*Data bit
*Parity bit
*Stop bit
Transfer clock
Reception start condition
Transmission start condition
Transfer abort
Interrupt request generation
timing
Error detection
Selection function
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
Specification
: 1 bit
: 8 bits (LSB first)
: 1 bit (Odd)
: 1 bit
*Acknowledge
: 1 bit (Transmission only)
*Using the clock, which is synchronized with the sampling clock of PS2
clock (CLK)
*The following conditions should be met for reception start
1) Setting reception enable bit to “1”
2) The detection of “L” on both PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT) lines
*The following conditions should be met for transmission start
1) Setting transmission data to PS2i shift register
2) Setting transmission enable bit to “1”
*The following conditions should be met for transfer abort
1) Setting transfer interruption bit to “1”
2) The transfer completion flag becomes “1”
*In reception: At the completion of stop bit reception
*In transmission: At the completion of ACK bit reception.
*In transfer interruption: At the completion of transfer interruption
*Parity error (In reception)
It occurs when there is a parity error in data reception
*Framing error (In reception)
It occurs when the detection of stop bit of reception data fails.
*Abnormal acknowledge reception (In transmission)
It occurs when NAK is received from a device side after the data
transmission
*Sampling clock selection
Selecting the clock which samples the PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT)
page 210 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
In reception
Data
:8-bit
Parity
:Odd
Stop
:1 bit
START
D0
10-bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
PARITY
STOP
D6
D7
PARITY
STOP ACK/NAK
1 byte data format
In Transmission
Data
Parity
Stop
Acknowledge
START
:8-bit
:Odd
:1 bit
:1 bit
D0
11-bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
1 byte data format
Fig.GK-2 1 byte data format
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 211 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
Fig.GK-3 shows the PS2 interface overall block diagram.
Fig.GK-4 shows the transmission/reception block diagram.
Internal data bus
PS2 mode register (02AC16)
Pin selection
Control stop
PS2Bi(i=0-2)
CLK output
DAT output
Ch0
Transmission/
reception
section
"1"
Interrupt request 0
"1"
CLK input
DAT input
PS2Ai(i=0-2)
Ch1
"1"
Transmission/
reception
section
"1"
Interrupt request 1
Port control section
1/4
f1
Divider
Sampling clock
selection
1/8
1/16
1/32
Fig.GK-3 PS2 interface block diagram
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 212 of 290
Sampling clock
Ch2
Transmission/
reception
section
Interrupt request 2
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
Internal data bus
PS2i shift register
(02A016,02A416,02A816)
DAT output
Sampling clock
CLK output
CLK input
Synchronization
DAT input
Reception
start
detection
circuit
Transmission/reception
control circuit
Shift enable
Reception enable
Transfer abort
Reception completion
Reception process
section
• Completion detection
• Parity generation
PE & FE
Transmission process
section
Completion detection
• Parity generation
• Acknowledge reception
Transfer
completion
process circuit
Transmission completion
Acknowledge result
Transmission
enable
Communication status flags
Error flag refresh
Transfer completion
flag refresh
All bits clear
Interrupt request
PS2i control register
(02A216,02A616,02AA16)
PS2i status register
(02A116,02A516,02A916)
Internal data bus
Fig.GK-4 Transmission/reception section block diagram (One channel)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 213 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
(1) Register description
● PS2i shift register
• Transmission/reception data
(1) Data reception
The reception data are stored.
(2) Data transmission
By writing the transmitted data to the register, data transmission is ready to start. PS2 data (DAT) will
become “L” automatically (transmission start).
AAA
PS2i Shift register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
symbol
PS20SR
PS21SR
PS22SR
b0
Bit symbol
Fig.GK-5 PS2i shift register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 214 of 290
Address
02A016
02A416
02A816
Bit name
Reset value
0016
0016
0016
Function
Transmission/reception
data
R W
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
● PS2i Control register
• Reception enable bit (REN)
The data reception is allowed when this bit is set to “1”. The PS2 clock (CLK) will become to “H” (reception
enable status) automatically.
This bit will be cleared to “0” automatically after the completion of data reception and PS2 clock (CLK) will
become “L” (reception disable status) .
If this bit is needed wants to be cleared after setting it to “1” but before the transfer completion flag is
set, set reception enable bit = “0”, transfer abort request bit = “0” and proccess the transfer abort simultaneously.
• Transmission enable bit (TEN)
After writing transmission data to the PS2i shift register, setting the bit to “1” makes data transmission
enabled and PS2 clock (CLK) will become “H” automatically (transmission enable status).
This bit will be cleared to “0” automatically after the completion of data transmission and PS2 clock (CLK)
will become “L” (transmission disable status).
If this bit is needed to be cleared after setting it to “1” but before the transfer completion flag is set, set
reception enable bit = “0”, transfer abort request bit = “0” and proccess the transfer abort simultaneously.
• Transfer abort request bit (RSTOP)
This bit is used to abort the data transfer procession.
At the completion of transfer abort procession, the transfer completion flag and transfer abort flag of
PS2i status register are set to “1”, the bit is cleared to “0” automatically and PS2 clock (CLK) will become
“L” ( reception disable status).
After “L” is output to the PS2 clock (CLK), do not execute the following transmission/reception before the
device recognizes the transfer abort request.
PS2i control register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
PS20CON
PS21CON
PS22CON
b0
Bit Symbol
Address
02A216
02A616
02AA16
Bit name
Reception enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
TEN
Transmission enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RSTOP
Transfer abort request bit
0 : No transfer abort
1 : Transfer abort
Fig.GK-6 PS2i control register
Jun 06, 2003
Function
REN
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading.
Rev.1.00
Reset Value
0016
0016
0016
page 215 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
PS2 Interface
●PS2i status register
• Transfer completion flag (TI)
The flag is set to “1” at the completion of transmission/reception and the completion of transfer abort.
The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register or when the reception enable bit is changed from “0”
to “1”.
• Receiving flag (RF)
The flag is set to “1” during the data reception.
The flag is cleared automatically after the data reception or after the transfer abort.
• Reception abort incognizable flag (CD)
The flag is set in the case that device side can not recognize the abort even if the reception abort is requested.
(The flag is set in the period between the completion of data bit 6 reception and the completion of stop bit
reception.) The flag is cleared automatically after the completion of data reception or after the completion
of transfer abort.
✽ Note that during the period when the flag is set, the device side can not recognize the reception abort
request even if the tranfer abort is executed. Thus the data that the transfer abort is requested will not be
resent from device side.
• Transfer status flag (TS)
The flag is set to “1” at the completion of data reception.
The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register or when the reception enable bit is changed from “0”
to “1”.
• Parity error flag (PE)
This bit is set to “1” when parity error occurs in received data.
The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register or when the reception enable bit is changed from
“0” to “1”.
• Framing error / NACK reception flag (FE)
At the completion of reception: The flag is set when the detection of stop bit of reception data fails.
At the completion of transmission: The flag is set when NAK is received from the device side.
The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register, the reception enable bit or the transmission bit is
changed from “0” to “1”.
• Transfer abort completion flag (CC)
This bit is set to “1” when transfer abort procession is completed.
The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register, or when the reception enable bit or the transmission
bit is changed from “0” to “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 216 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
PS2i status register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
PS20STS
PS21STS
PS22STS
b0
Bit Symbol
Address
02A116
02A516
02A916
Bit name
TI
Transfer completion flag
RF
Receiving flag
0 : Waiting for reception,
Reception complete
1 : During receiving
CD
Reception abort incognizable
flag
0 : Recognizable
1 : Incognizable
TS
Transfer status flag
0 : Transmission operation
1 : Reception operation
PE
Parity error flag
0 : No error
1 : Error
FE
Framing error /
NACK reception flag
0 : No error
1 : Error
CC
Transfer abort completion flag
0 : Not abort
1 : Abort
Fig.GK-7 PS2i status register
Jun 06, 2003
Function
0 : Waiting for transfer,
During transfer
1 : Communication complete
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading.
Rev.1.00
Reset Value
0016
0016
0016
page 217 of 290
R W
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
● PS2 mode register
• Sampling clock selection bits (SCK0,1)
These two bits select clock frequency for sampling PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT).
The relation between main clock (XIN) and sampling cycle is shown in table below.
8MHz
Setting value
1/4
0.5µ
1/8
1.0µ
1/16
2.0µ
1/32
4.0µ
5MHz
0.8µ
1.6µ
3.2µ
6.4µ
XIN
✽Sampling clock , which samples each line periodically, is used for avoiding the reflection from
each line. The sampling clock will be delayed by internal circuit around 1 cycle. Thus, set the
samplingclock as fast as possible.
• Pin selection bit (PSEL)
This bit is for selecting PS2 clock (CLK) or PS2 data (DAT) to connect to PS2Bi (i=0 to 2) .PS2Bi are external
interrupt input pins. The bit setting definition is shown in table below.
Pin selection bit
“0”
“1”
PS2Bi (i= 0 to 2)
PS2 clock (CLK)
PS2 data (DAT)
• PS2 interface enable bit (PSEN)
The PS2Ai (i= 0 to 2) and PS2Bi (i= 0 to 2) will be disconnected to hardware PS2 control section and become
GPIO port when the bit is “0”.
The PS2Ai and PS2Bi will be connected to hardware PS2 control section when this bit is “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 218 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
PS2 mode register
AAA
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
PS2MOD
Bit Symbol
SCK0
Address
02AC16
Bit name
Sampling clock
selection bits
SCK1
PSEL
Pin selection bit
Reset Value
0016
Function
00 : Main clock /4
01 : Main clock /8
10 : Main clock /16
11 : Main clock /32
0 : PS2B connects to PS2 clock(CLK)
1 : PS2B connects to PS2 data(DAT)
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading.
PSEN0
Jun 06, 2003
0 : P70,P73 as GPIO
1 : P70,P73 as PS2A0,PS2B0
PSEN1
0 : P71,P74 as GPIO
1 : P71,P74 as PS2A1,PS2B1
PSEN2
0 : P72,P75 as GPIO
1 : P72,P75 as PS2A2,PS2B2
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0".
Fig.GK-8 PS2 mode register
Rev.1.00
PS2 interface enable bits
page 219 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
PS2 Interface
(2) Operation description
● Basic setting
The following items should be set for PS2 mode register (address 02AC16) set when PS2 interface is used.
• PS2 interface enable bit
Set the PS2 interface enable bits (bit4 to 6 of PS2 mode register) to “1” to enable the PS2 channels to be
used. At this time PS2 clock goes “Low” (Receiving disable).
• Sampling clock selection bit
Sampling clock cycle (1/4,1/8,1/16,1/32 of main clock) is selected by setting sampling clock bit (bits 0,1).
• External interrupt function support pin (PS2B) selection
This bit is used to select PS2 clock (CLK) or PS2 data (DAT) for the external interrupt function support pin
(PS2B).
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 220 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
● Reception operation
Fig.GK-9 shows the reception operation timing.
1
DAT
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
start
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
3
4
5
parity stop
CLK
(Device side CLK)
(Controller side CLK)
Reception enable bit
Data receiving flag
Reception abort incognizable flag
Transfer completion flag
Interrupt request
Fig.GK-9 Reception operation timing
(1) Reception enable
The reception operation is enabled by writing 0116 (reception enable bit = “1”) to PS2i control register
(address : 02A216, 02A616, 02AA16). The PS2 clock (CLK) will become “H”.
(2) Reception start
The reception operation starts when both PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT) are detected with “L”.
(3) Data reception (The reception of data and parity bits)
The content PS2 data (DAT) is read into PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816) sequentially
by the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK). The data transfer sequence is data bit (D0 -D7) then parity bit.
(4) Reception completion (Stop bit Reception completion)
By detecting the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK), the transfer completion flag (bit 0 of PS2i status register)
is set to “1” after the update of error flag (bit 4 - 6 of PS2i status register) and the reception enable bit
(bit 0 of PS2i control register) is cleared to “0”. The PS2 clock (CLK) becomes “L” (reception disable
status) and interrupt request occurs.
(5) Data read out
Read out data from PS2i shift register (address : 02A016,02A416,02A816). At this time , the error flags
(Bit4 to 6) of and transfer completion flag (bit 0) of PS2i status register (address: 02A116, 02A516, 02A916)
will be cleared to “0”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 221 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
● Transmission operation
Fig.GK-10 shows the transmission operation timing.
1
DAT
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
start
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
parity stop
start
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
parity stop
4
5
6
ack
(Device side DAT)
(Controller side DAT)
CLK
(Device side CLK)
(Controller side CLK)
Transmission enable flag
Transfer completion flag
Interrupt request
Fig.GK-10 Transmission operation timing
(1) Data writing
Write transmission data to PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816). At this time,PS2 data
will become “L” (transmission start).
(2) Transmission enable
Set 0216 (Transmission enable bit = “1”) to PS2i control register (address : 02A216, 02A616, 02AA16) for
enabling transmission operation. At this time , PS2 clock (CLK) will become “H”.
(3) Data transmission (The transmission of data, parity and stop bits)
The content of PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816) will be output to the PS2 data
(DAT) sequentially by the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK). The sequence of data transfer is data bits (D0
to D7) , Parity bit, and stop bit.
(4) Acknowledge reception
The content of acknowledge bit will be read by the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK).
(5) Communication completion
The communication opeartion is completed by detecting “H” on both PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data
(DAT). After the update of error flag (bit 4 - 6 of PS2i status register), the transfer completion flag (bit 0 of
PS2i status register) is set to “1” and the reception enable bit (bit 0 of PS2i control register) is cleared to
“0”. At this time, PS2 clock (CLK) becomes “L” (reception disable status) and the interrupt request occurs.
(6) Status clear
Read out the data from PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816). At this time , the error flags
(bits 4 to 6) and transfer completion flag (Bit0) of PS2i status register (address : 02A116, 02A516, 02A916)
will be cleared to “0”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 222 of 290
PS2 Interface
M16C/6K9 Group
● Transfer abort operation
Fig.GK-11 shows the transfer abort operation timing.
1
DAT
2
3
3
3
3
start
D0
D1
D2
D3
4 5
6
D4
CLK
(Device side CLK)
(Controller side CLK)
Transfer abort request bit
Reception abort incognizable flag
Transfer abort completion flag
Transfer completion flag
Interrupt request
Fig.GK-11 Transfer abort operation timing ( reception)
(1) - (3) Data reception operation
(4) Transfer abort request
Set 0416 (transfer abort request bit = “1”) to PS2i control register (address : 02A216, 02A616,02AA16).
(5) Transfer abort completion
The transfer abort completion flag (bit 6) and transfer completion flag (bit 0) of PS2i status register
(address : 02A116, 02A516, 02A916) are set to “1”, transfer abort request bit (bit 2) of PS2i control register
(address : 02A216, 02A616, 02AA16) is cleared to “0”. At this time, PS2 clock (CLK) becomes “L” (reception disable status) and interrupt request occurs.
(6) Status clear
By a pseudo read of PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816), the transfer abort completion
flag (bit 6) and transfer completion flag (bit 0) of PS2i status register (address : 02A116, 02A516, 02A916)
are cleared to “0”.
Note: Do not execute the following transmission/reception during the period between the “L” output from
PS2 clock (CLK) and the transfer abort request recognition of the device.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 223 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Port
Programmable I/O Ports
There are 129 programmable I/O ports: P0 to P16 (excluding P85). Each port can be set independently for
input or output using the direction register. Pull-up resistances can be set in 4-port unit. (except for P10 and
P14). The N channel open drain ports P60 to P63, P70 to P77, P80 to P84, P130 to P137 and P85 (input only
port) do not build internal pull-up resistance.
Fig.UA-1 to UA-6 show the configurations of programmable I/O ports.
Each pin functions as a programmable I/O port and as the I/O for the built-in peripheral devices.
To use the pins as the inputs for the built-in peripheral devices, set the direction register of each pin to input
mode. When the pins are used as the outputs for the built-in peripheral devices (other than the D-A converter), they function as outputs regardless of the contents of the direction registers. When pins are used as
the outputs for the D-A converter, do not set the direction registers to output mode. See the descriptions of
the respective functions for how to set up the built-in peripheral devices.
(1) Direction registers
Fig.UA-7 shows the configurations of direction registers.
These registers are used to choose the direction of the programmable I/O ports. Each bit in these registers
corresponds one for one to each I/O pin.
Note: There is no direction register bit for P85.
(2) Port registers
Fig.UA-8 shows the configurations of port registers.
These registers are used to write and read data for input and output to and from exterior. A port register
consists of a port latch to hold output data and a circuit to read the status of a pin. Each bit in port registers
corresponds one for one to each I/O pin.
(3) Pull-up control registers
Fig.UA-9 and UA-10, UA-11 shows the configurations of pull-up control registers.
The pull-up control register can be set to apply a pull-up resistance to each block of 4 ports (except for P10
and P14). When ports are set to have a pull-up resistance, the pull-up resistance is connected only when the
direction register is set for input.
Pull-up resistance can be set to each pin of P10 and P14.
(4) Port control register
Fig.UA-12 shows the configurations of port control register 0, 1. Fig.UA-13 shows the configuraitons of port
control register 2, 3. The bit 0 of port control register 0 is used to read port P1 as follows:
0 : When port P1 is input port, port input level is read.
When port P1 is output port , the contents of port P1 register is read.
1 : The contents of port P1 register is read always. (neither input port nor output port)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 224 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Port
The P0, P1, P40 to P46, P11 and P14 output type, CMOS or N channel open drain, are set by bit 0 to 6 of port
control register 1 and bit 0 to 2 of port control register 3.
0 : CMOS output
1 : N channel open drain output
Exception: P42 output type is N channel open drain if either bit 4 of port control register 1 or bit 2 of port
control register 3 is set to “1”.
Bit 7 of port control register1 functions as below
0 : P40/P43 output is cleared by software only
1 : P40/P43 output is cleared by software or when output buffer 0 is read by host side.
The driving ability of N channel output transistors for P140 to P143 can be selected by bit 6 of port control
register 2 controls as below:
0 : Driving ability of N channel open drain output transistor is LOW
1 : Driving ability of N channel open drain output transistor is HIGH
(5) Port P4/P7 input register
Fig.UA-14 shows the configurations of P4 and P7 input register.
By reading the registers, the input level of the corresponding pins can be known regardless the input/output
mode.These two registers can be read regardless port direction setting. And the ports level will be read out.
Port4 : Bit 0 to bit6's level will be read out. And bit7 is always “0”.
Port7 : Bit 0 to bit5's level will be read out. And bit6,7 is always “0”.
(6) Port function selection register 0,1,2
Fig.UA-15, UA-16 shows the configurations of port function selection register 0,1,2. The port functions of
________
UART0 to UART2 input/output, TimerA0 to TimerA2 output, TimerB3,B4 input or external interrupt INT6 to
__________
INT12 input can be switched by setting these two registers. By setting bit0,1 of port function selection register 2, the same frequency clock with f(XIN) can be output from P110 and P111.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 225 of 290
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P00 to P07
P110 to P117
Output formality
selection bit
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P12, P16
P140 to P147
Output formality
selection bit
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input respective peripheral function
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P13, P43 to P46
"1"
Output formality
selection bit
Data bus
Output
Port latch
(Note)
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P10, P11, P14, P15, P17
P40 to P42
"1"
Output formality
selection bit
Data bus
Output
Port latch
(Note)
Input respective peripheral function
(Note)
Fig.UA-1 Programmable I/O ports (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 226 of 290
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc each port.
M16C/6K9 Group
Port
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P126, P127
P153 to P157
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P21, P24 to P27, P50 to P57
P91, P97
P120 to P125
P160, P161
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input to respective peripheral function
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P47
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Pull-up selection
P20, P22, P23, P30 to P37
P150 to P152, P64 to P67, P90, P92
Direction register
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input to respective peripheral function
Note.
Fig.UA-2 Programmable I/O ports (2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 227 of 290
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each port.
M16C/6K9 Group
Port
Direction register
P130 to P137
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Direction register
P76 to P77, P80 to P84
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input to respective peripheral function
Direction register
P60 to P63, P70 to P75
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input to respective peripheral function
Note.
Fig.UA-3 Programmable I/O ports (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 228 of 290
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
M16C/6K9 Group
Port
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P100, P101 (Excepting the short dashes line section)
P102 to P107 (Including the short dashes line section)
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Analog input
Input to respective peripheral function
P102 to P107 only
Pull-up selection
DA output enable
Direction register
P93, P94
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input to respective peripheral function
Analog output
DA output enable
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P95
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Input to respective peripheral function
Analog input
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P96
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Analog input
Note
Fig.UA-4 Programmable I/O ports (4)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 229 of 290
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each port.
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P87
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
fc
Input to respective peripheral function
Rf
Pull-up selection
Rd
Direction register
P86
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(Note)
Note
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each port.
Fig.UA-5 Programmable I/O ports (5)
M1
M1 signal input
(Note1)
M0
M0 signal input
(Note1)
RESET
RESET signal input
(Note1)
Note1.
Fig.UA-6 I/O pins
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 230 of 290
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each pin.
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port Pi direction register
b
7
b6
b
5
b
4
b3
b
2
b
1
Symbol
PDi(i=0-15, except 8)
b0
Bit symbol
Address
03E216,03E316,03E616,03E716,03EA16
03EB16,03EE16,03EF16,03F316,03F616
02E216,02E316,02E616,02E716,02EA16
Bit name
PDi_0
Port Pi0 direction register
PDi_1
Port Pi1 direction register
PDi_2
Port Pi2 direction register
PDi_3
Port Pi3 direction register
PDi_4
Port Pi4 direction register
PDi_5
Port Pi5 direction register
PDi_6
Port Pi6 direction register
PDi_7
Port Pi7 direction register
Function
When reset
0016
RW
0 : Input mode
(Function as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Function as an output port)
(i=0-15, except 8)
Port P8 direction register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
PD8
b0
Bit symbol
Address
03F216
Bit name
PD8_0
Port P80 direction register
PD8_1
Port P81 direction register
PD8_2
Port P82 direction register
PD8_3
Port P83 direction register
PD8_4
Port P84 direction register
When reset
00X000002
Function
RW
0 : Input mode
(Function as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Function as an output port)
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write "0". The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
PD8_6
Port P86 direction register
PD8_7
Port P87 direction register
0 : Input mode
(Function as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Function as an output port)
Port P16 direction register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
PD16
b0
Bit symbol
Address
02EB16
Bit name
PD16_0
Port P160 direction register
PD16_1
Port P161 direction register
When reset
XXXXXX002
Function
0 : Input mode
(Function as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Function as an output port)
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write "0". The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
Fig.UA-7 Direction register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 231 of 290
RW
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port Pi register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Pi(i=0 to15,
except 8)
Bit symbol
Address
03E016,03E116,03E416,03E516,03E816
03E916,03EC16,03ED16,03F116,03F416
02E016,02E116,02E416,02E516,02E816
Pi_0
Port Pi0 register
Port Pi1 register
Pi_2
Port Pi2 register
Pi_3
Port Pi3 register
Pi_4
Port Pi4 register
Pi_5
Port Pi5 register
Pi_6
Port Pi6 register
Pi_7
Port Pi7 register
RW
Function
Bit name
Pi_1
When reset
Indeterminate
Data is input and output to and from
each pin by reading and writing to
and from each corresponding bit
0 : "L" level data
1 : "H" level data
(i=0-15, except 8)
Port P8 register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P8
Bit symbol
Address
03F016
Bit name
P8_0
Port P80 register
P8_1
Port P81 register
P8_2
Port P82 register
P8_3
Port P83 register
P8_4
Port P84 register
P8_5
Port P85 register
P8_6
Port P86 register
P8_7
Port P87 register
When reset
Indeterminate
RW
Function
Data is input and output to and from
each pin by reading and writing to and
from each corresponding bit (except
for P85)
0 : "L" level data
1 : "H" level data
Port P16 register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P16
Bit symbol
Address
02E916
Bit name
PD16_0
Port P160 register
PD16_1
Port P161register
When reset
Indeterminate
Function
Data is input and output to and from
each pin by reading and writing to
and from each corresponding bit
0 : "L" level data
1 : "H" level data
Nothing is assigned.
In an attempt to write to this bit, write "0". The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate.
Fig.UA-8 Port register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 232 of 290
RW
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Pull-up control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR0
Bit symbol
Address
03FC16
When reset
0016
Bit name
PU00
P00 to P03 pull-up
PU01
P04 to P07 pull-up
PU02
P10 to P13 pull-up
PU03
P14 to P17 pull-up
PU04
P20 to P23 pull-up
PU05
P24 to P27 pull-up
PU06
P30 to P33 pull-up
PU07
P34 to P37 pull-up
Function
R W
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0: Not pulled high
1: Pulled high
Pull-up control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR1
Bit symbol
Address
03FD16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PU10
P40 to P43 pull-up
PU11
P44 to P47 pull-up
PU12
P50 to P53 pull-up
PU13
P54 to P57 pull-up
R W
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0: Not pulled high
1: Pulled high
Nothing is assigned. (Note)
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
PU15
P64 to P67 pull-up
Nothing is assigned. (Note)
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Note.Since P60 to P63 and P70 to P77 are N-channel open drain ports, internal pull-up is not
available for them.
Pull-up control register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR2
Bit symbol
Address
03FE16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
R W
Nothing is assigned. (Note)
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
PU21
P86, P87 pull-up(Note)
PU22
P90 to P93 pull-up
PU23
P94 to P97 pull-up
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0: Not pulled high
1: Pulled high
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Note.Since P80 to P84 are N-channel open drain ports, internal pull-up is not available for them.
And P85 is input port only , also no internal pull-up is available.
Fig.UA-9 Pull-up control register(1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 233 of 290
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Pull-up control register 3
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR3
Bit symbol
Address
02FC16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PU30
P110 to P113 pull-up
PU31
P114 to P117 pull-up
PU32
P120 to P123 pull-up
PU33
P124 to P127 pull-up
R W
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Pull-up control register 4
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR4
Bit symbol
Address
02FD16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PU40
P150 to P153 pull-up
PU41
P154 to P157 pull-up
PU42
P160, P161 pull-up
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Fig.UA-10 Pull-up control register(2)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 234 of 290
R W
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Pull-up control register 5
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR5
Bit symbol
Address
02F216
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PU50
P100 pull-up
PU51
P101 pull-up
PU52
P102 pull-up
PU53
P103 pull-up
PU54
P104 pull-up
PU55
P105 pull-up
PU56
P106 pull-up
PU57
P107 pull-up
R W
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
Pull-up control register 6
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR6
Bit symbol
Jun 06, 2003
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PU60
P140 pull-up
PU61
P141 pull-up
PU62
P142 pull-up
PU63
P143 pull-up
PU64
P144 pull-up
PU65
P145 pull-up
PU66
P146 pull-up
PU67
P147 pull-up
Fig.UA-11 Pull-up control register(3)
Rev.1.00
Address
02F316
page 235 of 290
The corresponding port is pulled
high with a pull-up resistor
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high
R W
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port control register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PCR0
Bit Symbol
PCR00
Address
03FF16
When reset
0016
Bit name
Port P1 control register
RW
Function
0 : When input port, read port
input level. When output port,
read the contents of port P1 register
1 : Read the contents of port P1
register though input/output port.
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Port control register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PCR1
Bit Symbol
Jun 06, 2003
Bit name
When reset
0016
Function
PCR10
Output type selection bit
(P00 to P03)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR11
Output type selection bit
(P04 to P07)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR12
Output type selection bit
(P10 to P13)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR13
Output type selection bit
(P14 to P17)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR14
Output type selection bit
(P40 to P46)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR15
Output type selection bit
(P110 to P113)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR16
Output type selection bit
(P114 to P117)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR17
P40,P43 output
clear function selection bit
0 : Cleared by software only
1 : Cleared by software or when
output buffer is read by host side.
Fig.UA-12 Port control register 0, 1
Rev.1.00
Address
02FE16
page 236 of 290
R W
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port control register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0 0 0 0 0
Symbol
PCR2
Address
02FF16
Bit symbol
Bit name
When reset
0016
Function
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0"
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0"
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0"
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0"
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0"
Reserved bit
Must be set to "0"
PCR26
Drive polarity selection bit
(P140 to P143)
R W
0 : Low side
1 : High side
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Port control register 3
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PCR3
Bit symbol
Address
02F716
When reset
0016
Bit name
Function
PCR30
Output type selection bit
(P140 to P143)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR31
Output type selection bit
(P144 to P147)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
PCR32
Output type selection bit
(P42)
0 : CMOS
1 : N-channel open drain
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Fig.UA-13 Port control register 2, 3
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 237 of 290
R W
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port P4 input register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P4PIN
Bit Symbol
Address
02FA16
When reset
0XXXXXXX2
Bit name
Function
P4PIN_0
Port P40 input register
For reading P40 pin level
P4PIN_1
Port P41 input register
For reading P41 pin level
P4PIN_2
Port P42 input register
For reading P42 pin level
P4PIN_3
Port P43 input register
For reading P43 pin level
P4PIN_4
Port P44 input register
For reading P44 pin level
P4PIN_5
Port P45 input register
For reading P45 pin level
P4PIN_6
Port P46 input register
For reading P46 pin level
R W
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Port P7 input register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P7PIN
Bit Symbol
Address
02FB16
When reset
00XXXXXX2
Bit name
Function
P7PIN_0
Port P70 input register
For reading P70 pin level
P7PIN_1
Port P71 input register
For reading P71 pin level
P7PIN_2
Port P72 input register
For reading P72 pin level
P7PIN_3
Port P73 input register
For reading P73 pin level
P7PIN_4
Port P74 input register
For reading P74 pin level
P7PIN_5
Port P75 input register
For reading P75 pin level
Nothing is assigned.
Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”.
Fig.UA-14 Port P4,P7 input register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 238 of 290
R W
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port function selection register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PSL0
Address
02F816
When reset
0016
Function
Bit name
Bit Symbol
PSL00
UART0 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P60 to P63
1 : P10 to P13
PSL01
UART1 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P64 to P67
1 : P14 to P17
PSL02
UART2 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P70 to P73
1 : P20 to P23
PSL03
INT7 input pin selection bit
0 : P103
1 : P14
PSL04
INT8 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P104
1 : P15
PSL05
INT9 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P105
1 : P16
PSL06
INT10 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P106
1 : P17
PSL07 (Note)
P110 output clock selection bit
0 : f(XIN)
1 : fC
R W
Note. Enabled only if bit 0 of port function selection register 2 is set to "1".
If fc is selected, the phase of output clock is reversed to XCIN.
Port function selection register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PSL1
Address
02F916
Bit Symbol
When reset
0016
Function
Bit name
PSL10
TA0 output pin selection bit
0 : P40
1 : P150
PSL11
TA1 output pin selection bit
0 : P41
1 : P151
PSL12
TA2 output pin selection bit
0 : P42
1 : P152
PSL13
TB3 output pin selection bit
0 : P93
1 : P160
PSL14
TB4 output pin selection bit
0 : P94
1 : P161
PSL15 (Note)
INT6-INT11 input pin
switching bit
0 : P97, P103 to P107
1 : P120, P121 to P125
R W
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading.
Note. If this is set to "1" then port function selection register 1 (address 02F816) bit 3 to bit6
setting will be ignored.
Fig.UA-15 Port function selection register 0,1
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 239 of 290
Port
M16C/6K9 Group
Port function selection register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PSL2
Address
02F116
Bit Symbol
Bit name
P110 : f1 output function selection bit
0 : P110 as GPIO
1 : P110 as f1 output
PSL21
P111 : f1 output function selection bit
0 : P111 as GPIO
1 : P111 as f1 output
PSL22
S I/O3 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P90 to P92
1 : P150 to P152
PSL23
S I/O4 I/O pin selection bit
0 : P95 to P97
1 : P155 to P157
Fig.UA-16 Port function selection register 2
Jun 06, 2003
Function
PSL20
Nothing is assigned.
Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading.
Rev.1.00
When reset
0016
page 240 of 290
R W
M16C/6K9 Group
Port
Table.UA-1 Example connection of unused pins in single-chip mode
Pin name
Connection
Ports P0 to P10
(excluding P85)
After setting for input mode, connect every pin to VSS or VCC via a
resistor; or after setting for output mode, leave these pins open.
Ports P11 to P16
After setting for input mode, connect every pin to VSS or VCC via a
resistor; or after setting for output mode, leave these pins open.
XOUT (Note)
Open
NMI
Connect via resistor to VCC (pull-up)
FVCC
Apply 0V to 3.6V
AVCC
Connect to VCC
AVSS, VREF, M1
Connect to VSS
Note: With external clock input to XIN pin.
Microcomputer
Port P0 to P16 (input mode)
(except for P85)
(input mode)
(output mode)
open
NMI
XOUT
open
VCC
AVCC
0.47 mF
M1
AVSS
VREF
M0
VSS
In single-chip mode
Fig.UA-17 Example connection of unused pins
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 241 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Usage precaution
Usage Precaution
Timer A (timer mode)
(1) Reading the timer Ai register while a count is in progress allows reading, with arbitrary timing, the value of
the counter. But, reading the timer Ai register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16”. Reading the timer Ai
register after setting a value in the timer Ai register with a count halted but before the counter starts
counting gets a setting value to the timer.
Timer A (event counter mode)
(1) Reading the timer Ai register while a count is in progress allows reading, with arbitrary timing, the value of
the counter. But, reading the timer Ai register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16” by underflow or “000016”
by overflow. Reading the timer Ai register after setting a value in the timer Ai register with a count halted
but before the counter starts counting gets a setting value to the timer.
(2) When stop counting in free run type, set timer again.
Timer A (one-shot timer mode)
(1) Setting the count start flag to “0” while a count is in progress causes as follows:
• The counter stops counting and a content of reload register is reloaded.
• The TAiOUT pin outputs “L” level.
• The interrupt request generated and the timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1”.
(2) The timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1” if the timer's operation mode is set using any of the following
procedures:
• Selecting one-shot timer mode after reset.
• Changing operation mode from timer mode to one-shot timer mode.
• Changing operation mode from event counter mode to one-shot timer mode.
Therefore, to use timer Ai interrupt (interrupt request bit), set timer Ai interrupt request bit to “0” after the
above listed changes have been made.
Timer A (pulse width modulation mode)
(1) The timer Ai interrupt request bit becomes “1” if setting operation mode of the timer in compliance with
any of the following procedures:
• Selecting PWM mode after reset.
• Changing operation mode from timer mode to PWM mode.
• Changing operation mode from event counter mode to PWM mode.
Therefore, to use timer Ai interrupt (interrupt request bit), set timer Ai interrupt request bit to “0” after the
above listed changes have been made.
(2) Setting the count start flag to “0” while PWM pulses are being output causes the counter to stop counting.
If the TAiOUT pin is outputting an “H” level in this instance, the output level goes to “L”, and the timer Ai
interrupt request bit goes to “1”. If the TAiOUT pin is outputting an “L” level in this instance, the level does
not change, and the timer Ai interrupt request bit does not becomes “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 242 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Usage precaution
Timer B (timer mode, event counter mode)
(1) Reading the timer Bi register while a count is in progress allows reading , with arbitrary timing, the value
of the counter. But, reading the timer Bi register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16”. Reading the timer
Bi register after setting a value in the timer Bi register with a count halted but before the counter starts
counting gets a setting value to the timer.
Timer B (pulse period/pulse width measurement mode)
(1) If changing the measurement mode select bit is set after a count is started, the timer Bi interrupt request
bit goes to “1”.
(2) When the first effective edge is input after a count is started, an indeterminate value is transferred to the
reload register. At this time, timer Bi interrupt request is not generated.
A-D Converter
(1) Write to each bit (except bit 6) of A-D control register 0, to each bit of A-D control register 1, and to bit 0
of A-D control register 2 when A-D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs).
In particular, when the Vref connection bit is changed from “0” to “1”, start A-D conversion after an elapse
of 1 µs or longer.
(2) When changing A-D operation mode, select analog input pin again.
(3) Using one-shot mode or single sweep mode
Read the correspondence A-D register after confirming A-D conversion is finished. (It is known by A-D
conversion interrupt request bit.)
(4) Using repeat mode, repeat sweep mode 0 or repeat sweep mode 1
Use the undivided main clock as the internal CPU clock.
Stop Mode and Wait Mode
____________
(1) When returning from stop mode by hardware reset, RESET pin must be set to “L” level until main clock
oscillation is stabilized.
(2) When switching to either wait mode or stop mode, instructions occupying four bytes either from the WAIT
instruction or from the instruction that sets the every-clock stop bit to “1” within the instruction queue are
prefetched and then the program stops. So put at least four NOPs in succession either to the WAIT
instruction or to the instruction that sets the every-clock stop bit to “1”.
Interrupts
(1) Reading address 0000016
• When maskable interrupt is occurred, CPU read the interrupt information (the interrupt number and
interrupt request level) in the interrupt sequence.
The interrupt request bit of the certain interrupt written in address 0000016 will then be set to “0”.
Reading address 0000016 by software sets enabled highest priority interrupt source request bit to “0”.
Though the interrupt is generated, the interrupt routine may not be executed.
Do not read address 0000016 by software.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 243 of 290
Usage precaution
M16C/6K9 Group
(2) Setting the stack pointer
• The value of the stack pointer immediately after reset is initialized to 000016. Accepting an interrupt
before setting a value in the stack pointer may become a factor of runaway. Be sure to set a value in the
stack pointer before accepting an interrupt.
_______
When using the NMI interrupt, initialize the stack point at the beginning of a program. Concerning the first
_______
instruction immediately after reset, generating any interrupts including the NMI interrupt is prohibited.
_______
(3) The NMI interrupt
_______
• As for the NMI interrupt pin, an interrupt cannot be disabled. Connect it to the VCC pin via a resistor
(pull-up) if unused. Be sure to work on it.
_______
• Do not get either into stop mode with the NMI pin set to “L”.
(4) External interrupt
_______
_________
• When the polarity of the INT0 to INT11 pins is changed, the interrupt request bit is sometimes set to "1".
After changing the polarity, set the interrupt request bit to "0".
(5) Rewrite the interrupt control register
• To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for
that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occur, rewrite the interrupt control register after
the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow:
Example 1:
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
NOP
NOP
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 2:
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
MOV.W MEM, R0
FSET
I
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Dummy read.
; Enable interrupts.
Example 3:
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
AND.B #00h, 0055h
POPC FLG
; Push Flag register onto stack
; Disable interrupts.
; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit.
; Enable interrupts.
The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted
before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the
interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue.
• When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled, the
interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated.
This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the
register.
Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
Noise
(1) Insert the by-pass condencer to the Vcc-Vss line for preventing a noise and latch-up. Connect the by -pass
condencer (about 0.1µF) between Vcc pin and Vss pin. It is distance must be shortest rather sicker line.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 244 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Usage precaution
DMAC
The write to DMAC bit of DMAiCON register (i= 0-1)
If (a) conditions are matched, follow (b) as wirte procedure.
(a) Conditions
Write "1" to DMAE bit again when DMAE bit is "1" (DMAi active status).
The possibility that the write to DMAE bit and DMA request occur at the same time.
.
(b) Write procedure
(1) Write "1" to both DMAE bit and DMAS bit at the same time (Note 1).
(2)Confirm with program that DMAi is at initial condition (Note 2).
Note 1: The DMAS will be "0" if writing "0" to it. However, there is no change if writing "1" to the bit. Hence,
if "1" is to be written to DMAE by writing DMAiCON register, setting the value of DMAS to "1", DMAS
will remain the same status before the writing.
If read modify write command is used to write to DMAE bit, setting the value of DMAS to "1", the
DMA request will be retained during the execution of the command.
Note 2: Comfirm it with TCRi register.
If the value read from TCRi register becomes the same with that, which was written to TCRi register
before the start of DMA transfer (the TCRi value will be 1 decremented after writing to DMAE bit), it
is at initial condition. Otherwise, DMA is still under transfer.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 245 of 290
Electrical characteristics
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Table.ZA-1 Absolute maximum ratings
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Rated value
Unit
Vcc
Supply voltage
VCC=AVCC
-0.3 to 4.6
V
AVcc
Analog Supply voltage
VCC=AVCC
-0.3 to 4.6
V
FVcc
Supply voltage for program/erase
-0.3 to 4.6
V
Input
voltage
VI
RESET,M0,M1,VREF,XIN,
P00 to P07,P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37,
P40 to P47,P50 to P57,P64 to P67,P86,P87,
P90 to P97,P100 to P107,P110 to P117,
P120 to P127,P140 to P147,P150 to P157,
P160,P161
-0.3 to Vcc+0.3
P60 to P63,P70 to P77,P80 to P84,P85,
P130 to P137
output
voltage
VO
P00 to P07,P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37,
P40 to P47,P50 to P57,P64 to P67,P86,P87,
P90 to P97,P100 to P107,P110 to P117,
P120 to P127,P140 to P147,P150 to P157,
P160,P161,XOUT
P60 to P63,P70 to P77,P80 to P84,
P130 to P137
Pd
Power dissipation
Ta=25 C
V
-0.3 to 5.8
V
-0.3 to Vcc+0.3
V
-0.3 to 5.8
V
300
mW
Topr
Operating ambient temperature
-20 to 85
C
Tstg
Storage temperature
-40 to 125
C
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 246 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Table.ZA-2 Recommended operating conditions (referenced to Vcc=3.0V to 3.6V,Ta= -20 to 85oC)
Parameter
Symbol
Vcc
AVcc
Supply voltage
Analog Supply voltage
FVcc
Supply voltage
for program/erase
Vss
Supply voltage
Analog Supply voltage
AVss
Min.
3.0
"H" input
voltage
VIH
During flash memory read
Jun 06, 2003
V
3.6
V
V
V
0
V
0
V
P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27, P30 to P37,P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P64 to P67,P86,P87,P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147, P150 to P157,
P160,P161,XIN, RESET, M0,M1
0.8Vcc
Vcc
V
P60 to P63, P70 to P77,P80 to P84,P85,P130 to P137,
PSA0 to PSA2, PSB0 to PSB2
0.8Vcc
5.5
V
0.6Vcc
Vcc
V
0.7Vcc
1.4
5.5
5.5
V
V
P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27, P30 to P37,P40 to P47,
P50 to P57, P64 to P67,P86,P87,P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147, P150 to P157,
P160,P161,XIN, RESET, M0,M1
0
0.2Vcc
V
P60 to P63, P70 to P77,P80 to P84,P85,P130 to P137,
PSA0 to PSA2, PSB0 to PSB2
0
0.2Vcc
V
LAD0 to LAD3,LFRAME,LCLK,SERIRQ,CLKRUN
0
0.2Vcc
V
0
0
0.3Vcc
V
0.6
V
SDA0,SCL0,SDA1,SCL1,SDA2,SCL2
P60 to P63,P76,P77,P81 to P84
Rev.1.00
Unit
Max.
3.6
3.6
3.0
LAD0 to LAD3,LFRAME,LCLK,SERIRQ,CLKRUN
VIL
3.3
Vcc
0
During program/erase
SDA0,SCL0,SDA1,SCL1,SDA2,SCL2
P60 to P63,P76,P77,P81 to P84
"L" input
voltage
Standard
Typ.
page 247 of 290
I2C-BUS input level selected
SMBUS input level selected
I2C-BUSes input level selected
SMBUS input level selected
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Table.ZA-3 Recommended operating conditions (referenced to Vcc=3.0V to 3.6V,Ta= -20 to 85oC)
Symbol
Parameter
Min.
I OH (peak)
"H"peak output
current
P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37,P40 to P47,
P50 to P57,P64 to P67,P86 to P87,P90 to P97,P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147,P150 to P157,
P160,P161
I OL (peak)
"L"peak output
current
P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P30 to P37,P40 to P47,
P50 to P57,P60 to P67,P76 to P77,P80 to P84, P86 to P87,
P90 to P97,P100 to P107, P110 to P117,P120 to P127,
P130 to P137,P144 to P147, P150 to P157,P160,P161
Standard
Typ.
P20 to P27
I OL (peak)
I OH (avg)
I OL (avg)
I OL (avg)
"L"peak output
current
P140 to P143
Driven ability:High
Driven ability:Low
"H" average output P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37,
P40 to P47,P50 to P57,P60 to P67,P86 to P87,P90 to P97,
current
P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147,
P150 to P157,P160,P161
P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P30 to P37, P40 to P47,
P50 to P57,P60 to P67,P76 to P77,P80 to P84, P86 to P87,
P90 to P97,P100 to P107,P110 to P117,P120 to P127,
P130 to P137,P140 to P147,P150 to P157,P160,P161
P20 to P27
Driven ability:High
"L"average output P140 to P143
Driven ability:Low
current
"L"average output
current
f (XIN)
Main clock input
oscillation frequency
f (XcIN)
Subclock oscillation
frequency
0
32.768
Max.
-10.0
mA
10.0
mA
20.0
20.0
10.0
mA
mA
mA
-5.0
mA
5.0
mA
15.0
15.0
5.0
mA
mA
mA
16
MHz
50
Note1 : The average output current is the average value during the 100ms period limited current.
Note2 : The value are as follow:
The sum of IOL (peak) of P0,P1,P2,P86 to P87,P9,P10,P11,P120 to P126,P153 to P157 P16 should be under 80mA.
The sum of IOH (peak) of P0,P1,P2,P86 to P87,P9,P10,P11,P120 to P126,P153 to P157 P16 should be under 80mA.
The sum of IOL (peak) of P3,P4,P5,P6,P7,P80 to P84,P13,P14,P150 to P152 should be under 80mA.
The sum of IOH (peak) of P3,P4,P5,P64 to P67,P14,P150 to P152 should be under 80mA.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 248 of 290
Unit
kHz
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Table.ZA-4 Electrical characteristics
(referenced to Vcc=3.0V, Vss=0V, Ta=25oC, f(XIN)=16MHz with 0 wait unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
Parameter
VOH
High output
voltage
R fXIN
R fXCIN
Feedback resistance
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37,
P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P64 to P67, P86, P87,
P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117,
P120 to P127, P140 to P147, P150 to P157,
P160, P161
XOUT
HIGH POWER
LOWPOWER
HIGHPOWER
XCOUT
LOWPOWER
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P30 to P37,
P40 to P47,P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77,
P80 to P84, P86, P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127, P130 to P137,
P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160, P161
P20 to P27
P140 to P143
HIGH POWER
LOWPOWER
XOUT
HIGH POWER
LOWPOWER
HIGHPOWER
XCOUT
LOWPOWER
_______
_________
TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN, INT0 to INT11,
__________
________
________
________
ADTRG, CTS0, CTS1, CTS2, CLK0, CLK1,
CLK2, CLK3, CLK4, SIN3, SIN4, RXD0, RXD1,
_______ ________
________
RXD2, ICCK, NMI, KI00 to KI07
____________
RESET
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37,
P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77,
P80 to P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P120 to P127, P130 to P137, P140 to P147,
____________
P150 to P157, P160, P161, XIN, RESET, M0, M1
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37,
P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77,
P80 to P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107,
P110 to P117, P120 to P127, P130 to P137,
P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160, P161,
____________
XIN, RESET, M0, M1
P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27,
P30 to P37, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,
P64 to P67, P86, P87, P90 to P97,
P100 to P107, P110 to P117,
P120 to P127, P140 to P147,
P150 to P157, P160, P161
XIN
VOH
High output
voltage
High output
voltage
Low output
voltage
Feedback resistance
XCIN
V RAM
I CC
RAM retention voltage
VOL
VOL
VOL
VT+VT-
VT+VTIIH
IIL
R PULLUP
Low output
voltage
Low output
voltage
Low output
voltage
Hysteresis
Hysteresis
HIGH input
current
Low input
current
Pull-up
resistance
Power supply current
When reset, the output pins are opened , the
other pins are connected to Vss.
Note1 : Under the state that a timer is operating with fc32.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 249 of 290
Standard
Measuring condition
IOH=-1mA
IOH= -0.1mA
IOH= -50µA
With no load applied
With no load applied
Min.
2.5
Typ.
Unit
Max.
V
2.5
2.5
V
V
3.0
1.6
IOL=1mA
0.5
V
VCC=3V, IOL=3mA
IOL=3mA
IOL=1mA
IOH=0.1mA
IOH=50µA
With no load applied
With no load applied
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
V
V
V
V
0
0
0.2
0.8
V
0.2
1.8
V
VI=3V
4.0
µA
VI=0V
-4.0
µA
500.0
kΩ
VI=0V
66.0
120.0
MΩ
3.0
10.0
When clock is stopped
f(XIN)=16MHZ, Square wave
without division
f(XCIN)=32kHZ, Square wave
When operation under RAM
f(XCIN)=32kHZ, Square wave
When operation under
Flash memory
f(XCIN)=32kHZ, With WAIT
oscillation capacity High
(Note1)
f(XCIN)=32kHZ, With WAIT
oscillation capacity Low
(Note1)
Ta=25°C
When clock is stopped
Ta=85°C
When clock is stopped
2.0
16.0
24.0
MΩ
V
mA
35.0
µA
450.0
µA
4.5
µA
2.5
µA
100.0
µA
300.0
µA
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Table.ZA-5 DC characteristics
(referenced to Vcc=3.0 to 3.6V, Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified)
Standard (Typ.)
Parameter
Symbol
Ipp
Measuring condition
FVcc=3.0 to 3.6V
FVcc power current
Program
Erase
60mA
30mA
Table.ZA-6 A-D conversion characteristics
(referenced to Vcc=AVcc=VREF=3V,Vss=AVss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
Measuring condition
Parameter
Min.
Standard
Typ. Max.
Unit
10
±2
Bits
LSB
±6
LSB
VREF =VCC
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
RLADDER
Ladder resistance
tCONV
Conversion time
VREF
VIA
Reference voltage
8 bit
10 bit
VREF =VCC=3V, ØAD=fAD
VREF =VCC
10
40
kW
ms
ms
VCC
VREF
V
6.125
7.375
8 bit
10 bit
2.7
Analog input voltage
0
V
Table.ZA-7 D-A conversion characteristics
(referenced to Vcc=AVcc=VREF=3V,Vss=AVss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified)
Symbol
Parameter
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
Setup time
Output resistance
Reference power supply input current
tsu
RO
IVREF
Measuring condition
(Note1)
Standard
Typ. Max.
8
1.0
3
4
20
10
1.0
Min.
Unit
Bits
%
ms
kW
mA
Note1: This applies when using one D-A converter, with the D-A register for the unused D-A converter set to "0016".
The A-D converter's ladder resistance is not included.
When the content of D-A register is not "00", the IVREF will also be sent even if VREF is disconnected.
Table.ZA-8 Comparator characteristics
(referenced to Vcc=AVcc=VREF=3V to 3.6V,Vss=AVss=0V at Ta=25oC)
Parameter
Symbol
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
TCONV
Conversion time
VIA
IIA
RLADDER
Analog input voltage
Analog input current
Ladder resistance
Rev.1.00
Measuring condition
Jun 06, 2003
page 250 of 290
when f(XIN) = 16MHz
when f(XIN) = 8MHz
Standard
Typ. Max.
4
1/2
1.75
3.5
VCC
0
5.0
50
20
40
Min.
Unit
Bits
LSB
ms
ms
V
ms
kW
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc=3V,Vss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table.ZA-9 External clock input
Parameter
Symbol
tc
tw(H)
tw(L)
tr
tf
Rev.1.00
External clock input cycle time
External clock input HIGH pulse width
External clock input LOW pulse width
External clock rising time
External clock falling time
Jun 06, 2003
page 251 of 290
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
62.5
ns
25
ns
25
ns
ns
ns
9
9
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc=3V,Vss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table.ZA-10 Timer A input (The count input of event counter mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN input cycle time
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
ns
TAiIN input "H" pulse width
150
60
TAiIN input "L" pulse width
60
ns
ns
Table.ZA-11 Timer A input (The gating input of timer mode)
Parameter
Symbol
Standard
Min.
tc(TA)
TAiIN input cycle time
600
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input "H" pulse width
TAiIN input "L" pulse width
300
300
Max.
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table.ZA-12 Timer A input (The external trigger input of one shot timer mode)
Parameter
Symbol
Standard
Min.
tc(TA)
TAiIN input cycle time
300
tw(TAH)
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input "H" pulse width
TAiIN input "L" pulse width
150
150
Max.
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table.ZA-13 Timer A input (The external trigger input of pulse width modulation mode)
Parameter
Symbol
Standard
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input "H" pulse width
Min.
150
tw(TAL)
TAiIN input "L" pulse width
150
Max.
Unit
ns
ns
Table.ZA-14 Timer A input (The up down input of event counter mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(UP)
TAiOUT input cycle time
3000
ns
tw(UPH)
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input "H" pulse width
TAiOUT input "L" pulse width
1500
ns
ns
tsu(UP-TIN)
th(TIN-UP)
TAiOUT input setup time
Rev.1.00
TAiOUT input hold time
Jun 06, 2003
page 252 of 290
1500
600
600
ns
ns
M16C/6K9 Group
Electrical characteristics
Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc=3V,Vss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified)
Table.ZA-15 Timer B input (The count input of event counter mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TB)
TBiIN input cycle time (single edge count)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input "H" pulse width (single edge count)
TBiIN input "L" pulse width (single edge count)
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
150
ns
60
60
ns
ns
tc(TB)
TBiIN input cycle time (double edge count)
300
ns
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input "H" pulse width (double edge count)
160
ns
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input "L" pulse width (double edge count)
160
ns
Table.ZA-16 Timer B input (Pulse period measurement mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(TB)
TBiIN input cycle time
600
ns
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input "H" pulse width
300
300
ns
TBiIN input "L" pulse width
ns
Table.ZA-17 Timer B input (Pulse width measurement mode)
Parameter
Symbol
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input cycle time
TBiIN input "H" pulse width
600
300
ns
ns
tw(TBL)
TBiIN input "L" pulse width
300
ns
Table.ZA-18 A-D trigger input
Parameter
Symbol
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
ADTRG input cycle time (The Min. of trigger)
ADTRG input "L" pulse width
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
1500
ns
200
ns
Table.ZA-19 Serial I/O
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
Unit
tc(CK)
CLKi input cycle time
300
ns
tw(CKH)
tw(CKL)
td(C-Q)
CLKi input "H" pulse width
150
CLKi input "L" pulse width
TxDi output delay time
150
ns
ns
ns
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
TxDi hold time
RxDi input setup time
RxDi input hold time
160
ns
0
50
90
ns
ns
______
Table.ZA-20 External interrupt INTi input
Symbol
tw(INH)
tw(INL)
Rev.1.00
Parameter
Standard
Min.
INTi input "H" pulse width
380
INTi input "L" pulse width
380
Jun 06, 2003
page 253 of 290
Max.
Unit
ns
ns
Electrical characteristics
M16C/6K9 Group
Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc = 3.0 to 3.6V, Vss = 0V, Ta =25 °C)
Table. ZA-21 Multi-master I2C-BUS line
Symbol
Standard clock mode
Min.
Max.
4.7
4.0
Parameter
tBUF
Bus free time
tHD;STA
tLOW
The hold time in start condition
The hold time in SCL clock "0" status
tR
tHD;DAT
SCL, SDA signals' rising time
Data hold time
tHIGH
tF
The hold time in SCL clock "1" status
SCL, SDA signals' falling time
tsu;DAT
tsu;STA
Data setup time
The setup time in restart condition
tsu;STO
Stop condition setup time
4.7
1000
High-speed clock mode
Min.
Max.
1.3
0.6
1.3
20+0.1Cb
µs
µs
µs
0
0.6
0.9
ns
µs
300
µs
ns
250
20+0.1Cb
100
4.7
4.0
0.6
0.6
0
4.0
300
300
Unit
ns
µs
µs
Table. ZA-22 PS2 interface (referenced to Vcc = 3.0 to 3.6V, Vss = 0V, Ta =25 °C)
Standard
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
30
30
twL
twH
PS2 clock "L" pulse width
PS2 clock "H" pulse width
tsu
th
PS2 data setup time
PS2 data hold time
5
0
td
tv
PS2 data delay time
PS2 data valid time
0
Typ.
Unit
Max.
50
50
µs
µs
µs
ns
twL-5
twL-5
µs
µs
Table. ZA-23 LPC bus interface/serial interrupt output
Standard
Parameter
Symbol
tC(CLK)
tWH(CLK)
tWL(CLK)
LCLK clock input cycle time
LCLK clock input "H" pulse width
LCLK clock input "L" pulse width
tsu(D-C)
LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME
Input setup time
th(C-D)
LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN , LFRAME
input hold time
tV(C-D)
LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN , LFRAME
valid delay time
toff(A-F)
LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN
floating output delay time
Min.
30
11
11
Typ.
Max.
∞
Unit
ns
ns
ns
_______________ _______________
_______________
_______________
7
ns
0
ns
_______________
_______________
2
11
ns
28
ns
_______________
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 254 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Timing
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
P11
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
Fig.ZA-1 The measuring circuit for port 0 to port 16
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 255 of 290
30pF
Timing
M16C/6K9 Group
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input
tw(TAL)
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input
(Up down input)
Inevent counter mode
TAiIN input
(when selecting the fulling edge count)
th(TIN-UP) tsu(UP-TIN)
TAiIN input
(when selecting the rising edge count)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input
tw(TBL)
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
ADTRG input
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
CLKi
tw(CKL)
th(C-Q)
TxDi
td(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
RxDi
tw(INL)
INTi input
tw(INH)
Fig.ZA-2 Timing diagram (1)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 256 of 290
th(C-D)
Timing
M16C/6K9 Group
SDA
tHD:STA
tBUF
tLOW
SCL
tR
tF
S
p
tsu:STO
Sr
tHD:STA
tHD:DTA
tHIGH
tsu:DAT
p
tsu:STA
Fig.ZA-3 Timing diagram (2)
PS/2 interface timing diagram
In receiving
tWH
tWL
0.8VCC
0.8VCC
CLK
0.2VCC
0.2VCC
th
tsu
DATA
0.8VCC
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
0.2VCC
In transmitting
tWL
tWH
0.8VCC
CLK
0.2VCC
td
DATA
Fig.ZA-4 Timing diagram (3)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 257 of 290
0.2VCC
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
tv
0.8VCC
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
0.2VCC
M16C/6K9 Group
Timing
LPC bus interface/serial interrupt output timing
tC(CLK)
tWH(CLK)
LCLK
tWL(CLK)
VIH
VIL
tsu(D-C)
LAD[3:0]
SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME
(Input)
tv(C-D)
LAD[3:0]
SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME
(Active output)
toff(A-F)
LAD[3:0]
SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME
(Floating output )
Fig.ZA-5 Timing diagram (4)
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 258 of 290
th(C-D)
Flash memory version
M16C/6K9 Group
Feature Outline
Table AB-1 shows the feature outline of M16C/6K9 (build-in NEW DINOR flash memory version).
Table.AB-1 Feature outline of M16C/6K9 (build-in NEW DINOR flash memory version)
Item
Feature
Power supply voltage
Power supply voltage for program/erase
3.0-3.6V (f(XIN)=16MHz, 0 wait)
3.0-3.6V (CPU reprogram mode, f(XIN)=8MHz with 0 wait or 16MHz
Flash memory operation mode
with 1 wait)
3 modes (parallel I/O, standard serial I/O, CPU reprogram)
Erase block division
User ROM area
Boot ROM area
See Fig.AB-1
1 division (4K bytes) (Note1)
Program method
Erase method
2-byte unit
Block erase
Program/ erase control method
Number of command
Program/ erase controlled by s/w commands
5 commands
Program/ erase count
ROM code protect
100 times
Support for parallel I/O and standard serial I/O modes
Note1: The control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in boot ROM area when shipping from factory.
The area can only be erased or programmed by parallel I/O mode.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 259 of 290
Flash memory version
M16C/6K9 Group
Flash Memory
The M16C/6K9 (build-in flash memory version) contains the NEW DINOR type flash memory, which is applied
2 power supplies VCC=3.3V when using CPU reprogram or standard serial I/O mode. For the flash memory,
3 flash memory modes are available in which to read, program and erase. They are parallel I/O mode,
standard serial I/O mode and CPU reprogram mode. For parallel I/O mode, a programmer is used. For
standard serial I/O and CPU reprogram modes, the flash memory is manipulated by CPU. Each mode is
detailed in the pages to follow.
Fig. AB-1 shows that flash memory is divided into several blocks. Erasing is in block unit.
In addition to the ordinary user ROM area there is a boot ROM area to store the control program for the CPU
reprogram and standard serial I/O modes. The control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in boot
ROM area when shipping from factory. User can reprogram the program to suit its own application system.
The area can only be erased or programmed by parallel I/O mode.
0E000016
Chip name
The start address of
the flash memory
M306K9FCL
0E000016
Block 3 : 32K bytes
M306K9F8L
0F000016
Block 6 : 64K bytes
0F000016
Block 5 : 32K bytes
0F800016
Block 4 : 8K bytes
0FA00016
Block 3 : 8K bytes
0FC00016
0FE00016
0FF00016
0FFFFF16
Block 2 : 8K bytes
0FF00016
0FFFFF16
4K bytes
Boot block area
Block 1 : 4K bytes
Block 0 : 4K bytes
User block area
Note 1: Boot ROM area can be reprogrammed only in parallel I/O mode.
(Access to any other areas is inhibited.)
Note 2: To specify a block, use the maximum even address in the block.
Fig.AB-1 Block diagram of flash memory version
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 260 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU Reprogram Mode
CPU reprogram mode
In CPU reprogram mode, the on-chip flash memory can be operated on (read, program or erase) under the
control of CPU.
In CPU reprogram mode, only the user ROM area shown in Fig.AB-1 can be reprogrammed. The boot ROM
area cannot be reprogrammed. Make sure the program and block erase commands are issued only for each
block of the user ROM area.
The control program for CPU reprogram mode can be stored in either user ROM or boot ROM area. In CPU
reprogram mode, because the flash memory cannot be read form CPU, the control program must be transferred
to the RAM area before execution.
Microcomputer mode and Boot mode
The control program for CPU reprogram mode must be written into the user ROM or boot ROM area in
parallel I/O mode beforehand. (If the control program is written into the boot ROM area, the standard serial I/
O mode becomes disable.)
See Fig.AB-1 for details about the boot ROM area.
Normal microcomputer mode is entered when reset with pulling “L” of M0. In this case, the CPU starts
operating the control program in user ROM area.
If the microcomputer is reset with M0 being “H” and M1 being “L”, the CPU starts operating the control
program in boot ROM area. This mode is called as “boot” mode.
Block address
Block address refers to the maximum even address of each block. The address is used in block erase
command.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 261 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU Reprogram Mode
Feature Outline (CPU reprogram mode)
In CPU reprogram mode, the CPU erases, programs and reads the on-chip flash memory as instructed by
S/W commands. The reprogram control program must be transferred to the RAM area before it can be
executed.
The CPU reprogram mode is accessed by writing “1” to the CPU reprogram select bit (bit 1 in address
03B716). S/W commands are accepted once the mode is accessed.
In CPU reprogram mode, the writing and reading of the commands and data should be in even address (“0”
for byte address A0) in 16-bit unit, so the 8-bit unit S/W commands should be written in even address.
Commands are ignored with odd address.
Use S/W commands to control flash memory programming and erasing. Whether the programming and
erasing operation terminates correctly or in error can be verified by reading the status register.
Fig.BB-1 shows the flash control register.
_____
Bit 0 is the RY/BY status flag exclusively used to read the operating status of the flash memory. During
programming and erasing operation, it is “0”, otherwise it is “1”.
Bit 1 is the CPU reprogram mode select bit. When the bit is set to “1”, CPU reprogram mode is entered S/W
commands then can be accessed. In CPU reprogram mode, the CPU cannot access the on-chip flash memory
directly. Therefore, use the control program in RAM to write the bit to “1”. To set the bit, it is necessary to write
“0” and then write “1” in succession. The bit can be cleared to “0” by only writing the “0”.
Bit 3 is the flash memory reset bit used to reset the control circuit of the on-chip flash memory. The bit is used
when exiting the CPU reprogram mode and when flash memory access has failed. When the CPU reprogram
mode select bit is “1”, writing “1” to the bit resets the control circuit. To release the reset, it is necessary to set
the bit to “0”. If the control circuit is reset while erasing is in progress, the wait for 5 ms is needed so that the
flash memory can restore to the normal operation.
Bit 5 of the flash control register 0 is the user ROM select bit. It is enabled only in boot mode. When the bit is
set to “1”, the accessed area is switched from boot ROM to user ROM. When CPU reprogram mode is
entered in boot mode, please set this bit to “1”. The bit is disabled when program starts in user ROM. Please
write the bit with the program that is not located in on-chip flash memory area.
Fig.BB-2 shows a flowchart for the setting/ releasing the CPU reprogram mode.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 262 of 290
CPU Reprogram Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Flash memory control register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
Address
When reset
FMR
03B716
XX0000012
0
Bit name
Bit symbol
Function
FMR0
RY/BY signal status bit
0: Busy (be written and erased)
1: Ready
FMR1
CPU reprogram mode
select bit (Note 1)
0: Normal mode
1: CPU reprogram mode
Reserved bit
FMR3
Must be “0”.
Flash memory reset bit
(Note 2)
0: Normal operation
1: Reset
Reserved bit
FMR5
Must be “0”.
User ROM area select bit
0: Access to boot ROM area
(Note 3)
(Only enabled in boot mode) 1: Access to user ROM area
Nothing is assigned.
When write, set “0”. When read, value is indeterminate.
A
AA
A
A
A
AA
A
AA
A
A
AA
R WW
R
Note 1: To write “1” to the bit, it is necessary to write “0” and “1” in succession.
Otherwise the bit will not be “1”. Please do not enter interrupt and DMA.
Note 2: It is enabled only CPU reprogram mode select bit is “1”. After setting to
“1”(reset), please write “0” in succession.
Note 3: Please write this bit with program that is not located in on-chip flash
memory area.
Flash memory identification register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
When reset
FTR
03B416
XXXXXX102
Function
The value after reset
XXXXXX102 : M16C/6K9 Group
000000002
XXXX00012
: M16C/6K7 Group
: M16C/6K5 Group (Note)
A
R W
Note: Address 03B416 of M16C/6K5 Group is the flash memory control register.
Fig.BB-1 The structure of flash memory control register and flash memory identification register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 263 of 290
CPU Reprogram Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Program located in ROM
Program located in RAM
Start
*1
Single-chip mode or boot mode
(Only for boot mode)
Set user ROM area select bit to "1"
Set processor mode register (Note 1)
Set CPU reprogram mode select bit="1"
(write "0" and then write "1") (Note 2)
Transfer CPU reprogram mode
control program to RAM area
Jump to the program that is transferred to RAM
(the operation hereafter is on RAM)
Operate with S/W commands to erase
and program.
Reset with read array command or the
setting of the flash memory reset bit
(write "1" and then write "0") (Note 3)
*1
Write "0" to CPU reprogram mode select bit.
(Only for boot mode)
Write user ROM area select bit to "0". (Note 4)
End
Note 1: Set the main clock frequency as shown below using the main clock divide ratio select bits (bit 6 at
address 000616 and bit 6 and 7 at address 000716):
(1) Not exceeding 8 MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = "0". (No wait for internal accessing)
(2) Not exceeding 16 MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = "1". (1 wait for internal accessing)
Note 2: For writing "1" to the bit, it is necessary to write "0" and "1" in succession. Otherwise the bit will not be
"1". Please do not enter interrupt and DAM. The write to the bit should be executed other than the flash
memory area and the NMI pin should be in "H" state.
Note 3: Be sure to execute a read command or to set flash memory reset bit before exiting the CPU reprogram
mode after completing erasing or programming operation.
Note 4: The bit can remain "1" too. If it is "1", user ROM area will be accessed.
Fig.BB-2 CPU reprogram mode set/reset flowchart
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 264 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU Reprogram Mode
Precautions on CPU reprogram mode
Described below are the precautions to be observed in programming the flash memory in CPU reprogram
mode.
(1) Operation speed
During CPU reprogram mode, set the main clock frequency as shown below using the main clock divide ratio
select bits (bit 6 at address 000616 and bit 6 and 7 at address 000716):
Not exceeding 8MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = “0”. (No wait for internal accessing)
Not exceeding 16MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = “1”. (1 wait for internal accessing)
(2) Instructions inhibited against use
The instructions listed below cannot be used during CPU reprogram mode because they refer to the internal
data of the flash memory:
UND instruction, INTO instruction, JMPS instruction, JSRS instruction and BRK instruction
(3) Interrupts inhibited against use
_______
The NMI, address match and WDC interrupts cannot be used during CPU reprogram mode because they
refer to the internal data of the flash memory. If interrupts have their vectors in the variable vector table, they
can be used by transferring the vector into the RAM area.
(4) Reset
The reset is always receivable.
(5) The reprogram in user ROM area
When CPU reprogram mode is entered and the block that the flash reprogram control program is located is
being reprogramming, the block may not be reprogrammed correctly if the power supply is suddenly down. It
is possible that the flash reprogram cannot be executed again in this case. Thus, it is recommended to use
standard serial I/O mode and parallel I/O mode.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 265 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU Reprogram Mode
Software commands
Table BB-1 lists the S/W commands available.
After setting the CPU reprogram mode select bit to “1”, the S/W commands can be used to specify the
erasing or programming operation. Note that when entering a S/W command, the upper byte (D15–D8) is
ignored.
The content of each S/W command is explained below.
Table BB-1 List of software commands (CPU reprogram mode)
The 1st bus cycle
Cycle
Command
Data
Mode
Address
number
(D15–D0)
Read array
1
Write
X (Note 5)
FF16
Read status register
2
Write
X
7016
Clear status register
1
Write
X
5016
Program
2
Write
X
4016
Block erase
2
Write
X
2016
The 2nd bus cycle
Data
Mode
Address
(D15–D0)
Read
X
SRD(Note 2)
Write
Write
WA(Note 3)
BA(Note 4)
WD(Note 3)
D016
Note 1: When a S/W command is input, the high-order byte of the data(D15–D8) is ignored.
Note 2: SRD = Status Register Data. The address should be even and within the user ROM area.
Note 3: WA = Write Address, WD = Write Data
Note 4: BA = Block Address (the maximum even address of the block)
Note 5: “X” can be any even address in user ROM area.
Read Array Command (FF16)
Issuing the command code “FF16” in the 1st bus cycle enters the read array mode. When an even address is
issued in one of the bus cycle that follows, the content of the address is read out at the data bus (D15–D0), 16
bits at a time.
The read array mode is retained intact until another command is written.
Read Status Register Command (7016)
When the command code “7016” is issued in the 1st bus cycle, the content of the status register is read out at
the data bus (D7–D0) by a read in the 2nd bus cycle.
The status register is explained in the next section.
Clear Status Register Command (5016)
The command is used to clear the bits SR4 and SR5 of the status register after they have been set. These
bits indicate that operation has ended in error. To use this command, issue the command code “5016” in the
1st bus cycle.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 266 of 290
CPU Reprogram Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Program Command (4016)
Program operation starts when the command code “4016” is issued in the 1st bus cycle. If the address and
data are issued in the 2nd bus cycle, program operation (data programming and verification) will start.
_____
Whether the program operation is completed can be conformed by reading the status register or the RY/BY
status flag. When the program starts, the read status register mode is accessed automatically and the
content of the status register can be read on the date bus (D7–D0). The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to
“0” at the same time when the program operation starts and is returned to “1” upon the completion of the
program operation. In this case, the read status register mode remains active until the Read Array Command
(FF16) is issued.
_____
The RY/BY status flag is “0” during program operation and “1” when the program operation is completed
same as the status register bit 7.
After the program, reading the status register can check the result. Refer to the section where the status
register is detailed.
Start
Write 4016
Write Write address
Write data
(The address for reading the status register
should be even and within the user ROM area.)
Status register read
SR7=1? or
RY/BY=1?
NO
YES
NO
SR4=0?
YES
Program completed
Fig.BB-3 Program flowchart
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 267 of 290
Program error
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU Reprogram Mode
Block Erase Command (2016/D016)
By issuing the command code “2016” in the 1st bus cycle and the conformation command code “D016” and
block address in the 2nd bus cycle, the erase operation specified by the block address starts (erase and
erase verification).
_____
Whether the block erase command is terminated can be conformed by reading the status register or the RY/BY
status flag. When the block erase operation starts, the read status register mode is accessed automatically
and the content of the status register can be read out. The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to “0” at the same
time when the erase operation starts and is returned to “1” upon the completion of the erase operation. In this
case, the read status register mode remains active until the Read Array Command (FF16) is written.
_____
The RY/BY status flag is “0” during erase operation and “1” when the erase operation is completed the same
as the bit 7 of status register.
After the block erase, reading the status register can check the result. Refer to the section where the status
register is detailed.
Start
Write 2016
Write D016
Block address
(The address for reading the status register
should be even and within the user ROM area.)
Status register read
SR7=1? or
RY/BY=1?
NO
YES
Full status check
(Note 1)
Erase completed
Note 1: Refer to Fig. BB-5.
Fig.BB-4 Erase flowchart
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 268 of 290
Error
Erase error
M16C/6K9 Group
CPU Reprogram Mode
Status register
The status register shows the operation status of the flash memory and whether program and erase operations
end successfully or not. It can be read in the following conditions.
(1) By reading an arbitrary address from the user ROM area after issuing the read status register command
(7016)
(2) By reading an arbitrary address from the user ROM area in the period from the start of program or erase
operation to the execution of read array command (FF16).
Table BB-2 shows the status register.
The status register can be cleared in the following condition.
(1) By issuing the clear status register command (5016).
(2) After reset, the status register is set to “8016”.
Each bit of the register is shows below.
Sequencer status (SR7)
After power-on, the sequencer status is set to “1” (ready).
The bit is set to “0” (busy) during program and erase operations and is set to “1” upon the completion of these
operations.
Erase status (SR5)
Erase status indicates the status of erase operation. When erase error occurs, it is set to “1”.
The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared.
Program status (SR4)
Program status indicates the status of program operation. When program error occurs, it is set to “1”.
The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared.
If “1” is set to SR5 or SR4, the program and block erase operations are not accepted. Before execution of
these commands, it is necessary to execute the clear status register command (5016) to clear the status
register.
If any S/W commands are not correct, both the SR5 and SR4 are set to “1”.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 269 of 290
CPU Reprogram Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Table BB-2 Definition of each bit of status register
Each bit of
SRD
Status name
Definition
"1"
"0"
Ready
Busy
-
-
SR7 (bit7)
Sequencer status
SR6 (bit6)
Reserved
SR5 (bit5)
Erase status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR4 (bit4)
Program status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR3 (bit3)
Reserved
-
-
SR2 (bit2)
Reserved
-
-
SR1 (bit1)
Reserved
-
-
SR0 (bit0)
Reserved
-
-
Full status check
By performing full status check, the execution result of erase and program operations can be known.
Fig.BB-5 shows the full status check flowchart and the method to deal with the error.
Read status register
SR4=1 and
SR5=1?
YES
Command
sequence error
NO
SR5=0?
NO
Execute the clear status register command (5016)
to clear the status register. Try to perform the
operation again after conforming that the command
is entered correctly.
Block erase error
Should block erase error occur, the block cannot
be used.
Program error
Should program error occur, the block cannot be
used.
YES
SR4=0?
NO
YES
End (block erase, program)
Note: When SR5 or SR4 is set to “1”, neither of the program nor block erase
commands are accepted. Execute the clear status register command (5016)
before executing these commands.
Fig.BB-5 Full status check flowchart and the method to deal with errors
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 270 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory
Functions to inhibit rewriting to the on-chip flash memory
To prevent flash memory from being miss-read or miss-written, ROM code protect function for parallel I/O
mode and ID code check function for standard serial mode are introduced.
ROM code protect function
ROM code protect function can inhibit readout from or modification to the flash memory by setting the content
in ROM code protect control address (0FFFFF16) for parallel I/O mode. Fig.BB-6 shows the content of ROM
code protect control address (0FFFFF16). (The address exists in user ROM area.)
If one of the pair of ROM code protect bits is set to “0”, ROM code protect is turned on, so that the flash
memory is protected against the readout or modification. ROM code protect is implemented in two levels. If
level 2 is selected, the flash memory is protected even against readout by a shipment inspection LSI tester,
etc. When both level 1 and level 2 are set, level 2 will be selected.
If both of the two ROM code protect reset bits are set to “00”, ROM code protect is turned off, so that the flash
memory can be read out or modified. Once ROM code protect is turned on, the ROM code protect reset bits
cannot be modified in parallel I/O mode. Use the serial mode or other to rewrite these two bits.
ROM code protect control address
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
When reset
1 1
ROMCP
0FFFFF16
FF16
Bit name
Bit symbol
Reserved bits
Function
Always set these bits to “1”
b3 b2
ROMCP2 ROM code protect level
2 set bits (Note 1,2)
0 0: Protect enabled
0 1: Protect enabled
1 0: Protect enabled
1 1: Protect disabled
b5 b4
ROMCR
0 0: Protect removed
ROM code protect reset 0 1: Protect set bits effective
bits (Note 3)
1 0: Protect set bits effective
1 1: Protect set bits effective
b7 b6
0 0: Protect enabled
ROMCP1 ROM code protect level 0 1: Protect enabled
1 0: Protect enabled
1 set bits (Note 1)
1 1: Protect disabled
Note 1: When ROM code protect is turned on, the on-chip flash memory is
protected against readout or modification in parallel I/O mode.
Note 2: When ROM code protect level 2 is turned on, ROM code readout by
a shipment inspection LSI tester,etc. is also inhibited.
Note 3: The ROM code protect reset bits can be used to turn off ROM code
protect level 1 and level 2. However,Since these bits can not be
modified in parallel I/O mode, they should be rewritten in serial I/O
mode or other modes.
Fig.BB-6 ROM code protect control address
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 271 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory
ID code check function
The function is used in standard serial I/O mode. If the flash memory is not blank, the ID code sent from serial
burner is compared with that inside flash memory to check the agreement. It the ID codes do not match, the
commands from serial burner are not accepted. Each ID code consists of 8-bit data, the areas of which,
beginning from the 1 st byte, are 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316, 0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716,
0FFFFB16. Write a program with the ID code at these addresses to the flash memory.
Address
0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16
ID1
Undefined instruction vector
0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316
ID2
Overflow vector
0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716
BRK instruction vector
0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16
ID3
Address match vector
0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16
ID4
Single step vector
0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316
ID5
Watchdog timer vector
0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716
ID6
DBC vector
0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16
ID7
NMI vector
0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16
Reset vector
4 bytes
Fig.BB-7 ROM ID code addresses
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 272 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Parallel I/O Mode
Parallel I/O mode
Parallel I/O mode is to input and output the software command, address and data in parallel to access the
on-chip flash memory (read, program, erase etc.).
Please use the specific device (programmer) supported for M16C/6K9 Group. Referring to the guideline etc.
of each device manufacture for the usage.
User ROM area and boot ROM area
In parallel I/O mode, both user ROM area and boot ROM area showed in Fig.AB-1 can be reprogrammed.
The access method to both areas is the same.
The size of boot ROM area is 4K bytes. The addresses are allocated in 0FF00016– 0FFFFF16. Make sure
program and block erase operations are always performed within this address range. (Access to any location
outside this address range is prohibited.)
In the boot ROM area, erase block operation is applied to only one 4K bytes block. The boot ROM area has
had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored in it when shipped from Renesas factory. Therefore,
if the standard serial I/O mode is used, the rewriting to the boot ROM area is not necessary.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 273 of 290
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Table EE-1 Pin function (Flash memory standard serial I/O mode)
Pin name
Name
I/O
VCC, VSS
Power supply
Apply 3.3 ± 0.3V to VCC, apply 0V to VSS
M0
M0
I
Connect to VCC
____________
RESET
Reset input
I
Reset input pin. While reset is "L", 20 cycles or more
clocks input to XIN pin are needed.
XIN
Clock input
I
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator
XOUT
Clock output
O
between XIN and XOUT. If external clock is used, input
it to XIN pin and open the XOUT pin.
M1
M1
I
Connect to VSS
FVCC
Power supply input
Apply 3.0V to 3.6V
for flash program
AVCC, AVSS
Analog power supply
Connect AVSS to VSS, AVCC to VCC
VREF
Reference voltage
I
The input pin of reference voltage of AD converter
P00–P07
P10–P17
P20–P27
P30–P37
P40–P47
P50–P57
P60–P63
P64
P65
P66
P67
P70–P77
P80–P84
P86,P87
P85
P90–P97
P100–P107
Input port P0
Input port P1
Input port P2
Input port P3
Input port P4
Input port P5
Input port P6
BUSY output
SCLK input
RXD input
TXD input
Input port P7
Input port P8
P110–P117
P120–P127
P130–P137
P140–P147
P150–P157
P160,P161
Rev.1.00
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
O
I
I
O
I
I
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
The output pin of BUSY signal
The input pin of serial clock
The input pin if serial data
The output pin of serial data
Input "H", "L" or open
Input "H", "L" or open
NMI input
Input port P9
Input port P10
I
I
I
Connect to VCC
The input pin of serial data
The input pin of serial data
Input port P11
Input port P12
Input port P13
Input port P14
Input port P15
Input port P16
I
I
I
I
I
I
The input pin of serial data
The input pin of serial data
The input pin of serial data
The input pin of serial data
The input pin of serial data
The input pin of serial data
______
Jun 06, 2003
page 274 of 290
Standard Serial I/O Mode
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
71
70
69
68
67
66
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
M306K9FCLRP
M306K9F8LRP
(144PFB)
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
133
48
134
135
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
40
39
38
37
143
144
6 7 8
P42/TA20OUT/GATEA20
P43/OBF01
P44/PWM01/OBF1
P45/PWM11/OBF2
P46/PWM21/OBF3
FVCC
P47/PWM31
VSS
P140/KI10
P141/KI11
P142/KI12
P143/KI13
P144/KI14
P145/KI15
P146/KI16
P147/KI17
P50/KI00
P51/KI01
P52/KI02
P53/KI03
P54/KI04
P55/KI05
P56/KI06
P57 /CLKOUT/KI07
P150 /TA01OUT
P151 /TA11OUT
P152 /TA21OUT
P60/CTS00/RTS00/SDA0
P61/CLK00/SCL0
P62/RXD00/SDA1
P63/TXD00/SCL1
P64/CTS10/RTS10 /CTS00/CLKS10
P65/CLK10
P66/RXD10/TA3OUT
P67/TXD10/TA4OUT
P70/TXD20/PS2A0
FVCC
BUSY
RXD
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
RESET
M1
M0
P96/ANEX1/SOUT40/PWM30
P95/ANEX0/CLK40/PWM20
P94/DA1/TB40IN/PWM10
P93/DA0/TB30IN/PWM00
2 3 4 5
Fig.EE-1 Pin connections for serial I/O mode
Jun 06, 2003
82
81
80
72
110
1
Rev.1.00
84
83
109
VSS
P92/SOUT30/INT5
P91/SIN30/INT4
P90/CLK30/INT3
P161/TB41IN/PWM50
P160/TB31IN/PWM40
P157/SIN41
P156/SOUT41
P155/CLK41
P154
P153
M1
M0
P87/XCIN
P86/XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC
P85/NMI
P84/TB2IN
P83/TB1IN
P82/TB0IN
P81/TA4IN
P80/ICCK
P77/TA3IN/SCL2
P76/SDA2
P75/TA2IN/INT2/PS2B2
P74/INT1/PS2B1
P73/CTS20/RTS20/TA1IN/INT0/PS2B0
P72/CLK20/PS2A2
P71/RXD20/TA0IN/TB5IN/PS2A1
P10/CTS01/RTS01
P126
P125/INT111
P124/INT102
P123/INT92
P122/INT82
P121/INT72
P120/INT61
P07
P06
P05
P04
P03
P02
P01
P00
P117
P116
P115
P114
P113
P112
P111/F1OUT1
P110/F1OUT0
P107/AN7/INT110
P106/AN6/INT100
P105/AN5/INT90
P104/AN4/INT80
P103/AN3/INT70
P102/AN2
P101/AN1
AVSS
P100/AN0
VREF
AVcc
P97/ADTRG/SIN40/INT60
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
108
107
106
105
104
103
102
101
100
99
P11/CLK01
P12/RXD01
P13/TXD01
P14/INT71/CTS11/RTS11/CTS01/CLKS11
P15/INT81/CLK11
P16/INT91/RXD11
P17/INT101/TXD11
P20/TXD21
P21/RXD21
P22/CLK21
P23/CTS21/RTS21
P24
P25
P26
P27
VSS
P30/LAD0
VCC
P127
P31/LAD1
P32/LAD2
P33/LAD3
P34/LFRAME
P35/LRESET
P36/LCLK
P37
P130
P131
P132
P133
P134
P135
P136
P137
P40/ TA00OUT/OBF00/PWM41
P41/TA10OUT/PWM51
M16C/6K9 Group
page 275 of 290
Connect to oscillation circuit
VCC
Mode setting method
Name of signal line
Value
M0
VCC
M1
VSS
FVCC
3.0V to 3.6V
RESET
VSS → VCC
SCLK
TXD
M16C/6K9 Group
Standard Serial I/O Mode
Standard serial I/O mode
The standard serial I/O mode inputs and outputs the S/W commands, addresses and data needed to operate
(read, program, erase etc.) the on-chip flash memory with a dedicated serial programmer.
Different from parallel I/O mode, in standard serial mode, CPU controls the flash memory reprogramming
(uses the CPU reprogram mode) and the input of serial reprogram data etc. The standard serial I/O mode is
started by connecting M0 to “H”, M1 to “L” and applying 3.0V to 3.6V externally to FVCC with the release of
reset. (To connect M0 to “L” in normal microcomputer mode.)
This control program is written in boot ROM area when the product is shipped from Renesas factory. Make
sure that the standard serial I/O mode cannot be used if boot ROM area is written in parallel I/O mode. Fig
EE-1 shows the pin connections for standard serial I/O mode. The input and output of serial data are processed
in CLK10, RxD10, TxD10, RTS10 (BUSY) 4 pins of the UART1.
The CLK10 is clock input pin, which clock is input externally. The TxD10 is CMOS output pin. The RTS10
(BUSY) pin outputs “L” when ready for reception and outputs “H” when reception starts. The serial data are
transferred in 8-bit unit.
In standard serial I/O mode, only the user ROM area shown in Fig.AB-1 can be reprogrammed. Boot ROM
area cannot be reprogrammed.
In the standard serial I/O mode, a 7-byte ID code is used. If the flash memory is not blank, commands sent
from programmer are not accepted unless the ID code matches.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 276 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Standard Serial I/O Mode
Outline (standard serial I/O mode)
In standard serial I/O mode, S/W commands, addresses, and data etc. are input and output with the peripheral
device (serial programmer) using 4-wire clock-synchronized serial I/O (UART1). In reception, S/W commands,
addresses and program data are read from RxD10 pin synchronized with the rising edge of the transfer clock
that is input to the CLK10 pin. In transmission, the read data and status are output to TxD10 pin synchronized
with the falling edge of the transfer clock.
The TxD10 is CMOS output pin. Transfer is in 8-bit unit with LSB first.
During transmission, reception, erasing and programming, the RTS10 (BUSY) pin is “H”. Accordingly, always
start the next transfer after the RTS10 (BUSY) pin becomes “L”.
The read after the input of S/W commands can get memory data and status register. Reading the status
register can check the flash memory operation status, the normal/error end of erasing or programming operation.
The following are the explanation of S/W commands, status register etc.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 277 of 290
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
S/W commands
Table EE-2 lists the S/W commands. In standard serial I/O mode, the S/W commands, which transferred
from RxD pin, control of erase, program and read etc. The S/W commands in standard serial I/O mode are
similar with that in parallel I/O mode. ID check function, download function, version information output function,
boot ROM area output function and read check data, 5 commands are added.
Table EE-2 The list of S/W commands (standard serial I/O mode)
1
2
3
Control
1st byte
command
Page read
transfer
FF16
Address
Address
Data
Data
4116
(middle)
Address
(high)
Address
output
Data
output
Data
(high)
Address
input
D016
input
input
data input
2016
(middle)
Address
7016
(middle)
SRD
(high)
SRD1
output
output
Page program
Block erase
2nd byte
3rd byte
4th byte
5th byte
6th byte
–
If ID
Data
259th byte
unmatched
Not acceptable
output
Data
data output
259th byte
Not acceptable
Not acceptable
4
Read
5
status register
Clear
5016
6
status register
ID check
F516
Address
Address
Address
ID size
ID1
–ID7
Acceptable
7
function
Download
FA16
(low)
Address
(middle)
Address
(high)
Check
Data
No. of
–ID7
Not acceptable
8
function
Version information
FB16
(low)
Version
(high)
Version
sum
Version
input
Version
times required
Version
–9th byte
Acceptable
9
output function
Boot ROM area
FC16
data output
Address
data output
Address
data output data output
Data
Data
data output
Data
Version data output
–259th byte
Not acceptable
(high)
Check data
output
output
data output
FD16
(middle)
Check data
(low)
(high)
output function
10 Read check
data
Acceptable
Not acceptable
output
Not acceptable
Note 1: Shading indicates transfer from flash memory on chip microcomputer to serial programmer.
The else indicates transfer from serial programmer to flash memory on chip microcomputer.
Note 2: SRD means status register data. SRD1 means status register 1 data.
Note 3: All commands are acceptable if the flash memory is blank.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 278 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Standard Serial I/O Mode
The following are the descriptions of S/W commands
Page read command
The command reads the specified page (256 bytes) of the flash memory sequentially one byte at a time.
Execute the page read command as following:
(1) Transfer the “FF16” command code in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A8– A15 and A16– A23 in the 2nd and 3rd byte respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, data (D7–D0) of the page specified by the address (A23–A8) will be output
sequentially from the smallest address sync with the falling edge of the clock.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
FF16
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
Data255
Data0
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-2 Timing of page read
Read status register command
The command is for reading status information. When command code “7016” is sent in the 1st byte, the
contents of status register (SRD) and status register 1 (SRD1) will be output in the 2nd and 3rd byte respectively
sync with the falling edge of the clock.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-3 Timing of read status register
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 279 of 290
7016
SRD
output
SRD1
output
M16C/6K9 Group
Standard Serial I/O Mode
Clear status register command
The command clears the bits (SR4–SR5), which are set when operation ended in error. When command
code “5016” is sent in the 1st byte, the aforementioned bits are cleared. When the clear status register
operation ends, the RTS10 (BUSY) signal changes from “H” to “L”.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
5016
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-4 Timing of clear status register
Page program command
The command programs the specified page (256 bytes) of flash memory sequentially one byte a time. Execute
the command as follows:
(1) Transfer the command code “4116” in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A15–A8 and A23–A16 in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) From the 4th byte onward, after inputting 256 bytes program data (A7–A0) from the smallest address of
the specified page, the page program operation will be executed automatically.
When the reception for the next 256 bytes is setup, the RTS10 (BUSY) signal changes from “H” to “L”.
The result of the page program can be known by reading the status register. For more detail, see the
section on the status register.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-5 Timing of page program
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 280 of 290
4116
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
Data0
Data255
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Block erase command
The command erases the data in the specified block. Execute the command as follows:
(1) Transfer the command code “2016” in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A15–A8 and A23–A16 in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
(3) After transferring the verify command code“D016” in the 4th byte, the erase operation starts for the specified
block of the flash memory. Issue the biggest address of th2e specified block to A23–A8.
After the completion of block erase, the RTS10 (BUSY) signal changes from “H” to “L”. The result of the block
erase can be know by reading the status register. For more detail, see the section on the status register.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-6 Timing of block erase
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 281 of 290
2016
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
D016
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Download function
The command downloads an execution program to RAM. Execute the command as follows:
(1) Transfer the command code “FA16” in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer the program size in the 2nd and 3rd bytes.
(3) Transfer the checksum in the 4th byte. Check sum is calculated from all transferred data from the 5th byte
onward.
(4) The execution program is transferred from 5th byte onward.
After the entire program data have been transferred, the downloaded execution program will be executed
if the checksum matches.
The program size allowed to transfer varies according to the size of on-chip RAM.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
FA16
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-7 Timing of download function
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 282 of 290
Data size Data size
(low)
(high)
Check
sum
Program
data
Program
data
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Version information output function
The version information of the control program stored in boot ROM area can be output by the function.
Execute the command as follows:
(1) Transfer the command code “FB16” in the 1st byte.
(2) From the 2nd byte onward, the version information will be output. The information is composed of 8 ASCII
character code.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
FB16
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
'V'
'E'
'R'
'X'
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-8 Timing of version information output function
Boot ROM area output function
The control program stored in boot ROM area can be read out in page (256 bytes) unit by the function.
Execute the command as follows:
(1) Transfer the command code “FC16” in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A15–A8 and A23–A16 in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
From the 4th byte onward, the data (D7–D0) specified in page (256 bytes) address A23–A8 will be output
sequentially from the smallest address in sync with the rising edge of the clock.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
FC16
A8 to
A15
A16 to
A23
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-9 Timing og boot ROM area output function
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 283 of 290
Data0
Data255
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
ID check function
The command checks the ID code. Execute the command as follows:
(1) Transfer the command code “F516” in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer addresses A 7–A0, A15–A8 and A23–A16 of 1st ID code (ID1) in the 2nd, 3rd and 4th bytes
respectively.
(3) Transfer the number of the ID code in the 5th byte.
(4) From the 6th byte onward, transfer the IDs from the 1st ID code (ID1).
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
F516
DF16
FF16
0F16
IDsize
ID1
ID7
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-10 Timing of ID check function
ID code
If the flash memory is not blank, the input ID codes are compared with that written in flash memory. If they do
not match, the input commands will not be accepted. Each ID code contains 8 bits data. Beginning from the
1st ID byte, the address of each ID code is 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316, 0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716
and 0FFFFB16 respectively. Write the program with the ID codes in these addresses to the flash memory.
Address
0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16
ID1
Undefined instruction vector
0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316
ID2
Overflow vector
0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716
BRK instruction vector
0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16
ID3
Address match vector
0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16
ID4
Single step vector
0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316
ID5
Watchdog timer vector
0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716
ID6
DBC vector
0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16
ID7
NMI vector
0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16
Reset vector
4 bytes
Fig.EE-11 ID code addressed
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 284 of 290
M16C/6K9 Group
Standard Serial I/O Mode
Read check data
Read check date command is for conforming if the reprogram data sent after page program command have
been received correctly.
(1) Transfer the command code “FD16” in the 1st byte.
(2) Transfer check data (low) and check data (high) in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively.
When using read check data command, the command should be issued at first to initialize the check data.
The next is to issue the page program command and related reprogram data. After that, by issuing the read
check data command again, the check data for the reprogram data issued between the two read check data
command can be read out.
Adding the reprogram data in byte unit and then calculating the lower 2 bytes of the added data in two's
complement gives out the check data.
CLK10
RxD10
(M16C reception data)
TxD10
(M16C transmit data)
RTS10(BUSY)
Fig.EE-12 Timing of read check dt command
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 285 of 290
FD16
Check data
(low)
Check data
(high)
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Status register
Status register indicates if the operation to the flash memory ends successfully or in error. It can be read by
issuing the read status register command (7016). The status register can be cleared by issuing the clear
status register command (5016).
Table EE-3 shows the definition of each bit of the register.
After reset, status register outputs “8016”.
Table EE-3 Status register (SRD)
Definition
Symbol
Status
"1"
"0"
Ready
Busy
-
-
SR7 (D7)
Sequencer status
SR6 (D6)
Reserved
SR5 (D5)
Erase status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR4 (D4)
Program status
Terminated in error
Terminated normally
SR3 (D3)
Reserved
-
-
SR2 (D2)
Reserved
-
-
SR1 (D1)
Reserved
-
-
SR0 (D0)
Reserved
-
-
Sequencer status (SR7)
After power-on, the sequencer status is set to “1” (ready).
The bit is set to “0” (busy) during program and erase operations and is set to “1” upon the completion of these
operations.
Erase status (SR5)
Erase status indicates the status of erase operation. When erase error occurs, it is set to “1”.
The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared.
Program status (SR4)
Program status indicates the status of program operation. When program error occurs, it is set to “1”.
The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 286 of 290
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Status register 1 (SRD1)
Status register 1 indicates the status of serial communication, the result of ID codes comparison, the result of
checksum comparison etc. It can be read after SDR by issuing the read status register command (7016). The
register can be cleared by issuing the clear status register command (5016).
Table EE-4 shows the definition of each bit of the register.
After power on, status register 1 outputs “0016”.
Table EE-4 Status register (SRD1)
Definition
Each bit of
SRD
Status name
"1"
"0"
SR15 (bit7)
Boot update completed bit
SR14 (bit6)
Reserved
-
-
SR13 (bit5)
Reserved
-
-
SR12 (bit4)
Check sum match bit
Match
SR11 (bit3)
ID check completed bits
00
01
10
11
SR9 (bit1)
Timeout of data reception
Timeout
SR8 (bit0)
Reserved
SR10 (bit2)
Update completed
Not update
Mismatch
Not verified
Verified with mismatch
Reserved
Verified with match
Normal operation
-
-
Boot update completed bit (SR15)
The flag indicates that if the control program has been downloaded to RAM with download function.
Check sum match bit (SR12)
The flag indicates if the check sum is matched when downloading the control program with download function.
ID check completed bits (SR11, SR10)
These bits indicate the result of ID checks. Some commands cannot be accepted without the ID checks.
Timeout of data reception bit (SR9)
The flag indicates if timeout occurs during data reception. If the bit is set to “1” during data reception,
microcomputer will discard the received data and return to wait state.
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 287 of 290
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Full status check
By performing full status check, the execution result of erase and program operations can be known. Fig.EE13 shows the full status check flowchart and the method to deal with the error.
Read status register
SR4=1 ? and YES
SR5=1 ?
Command
sequence error
NO
SR5=0?
NO
Execute the clear status register command (5016)
to clear the status register. Try to perform the
operation again after conforming that the
commands is entered correctly.
Block erase error
Should block erase error occur, the block can not
be used.
Program error
Should program error occur, the block can not be
used.
YES
SR4=0?
NO
YES
End (block erase, program)
Note: When SR5 or SR4 is set to "1", neither of the program nor block erase
commands are accepted. Execute the clear status register command (5016)
before executing these commands.
Fig.EE-13 Full status check flowchart and the method to deal with errors
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 288 of 290
Standard Serial I/O Mode
M16C/6K9 Group
Circuit applied for standard serial I/O mode (example)
The figure below shows a circuit applied for standard serial I/O mode. The control pins bary by different
programmer. Refer to programmer manual for the detail.
Clock input
CLK10
BUSY output
RTS10(BUSY)
Data input
RXD10
Clock output
TXD10
M16C/6K9 (NEW DINOR type
flash memory)
M0
M1
NMI
The control pins and external circuitry vary by different programmer.
Refer to programmer manual for the detail.
Fig.EE-14 Example circuit applied for the standard serial I/O mode
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
page 289 of 290
Package
M16C/6K9 Group
Package
MMP
144PFB-A
Plastic 144pin 16 16mm body TQFP
Weight(g)
0.62
JEDEC Code
–
Lead Material
Cu Alloy
MD
ME
e
EIAJ Package Code
TQFP144-P-1616-0.40
b2
HD
D
144
109
I2
Recommended Mount Pad
1
108
36
A
A1
A2
b
c
D
E
e
HD
HE
L
L1
Lp
HE
E
Symbol
73
37
A
72
L1
F
A3
y
Rev.1.00
Jun 06, 2003
b
x
M
page 290 of 290
L
Detail F
Lp
c
A1
A3
A2
e
x
y
b2
I2
MD
ME
Dimension in Millimeters
Min
Nom
Max
–
–
1.2
0.05
0.1
0.15
1.0
–
–
0.13
0.18
0.23
0.105
0.125
0.175
15.9
16.0
16.1
15.9
16.0
16.1
0.4
–
–
17.8
18.0
18.2
17.8
18.0
18.2
0.4
0.5
0.6
1.0
–
–
0.45
0.6
0.75
–
0.25
–
–
–
0.07
0.08
–
–
0
8
–
0.225
–
–
1.0
–
–
–
16.4
–
–
16.4
–
M16C/6K9 Group Data Sheet
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
Description
Summary
Page
1.00 Jun. 6, 2003
–
First edition issued
(1/1)
Sales Strategic Planning Div.
Nippon Bldg., 2-6-2, Ohte-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 100-0004, Japan
Keep safety first in your circuit designs!
1. Renesas Technology Corporation puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor products better and more reliable, but there is always the possibility that trouble may occur with
them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire or property damage.
Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i) placement of substitutive, auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of
nonflammable material or (iii) prevention against any malfunction or mishap.
Notes regarding these materials
1. These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection of the Renesas Technology Corporation product best suited to the customer’s application; they
do not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any other rights, belonging to Renesas Technology Corporation or a third party.
2. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, or infringement of any third-party’s rights, originating in the use of any product data, diagrams, charts,
programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in these materials.
3. All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs and algorithms represents information on products at the time of publication of these
materials, and are subject to change by Renesas Technology Corporation without notice due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore recommended that customers
contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor for the latest product information before purchasing a product listed
herein.
The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors.
Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability, or other loss rising from these inaccuracies or errors.
Please also pay attention to information published by Renesas Technology Corporation by various means, including the Renesas Technology Corporation Semiconductor home page
(http://www.renesas.com).
4. When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs, and algorithms, please be sure to evaluate all information
as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of the information and products. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage,
liability or other loss resulting from the information contained herein.
5. Renesas Technology Corporation semiconductors are not designed or manufactured for use in a device or system that is used under circumstances in which human life is potentially
at stake. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor when considering the use of a product contained
herein for any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for transportation, vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea repeater use.
6. The prior written approval of Renesas Technology Corporation is necessary to reprint or reproduce in whole or in part these materials.
7. If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control restrictions, they must be exported under a license from the Japanese government and cannot be
imported into a country other than the approved destination.
Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan and/or the country of destination is prohibited.
8. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation for further details on these materials or the products contained therein.
http://www.renesas.com
© 2002, 2003. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan.